aboutsummaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/dot_vim/doc
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'dot_vim/doc')
-rw-r--r--dot_vim/doc/csupport.txt1577
-rw-r--r--dot_vim/doc/haskellmode.txt456
-rw-r--r--dot_vim/doc/imaps.txt116
-rw-r--r--dot_vim/doc/latex-suite-quickstart.txt448
-rw-r--r--dot_vim/doc/latex-suite.txt3418
-rw-r--r--dot_vim/doc/latexhelp.txt2430
-rw-r--r--dot_vim/doc/ps_color.txt585
-rwxr-xr-xdot_vim/doc/taglist.txt1501
-rw-r--r--dot_vim/doc/tags1138
9 files changed, 0 insertions, 11669 deletions
diff --git a/dot_vim/doc/csupport.txt b/dot_vim/doc/csupport.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 266b8db..0000000
--- a/dot_vim/doc/csupport.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1577 +0,0 @@
-*csupport.txt* C/C++ Support November 21 2007
-
-C/C++ Support *c-support* *csupport*
- Plugin version 5.0.5
- for Vim version 6.0 and above
- Fritz Mehner <mehner@fh-swf.de>
-
-C/C++-IDE for Vim/gVim. It is written to considerably speed up writing code in
-a consistent style. This is done by inserting complete statements,idioms, code
-snippets, templates, and comments. Syntax checking, compiling, running a
-program, running a code checker or indent can be done with a keystroke.
-
-
- 1. Usage |csupport-usage-gvim|
- 1.1 Menu 'Comments' |csupport-comm|
- 1.1.1 Append aligned comments |csupport-comm-aligned|
- 1.1.2 Adjust end-of-line comments |csupport-comm-realign|
- 1.1.3 Code to comment |csupport-code-to-comm|
- 1.1.4 Comment to code |csupport-comm-to-code|
- 1.1.5 Frame comments, file header, ... |csupport-comm-frame|
- 1.1.6 KEYWORD + comment |csupport-comm-keywords|
- 1.1.7 C to C++ comments and vice versa |csupport-comm-c-cpp|
- 1.1.8 Date and date+time |csupport-comm-date|
- 1.2 Menu 'Statements' |csupport-stat|
- 1.2.1 Normal mode, insert mode. |csupport-stat-normal-mode|
- 1.2.2 Visual mode. |csupport-stat-visual-mode|
- 1.3 Menu 'Preprocessor' |csupport-prep|
- 1.3.1 Normal mode, insert mode. |csupport-prep-normal-mode|
- 1.3.2 Visual mode. |csupport-prep-visual-mode|
- 1.3.3 Block out code with #if 0 .. #endif |csupport-prep-if0|
- 1.4 Menu 'Idioms' |csupport-idioms|
- 1.5 Menu 'Snippets' |csupport-snippets|
- 1.5.1 Code snippets |csupport-snippets|
- 1.5.2 Picking up prototypes |csupport-proto|
- 1.6 Menu 'C++' |csupport-c++|
- 1.6.1 Normal mode, insert mode. |csupport-c++-normal-mode|
- 1.6.2 Visual mode. |csupport-c++-visual-mode|
- 1.6.3 Method implementation |csupport-c++-method-impl|
- 1.7 Menu 'Run' |csupport-run|
- 1.7.1 Minimal make functionality |csupport-run-buffer|
- 1.7.2 Command line arguments |csupport-run-cmdline-args|
- 1.7.3 Run make |csupport-run-make|
- 1.7.4 Command line arguments for make |csupport-run-make-args|
- 1.7.5 Splint |csupport-run-splint|
- 1.7.6 CodeCheck |csupport-run-codecheck|
- 1.7.7 Indent |csupport-run-indent|
- 1.7.8 Hardcopy |csupport-run-hardcopy|
- 1.7.9 Rebuild templates |csupport-run-templates|
- 1.7.10 Xterm size |csupport-run-xterm|
- 1.7.11 Output redirection |csupport-run-output|
- 1.8 Help |csupport-help|
-
- 2. Usage without GUI |csupport-usage-vim|
- 3. Hotkeys |csupport-hotkeys|
- 4. Customization and configuration |csupport-custom|
- 4.1 Global variables |csupport-custom-glob-vars|
- 4.2 The root menu |csupport-custom-root-menu|
- 4.3 System-wide installation |csupport-system-wide|
- 5. Template files and tags |csupport-templates|
- 5.1 Template files |csupport-templates-files|
- 5.2 Macros |csupport-templates-macros|
- 5.3 Templates |csupport-templates-names|
- 5.3.1 Template names |csupport-templates-names|
- 5.3.2 Template definition |csupport-templates-definition|
- 5.3.3 Template expansion |csupport-templates-expansion|
- 6. C/C++ Dictionaries |csupport-dictionary|
- 7. Extend taglist.vim for make and qmake |csupport-taglist|
- 8. Syntax based folding |csupport-folding|
- 9. Windows particularities |csupport-windows|
-10. Troubleshooting |csupport-troubleshooting|
-11. Release Notes /Change Log |csupport-release-notes|
-
- How to add this help file to Vim's help |add-local-help|
-
-
-==============================================================================
-1. USAGE WITH GUI (gVim) *csupport-usage-gvim*
-==============================================================================
-
-If the root menu 'C/C++' is not visible call it with the item "Load C Support"
-from the standard Tools-menu.
-The item "Load C Support" can also be used to unload the C/C++-root menu.
-
-Nearly all menu entries insert code snippets or comments. All these stuff is
-taken from template files and can be changed by the user to meet his
-requirements (see|csupport-templates|).
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-1.1 MENU 'Comments' *csupport-comm*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.1.1 APPEND ALIGNED COMMENTS TO CONSECUTIVE LINES *csupport-comm-aligned*
-
-In NORMAL MODE the menu items 'end-of-line comment' will append an comment to
-the current line.
-In VISUAL MODE these item will append aligned comments to all marked lines.
-Marking the first 4 lines
-
- print_double_array ( double array[],
- int n,
- int columns,
- char* arrayname
- )
-
-and choosing 'end-of-line com. /**/' will yield.
-
- print_double_array ( double array[], /* */
- int n, /* */
- int columns, /* */
- char* arrayname /* */
- ) /* */
-
-If one ore more lines go beyond the starting column (s.below) the comments
-will start at the 2. column after the longest line. The cursor will be
-positioned inside the first comment.
-
-The default starting column is 49 ( = (multiple of 2,4, or 8) + 1 ). This can
-be changed by setting a global variable in the file ~/.vimrc , e.g. :
-
- let g:C_LineEndCommColDefault = 45
-
-The starting column can also be set by the menu item
-'Comments->set end-of-line com. col' . Just position the cursor in an
-arbitrary column (column number is shown in the Vim status line) and choose
-this menu item. This setting is buffer related.
-
-If the cursor was at the end of a line you will be asked for a column number
-because this position is most likely not the desired starting column.
-Your choice will be confirmed.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.1.2 ADJUST END-OF-LINE COMMENTS *csupport-comm-realign*
-
-After some changes end-of-line comments may be no longer aligned:
-
- print_double_array ( double array[], /* */
- long int n, /* */
- unsigned int columns, /* */
- char* a_name /* */
- ) /* */
-
-Realignment can be achieved with the menu item 'adjust end-of-line com.' In
-normal mode the comment (if any) in the current line will be aligned to the
-end-of-line comment column (see above) if possible. In visual mode the
-comments in the marked block will be aligned:
-
- print_double_array ( double array[], /* */
- long int n, /* */
- unsigned int columns, /* */
- char* a_name /* */
- ) /* */
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.1.3 CODE TO COMMENT *csupport-code-to-comm*
-
-The marked block
-
-xxxxxxxx
-xxxxxxxx
-xxxxxxxx
-
-will be changed by the menu item 'code->comment /**/' into the multiline
-comment (all (partially) marked lines):
-
-/* xxxxxxxx
- * xxxxxxxx
- * xxxxxxxx
- */
-
-The marked block will be changed by the menu item 'code->comment //' into the
-multiline comment
-
-//xxxxxxxx
-//xxxxxxxx
-//xxxxxxxx
-
-The menu items works also for a single line. A single line needs not to be
-marked.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.1.4 COMMENT TO CODE *csupport-comm-to-code*
-
-If one (or more) complete comment (i.e. all lines belonging to the comment) is
-marked the item 'comment->code' will uncomment it. If the following lines
-are marked
-
- * printf ("\n");
- */
-
- printf ("\n");
-
- // printf ("\n");
- //
-
- /*
- * printf ("\n");
- */
-
-uncommenting will yield
-
- * printf ("\n");
- */
-
- printf ("\n");
-
- printf ("\n");
-
-
-
- printf ("\n");
-
-The first 2 lines are only a part of a C-comment and remain unchanged.
-A C-comment can start with /* , /** or /*! .
-
-The menu item works also for a single line with a leading // . A single line
-needs not to be marked.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.1.5 FRAME COMMENTS, FILE HEADER, ... *csupport-comm-frame*
-
-Frame comments, file header comments and function, methods, class descriptions
-are read as templates from the appropriate files (see |csupport-templates|).
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.1.6 KEYWORD+comment *csupport-comm-keywords*
-
-Preliminary comments to document (and find again) places where works will be
-resumed shortly. Usually not meant for the final documentation.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.1.7 C TO C++ COMMENTS AND VICE VERSA *csupport-comm-c-cpp*
-
-The menu item '// xxx -> /* xxx */' changes a C++ comment into an C comment.
-This is done for the current line in normal or insert mode and for a marked
-area of lines in visual mode.
-If there are multiple C comments only the first one will be changed:
- printf ("\n"); /* one */ /* two */ /* three */
-will be changed into
- printf ("\n"); // one /* two */ /* three */
-
-The menu item '/* xxx */ -> // xxx' changes a C comment into an C++ comment.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.1.8 DATE AND DATE+TIME *csupport-comm-date*
-
-The format for 'date' and 'date time' can be defined by the user (see
-|csupport-templates-date|).
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-1.2 MENU 'Statements' *csupport-stat*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.2.1 NORMAL MODE, INSERT MODE. *csupport-stat-normal-mode*
-
-An empty statement will be inserted and properly indented. The item 'if{}'
-will insert an if-statement:
-
-if ( )
-{
-}
-
-
-1.2.2 VISUAL MODE. *csupport-stat-visual-mode*
-
-STATEMENTS WITH BLOCKS AND CASE LABEL.
---------------------------------------
-The highlighted area
-
-xxxxx
-xxxxx
-
-can be surrounded by one of the following statements:
-
- +----------------------------+-----------------------------+
- | if ( ) | if ( ) |
- | { | { |
- | xxxxx | xxxxx |
- | xxxxx | xxxxx |
- | } | } |
- | | else |
- | | { |
- | | } |
- +----------------------------+-----------------------------+
- | for ( ; ; ) | while ( ) |
- | { | { |
- | xxxxx | xxxxx |
- | xxxxx | xxxxx |
- | } | } |
- +----------------------------+-----------------------------+
- | do | |
- | { | { |
- | xxxxx | xxxxx |
- | xxxxx | xxxxx |
- | } | } |
- | while ( ); | |
- +----------------------------+-----------------------------+
- | switch ( ) { |
- | case : |
- | break; |
- | |
- | case : |
- | break; |
- | |
- | case : |
- | break; |
- | |
- | case : |
- | break; |
- | |
- | default: |
- | break; |
- | } |
- +----------------------------+-----------------------------+
-
-For 'switch' and 'case' see |csupport-stat-switch| and |csupport-stat-case|.
-
-The whole statement will be indented after insertion.
-
-
-STATEMENTS WITHOUT BLOCKS.
---------------------------
-One of the following statements can be inserted:
-
- +-------------------------------+--------------------------+
- | if ( ) | for ( ; ; ) |
- +-------------------------------+--------------------------+
- | if ( ) | while ( ) |
- | else | |
- +-------------------------------+--------------------------+
- | case : | |
- | break; | |
- +-------------------------------+--------------------------+
-
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-1.3 MENU 'Preprocessor' *csupport-prep*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.3.1 NORMAL MODE, INSERT MODE. *csupport-prep-normal-mode*
-
-The preprocessor statements will be inserted and properly indented.
-
-1.3.2 VISUAL MODE. *csupport-prep-visual-mode*
-
-STATEMENTS WITH BLOCKS
-----------------------
-The highlighted area
-
-xxxxx
-xxxxx
-
-can be surrounded by one of the following statements:
-
- +----------------------------+-----------------------------+
- | #if CONDITION |
- | xxxxx |
- | xxxxx |
- | #else /* ----- #if CONDITION ----- */ |
- | |
- | #endif /* ----- #if CONDITION ----- */ |
- +----------------------------------------------------------+
- | #ifdef CONDITION |
- | xxxxx |
- | xxxxx |
- | #else /* ----- #ifdef CONDITION ----- */ |
- | |
- | #endif /* ----- #ifdef CONDITION ----- */ |
- +----------------------------------------------------------+
- | #ifndef CONDITION |
- | xxxxx |
- | xxxxx |
- | #else /* ----- #ifndef CONDITION ----- */ |
- | |
- | #endif /* ----- #ifndef CONDITION ----- */ |
- +----------------------------------------------------------+
- | #ifndef INC_TEST |
- | #define INC_TEST |
- | xxxxx |
- | xxxxx |
- | #endif /* ----- #ifndef INC_TEST ----- */ |
- +----------------------------------------------------------+
- | #if 0 /* ----- #if 0 : If0Label_1 ----- */ |
- | |
- | #endif /* ----- #if 0 : If0Label_1 ----- */ |
- +----------------------------------------------------------+
-
-The macro name for an include guard (e.g. INC_TEST above) will be derived as a
-suggestion from the file name.
-
-1.3.3 BLOCK OUT CODE WITH #if 0 ... #endif *csupport-prep-if0*
-
-The menu item #if 0 #endif inserts the lines
-
- #if 0 /* ----- #if 0 : If0Label_1 ----- */
-
- #endif /* ----- #if 0 : If0Label_1 ----- */
-
-In visual mode the marked block of lines will be surrounded by these lines.
-
-This is usually done to temporarily block out some code. The label names like
-If0Label_1 are automatically inserted into the comments. The trailing numbers
-are automatically incremented. These numbers can be changed by the user. The
-next number will be one above the highest number found in the current buffer.
-
-A corresponding label can be found by searching with the vim star command (*).
-All labels can be found with a global search like :g/If0Label_/ or
-:g/If0Label_\d\+/. All corresponding lines can be deleted with :g/If0Label_/d .
-
-
-REMOVE THE ENCLOSING #if 0 ... #endif -CONSTRUCT.
-
-The menu item 'remove #if #endif' removes such a construct if the cursor is
-in the middle of such a section or on one of the two enclosing lines. Nested
-constructs will be untouched.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-1.4 MENU 'Idioms' *csupport-idioms*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.4.1 ENTRY 'function'
-
-NORMAL MODE, INSERT MODE:
-The name of the function is asked for and the following lines (for function
-name "f") will be inserted:
-
- void
- f ( )
- {
- return ;
- } /* ---------- end of function f ---------- */
-
-VISUAL MODE:
-Main or [static] function: the highlighted lines will go inside the new
-function or main.
-for-loops: the highlighted lines will be set in braces.
-
-1.4.2 ENTRY 'open input file'
-
-The item 'open input file' will create the statements to open and close an
-input file (e.g. with the file pointer 'infile').
-
-1.4.3 ENTRY 'open output file'
-
-The item 'open output file' will create the statements to open and close an
-output file (e.g. with the file pointer 'outfile').
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-1.5 MENU 'Snippets' *csupport-snippets*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.5.1 CODE SNIPPETS
-
-Code snippets are pieces of code which are kept in separate files in a special
-directory (e.g. a few lines of code or a complete template for a Makefile).
-File names are used to identify the snippets. The snippet directory will be
-created during the installation ( $HOME/.vim/codesnippets-c is the default).
-Snippets are managed with the 3 items
-
- C/C++ -> Snippets -> read code snippet
- C/C++ -> Snippets -> write code snippet
- C/C++ -> Snippets -> edit code snippet
-
-from the Snippets submenu.
-
-CREATING A NEW SNIPPET
-When nothing is marked, "write code snippet" will write the whole buffer
-to a snippet file, otherwise the marked area will be written to a file.
-
-INSERT A SNIPPET
-Select the appropriate file from the snippet directory ("read code snippet").
-The inserted lines will be indented.
-
-EDIT A SNIPPET
-This is a normal edit.
-
-INDENTATION / NO INDENTATION
-Code snippets are normally indented after insertion. To suppress indentation
-add the file extension "ni" or "noindent" to the snippet file name, e.g.
-
- parameter_handling.c.noindent
-
-
-1.5.2 PICKING UP PROTOTYPES *csupport-proto*
-
-PICK UP PROTOTYPES.
-To make a prototype from a function head mark the function head and choose
-'Snippets -> pick up prototype'. From the first six lines of
-
- void
- print_double_array ( double array[], /* array to print */
- int n, /* number of elements to print */
- int columns, /* number of elements per column */
- char* arrayname /* array name */
- )
- {
- ...
- } /* ---------- end of function print_double_array ---------- */
-
-the prototype
-
- void print_double_array ( double array[], int n, int columns, char* arrayname );
-
-is produced and put in an internal buffer.
-- Leading and trailing whitespaces are removed.
-- All inner whitespaces are squeezed.
-- All comments will be discarded.
-- Trailing parts of the function body (e.g a '{' ) will also be removed.
-- The class name and the scope resolution operator will be removed (C++ method
- implementations).
-Further prototypes can be picked up and gathered in the buffer.
-
-For C++ methods namespace names and class names will be removed
-(exception: 'std::' ). The first two lines of
-
- std::string
- ROBOT::Robot::get_name ( void )
- {
- return type_name;
- } /* ----- end of method Robot::get_name ----- */
-
-result in the prototype
-
- std::string get_name ( void );
-
-Folding may help picking up prototypes (see |csupport-folding|).
-
-
-INSERT PROTOTYPES
-With 'Snippets -> insert prototype(s)' all picked up prototypes currently in
-the buffer will be inserted below the cursor.
-The prototype buffer will be cleared after insertion.
-
-
-DISCARD PROTOTYPES
-The prototype buffer can be cleared with 'Snippets -> clear prototype(s)' .
-
-
-SHOW PROTOTYPES
-The list of gathered prototypes can be shown with
-'Snippets -> show prototype(s)'. The number and the filename are shown, e.g.
-
- (1) matrix.c # double** calloc_double_matrix ( int rows, int columns );
- (2) matrix.c # void free_double_matrix ( double **m );
- (3) foomain.c # void foo ( );
-
-
-REMARK. Generating prototypes this way is nice in a small project. You may
-want to use an extractor like cextract or something else.
-
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-1.6 MENU 'C++' *csupport-c++*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.6.1 NORMAL MODE, INSERT MODE. *csupport-c++-normal-mode*
-
-An empty statement will be inserted and in some cases properly indented. The
-item 'try .. catch' will insert the following lines:
-
- try {
- }
- catch ( const &ExceptObj ) { // handle exception:
- }
- catch (...) { // handle exception: unspezified
- }
-
-The cursor will go into the try block.
-
-1.6.2 VISUAL MODE. *csupport-c++-visual-mode*
-
-The highlighted area can be surrounded by one of the following statements:
-
- try - catch
- catch
- catch(...)
- namespace { }
- extern "C" { }
-
-The whole statement will be indented after insertion.
-
-1.6.3 METHOD IMPLEMENTATION *csupport-c++-method-impl*
-
-The menu item 'method implement.' asks for a method name. If this item is
-called the first time you will see just an scope resolution operator. If you
-specify the scope this is used the next time you call this item. If you use
-one of the menu items to generate a class (see |csupport-templates|) the
-scope will be extracted and used for the next method.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-1.7 MENU 'Run' *csupport-run*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1.7.1 MINIMAL MAKE FUNCTIONALITY *csupport-run-buffer*
-
-The 'Run' menu provides a minimal make functionality for single file projects
-(e.g. in education) :
-
-SAVE AND COMPILE
-'save and compile' saves the buffer and run the compiler with the given
-options (see |csupport-custom-glob-vars|).
-
-An error window will be opened if the compiler reports errors and/or warnings.
-Quickfix commands can now be used to jump to an error location.
-
-Consider using maps like
- map <silent> <F7> <Esc>:cp<CR>
- map <silent> <F8> <Esc>:cn<CR>
-in your ~/.vimrc file to jump over the error locations and make navigation
-easier. The error list and the error locations in your source buffer will be
-synchronized.
-
-
-LINK
-'link' makes an executable from the current buffer. If the buffer is not
-saved, or no object is available or the object is older then the source step
-'save and compile' is executed first.
-
-The behavior of the compiler / linker is determined by the options assigned to
-the variables described in |csupport-custom-glob-vars| (4.group).
-
-RUN
-'run' runs the executable with the same name (extension .e) as the current
-buffer. If the buffer is not saved, or no executable is available or the
-executable is older then the source steps 'save and compile' and 'link' are
-executed first.
-
-
-1.7.2 COMMAND LINE ARGUMENTS *csupport-run-cmdline-args*
-
-The item 'command line arguments' calls an input dialog which asks for command
-line arguments. These arguments are forwarded to the program which is run by
-the 'run' item. The arguments are kept until you change them.
-
-The arguments belong to the current buffer (that is, each buffer can have its
-own arguments).
-If the buffer gets a new name with "save as" the arguments will now belong to
-the buffer with the new name.
-
-The command line arguments can be followed by pipes and redirections:
-
- 11 22 | sort -rn | head -10 > out
-
-Caveat: If you look for the current arguments by calling this menu item again
-be sure to leave it with a CR (not Esc !). Due to a limitation of an internal
-Vim function CR will keep the arguments, Esc with discard them.
-
-
-1.7.3 RUN make *csupport-run-make*
-
-The item 'make' runs the external make program.
-
-
-1.7.4 COMMAND LINE ARGUMENTS FOR make *csupport-run-make-args*
-
-The item 'command line arguments for make' calls an input dialog which asks
-for command line arguments for make. These arguments are forwarded to make
-when called by the item 'make'.
-
-
-1.7.5 SPLINT *csupport-run-splint*
-
-Splint is a tool for statically checking C programs (see http://www.splint.org).
-Of course it has to be installed in order to be used within Vim. The menu
-item 'Run->splint' will run the current buffer through splint.
-
-An error window will be opened if splint has something to complain about.
-Quickfix commands can now be used to jump to an error location. For easier
-navigation see tip under 'SAVE AND COMPILE' |csupport-run-buffer|.
-
-Splint has many options. Presumably the best way is to keep the options in an
-option file (~/.splintrc). For a quick try you can use the menu item
-'Run->cmd. line arg. for splint' to specify some buffer related options.
-
-When vim is started this plugin will check whether splint is executable. If
-not, the menu item will *NOT' be visible.
-
-
-1.7.6 CODECHECK *csupport-run-codecheck*
-
-CodeCheck (TM) is a commercial code analyzing tool produced by Abraxas
-Software, Inc. (www.abraxas-software.com).
-Of course it has to be installed in order to be used within Vim. The menu
-item 'Run->CodeCheck' will run the current buffer through CodeCheck.
-
-An error window will be opened if CodeCheck has something to complain about.
-Quickfix commands can now be used to jump to an error location. For easier
-navigation see tip under 'SAVE AND COMPILE' |csupport-run-buffer|.
-
-CodeCheck has many options. For a quick try you can use the menu item
-'Run->cmd. line arg. for CodeCheck' to specify some buffer related options.
-
-CodeCheck will be run with default options (see |csupport-custom-glob-vars|).
-The default options can be overwritten by placing a global variable in
-~/.vimrc , e.g.
-
- let g:C_CodeCheckOptions = "-K13 -Rmeyers"
-
-The default name for the executable is 'check'. There are other names in use
-on different platforms. The name can be changed by placing a global variable
-in ~/.vimrc , e.g.
-
- let g:C_CodeCheckExeName = "chknt.exe"
-
-When vim is started this plugin will check whether CodeCheck is executable. If
-not, the menu item will *NOT' be visible.
-
-
-1.7.7 INDENT *csupport-run-indent*
-
-The formatter 'indent' can be run over the whole buffer or a marked region.
-Before formatting the whole buffer this buffer will be saved to disk and you
-will be asked for a confirmation.
-
-Indent has many options. These are kept in the file '.indent.pro' in your home
-directory. See the indent manual for more information.
-
-
-1.7.8 HARDCOPY *csupport-run-hardcopy*
-
-Generates a PostScript file from the whole buffer or from a marked region.
-On a Windows system a printer dialog is displayed.
-
-The print header contains date and time for the current locale. The definition
-used is
-
- let s:C_Printheader = "%<%f%h%m%< %=%{strftime('%x %X')} Page %N"
-
-The current locale can be overwritten by changing the language, e.g.
-
- :language C
-
-or by setting a global variable in the file ~/.vimrc , e.g. :
-
- let g:C_Printheader = "%<%f%h%m%< %=%{strftime('%x %X')} SEITE %N"
-
-See :h printheader and :h strftime() for more details.
-
-
-1.7.9 REBUILD TEMPLATES *csupport-run-templates*
-
-After editing one or more template files a click on this item rereads the
-template files and rebuilds all templates.
-
-
-1.7.10 XTERM SIZE *csupport-run-xterm*
-
-The size of the xterm used for running a program (below) can be set by this
-menu item. The default is 80 columns with 24 lines.
-This feature is not available under Windows.
-
-
-1.7.11 OUTPUT REDIRECTION *csupport-run-output*
-
-Running a program can be done in one of three ways:
-(1) Run the program from the gVim command line.
- This is for interactive programs with little input and output.
-(2) Run the program and direct the output into a window with name "C-Output".
- The buffer and its content will disappear when the window is closed and
- reused otherwise.
- This is for non-interactive programs with little to very much output.
- You have unlimited line length, regex search, navigation, ...
- The tabstop value will be set to 8 for "C-Output".
-(3) Run the program in an xterm.
-
-The output method can be chosen from the menu item 'Run->output: ...'.
-This menu has three states:
-
- output: VIM->buffer->xterm
- output: BUFFER->xterm->vim
- output: XTERM->vim->buffer
-
-The first (uppercase) item shows the current method. The default is 'vim'.
-This can be changed by setting the variable g:C_OutputGvim to another value.
-Possible values are 'vim', 'buffer' and 'xterm' .
-
-The xterm defaults can be set in ~/.vimrc by the variable g:C_XtermDefaults .
-The default is "-fa courier -fs 12 -geometry 80x24" :
- font name : -fa courier
- font size : -fs 12
- terminal size : -geometry 80x24
-See 'xterm -help' for more options. Xterms are not available under Windows.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-1.8 'help' *csupport-help*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-The root menu item 'help' shows this plugin help in a help window. The help
-tags must have been generated with
- :helptags ~/.vim/doc
-
-==============================================================================
-2. USAGE WITHOUT GUI (Vim) *csupport-usage-vim*
-==============================================================================
-
-The frequently used constructs can be inserted with key mappings. The
-mappings are also described in the document c-hot-keys.pdf (reference card,
-part of this package).
-Hint: Typing speed matters. The combination of a leader ('\') and the
-following character(s) will only be recognized for a short time.
-The insert mode mappings start with ` (backtick).
-
-Legend: (i) insert mode, (n) normal mode, (v) visual mode
-
- -- Load / Unload C/C++ Support ----------------------------------------
-
- \lcs Load C/C++ Support Menus (n, GUI only)}
- \ucs Unload C/C++ Support Menus (n, GUI only)}
-
- -- Comments -----------------------------------------------------------
-
- \cl end-of-line comment (n,v,i)
- \cj adjust end-of-line comment(s) (n,v,i)
- \cs set end-of-line comment column (n)
- \c* code -> comment /* */ (n,v)
- \c/ code -> comment // (n,v)
- \co comment -> code (n,v)
- \cfr frame comment (n,i)
- \cfu function comment (n,i)
- \cme method description (n,i)
- \cca class description (n,i)
- \cd date (n,i)
- \ct date \& time (n,i)
-
- -- Statements ---------------------------------------------------------
-
- \sd do { } while (n,v,i)
- \sf for (n,i)
- \sfo for { } (n,v,i)
- \si if (n,i)
- \sif if { } (n,v,i)
- \sie if else (n,v,i)
- \sife if { } else { } (n,v,i)
- \sw while (n,i)
- \swh while { } (n,v,i)
- \ss switch (n,v,i)
- \sc case (n,i)
- \s{ { } (n,v,i)
-
- -- Preprocessor -------------------------------------------------------
-
- \p< #include <> (n,i)
- \p" #include "" (n,i)
- \pd #define (n,i)
- \pu #undef (n,i)
- \pie #if #else #endif (n,v,i)
- \pid #ifdef #else #endif (n,v,i)
- \pin #ifndef #else #endif (n,v,i)
- \pind #ifndef #def #endif (n,v,i)
- \pi0 #if 0 #endif (n,v,i)
- \pr0 remove #if 0 #endif (n)
- -- Idioms -------------------------------------------------------------
-
- \if function (n,v,i)
- \isf static function (n,v,i)
- \im main() (n,v,i)
- \i0 for( x=0; x<n; x+=1 ) (n,v,i)
- \in for( x=n-1; x>=0; x-=1 ) (n,v,i)
- \ie enum + typedef (n,i)
- \is struct + typedef (n,i)
- \iu union + typedef (n,i)
- \ip printf() (n,i)
- \isc scanf() (n,i)
- \ica p=calloc() (n,i)
- \ima p=malloc() (n,i)
- \isi sizeof() (n,v,i)
- \ias assert() (n,v,i)
- \ii open input file (n,i)
- \io open output file (n,i)
-
- -- Snippets -----------------------------------------------------------
-
- \nr read code snippet (n)
- \nw write code snippet (n,v)
- \ne edit code snippet (n)
- \np pick up prototype (n,v)
- \ni insert prototype(s) (n)
- \nc clear prototype(s) (n)
- \ns show prototype(s) (n)
-
- -- C++ ----------------------------------------------------------------
-
- \+m method implementation (n,i)
- \+c class (n,i)
- \+cn class (using new) (n,i)
- \+tm template method implementation (n,i)
- \+tc template class (n,i)
- \+tcn template class (using new) (n,i)
- \+tf template function (n,i)
- \+ec error class (n,i)
- \+tr try ... catch (n,v,i)
- \+ca catch (n,v,i)
- \+c. catch(...) (n,v,i)
-
- -- Run ----------------------------------------------------------------
-
- \rc save and compile (n)
- \rl link (n)
- \rr run (n)
- \ra set comand line arguments (n)
- \rm run make (n)
- \rg cmd. line arg. for make (n)
- \rp run splint (n)
- \ri cmd. line arg. for splint (n)
- \rk run CodeCheck (TM) (n)
- \re cmd. line arg. for CodeCheck (TM) (n)
- \rd run indent (n,v)
- \rh hardcopy buffer (n,v)
- \rs show plugin settings (n)
- \rx set xterm size (n, only Linux/UNIX & GUI)
- \ro change output destination (n)
- \rt rebuild templates (n)
-
-The hotkeys are defined in the file type plugin c.vim (part of this csupport
-plugin package) and described in the document c-hot-keys.pdf
-
-==============================================================================
-3. HOTKEYS *csupport-hotkeys*
-==============================================================================
-
-The following hotkeys are defined in normal, visual and insert mode:
-
- F9 compile and link
- Alt-F9 write buffer and compile
- Ctrl-F9 run executable
- Shift-F9 set command line arguments
-
- Shift-F2 switch between source files and header files
-
-Shift-F2 can be used to switch between source files and header files if the
-plugin a.vim is present. To suppress the creation of a new header file when
-switching from a source file the file ~/.vimrc should contain a line
-
- let g:alternateNoDefaultAlternate = 1
-
-A header file will only be opened if it already exists.
-
-The hotkeys are defined in the file type plugin c.vim .
-
-All hotkeys from the non-GUI mode also work for gVim (see |csupport-usage-vim|).
-
-==============================================================================
-4. CUSTOMIZATION *csupport-custom*
-==============================================================================
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-4.1 GLOBAL VARIABLES *csupport-custom-glob-vars*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-Several global variables are checked by the script to customize it:
-
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
- GLOBAL VARIABLE DEFAULT VALUE TAG (see below)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
- g:C_GlobalTemplateFile plugin_dir.'c-support/templates/Templates'
- g:C_LocalTemplateFile $HOME.'/.vim/c-support/templates/Templates'
- g:C_TemplateOverwrittenMsg 'yes'
-
- g:C_CodeSnippets plugin_dir."/c-support/codesnippets/"
- g:C_Dictionary_File ""
- g:C_LoadMenus "yes"
- g:C_MenuHeader "yes"
- g:C_OutputGvim "vim"
- g:C_XtermDefaults "-fa courier -fs 12 -geometry 80x24"
- g:C_Printheader "%<%f%h%m%< %=%{strftime('%x %X')} Page %N"
-
- Linux/UNIX:
- g:C_ObjExtension ".o"
- g:C_ExeExtension ""
- g:C_CCompiler "gcc"
- g:C_CplusCompiler "g++"
- Windows:
- g:C_ObjExtension ".obj"
- g:C_ExeExtension ".exe"
- g:C_CCompiler "gcc.exe"
- g:C_CplusCompiler "g++.exe"
- g:C_CFlags "-Wall -g -O0 -c"
- g:C_LFlags "-Wall -g -O0"
- g:C_Libs "-lm"
- g:C_LineEndCommColDefault 49
- g:C_CExtension "c"
- g:C_TypeOfH "cpp"
-
- g:C_CodeCheckExeName "check"
- g:C_CodeCheckOptions "-K13"
-
-The variable plugin_dir will automatically be set to one of the following values:
- $HOME.'/.vim/' for Linux/Unix
- $VIM.'/vimfiles/' for Windows
-
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-1. group: g:C_GlobalTemplateFile : Sets the master template file (see|csupport-templates|)
- g:C_LocalTemplateFile : Sets the local template file (see|csupport-templates|)
- g:C_TemplateOverwrittenMsg : message if template is overwritten
-
-2. group: g:C_CodeSnippets : The name of the code snippet directory
- (see |csupport-snippets|).
- g:C_Dictionary_File : The name(s) of the dictionary file(s) used for
- word completion (see also |csupport-dictionary|)
- g:C_Root : the name of the root menu of this plugin
- g:C_LoadMenus : Load menus and mappings ("yes", "no") at startup.
- g:C_MenuHeader : Switch the submenu header on/off.
- g:C_OutputGvim : when program is running output goes to the vim
- command line ("vim"), to a buffer ("buffer") or to
- an xterm ("xterm").
- g:C_XtermDefaults : the xterm defaults
- g:C_Printheader : hardcopy: definition of the page header
-
-3. group: g:C_CExtension : Extension of C files. Everything else is C++.
- g:C_TypeOfH : filetype of header files with extension 'h' (c,cpp)
- (see |csupport-comm-style|)
- g:C_CCompiler : The name of the C compiler.
- g:C_CplusCompiler : The name of the C++ compiler.
- g:C_CFlags : Compiler flags used for a compilation.
- g:C_LFlags : Compiler flags used for linkage.
- g:C_Libs : Libraries to link with.
- g:C_ObjExtension : C/C+ file extension for objects
- (leading point required if not empty)
- g:C_ExeExtension : C/C+ file extension for executables
- (leading point required if not empty)
- g:C_LineEndCommColDefault : Default starting column for end-of-line comments.
- g:C_CodeCheckExeName : The name of the CodeCheck (TM) executable
- (the default is 'check')
- g:C_CodeCheckOptions : Default options for CodeCheck (TM)
- (see |csupport-run-codecheck|).
-
-To override the default add appropriate assignments to ~/.vimrc .
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-4.2 THE ROOT MENU *csupport-custom-root-menu*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-The variable g:C_Root, if set (in ~/.vimrc or in ~/.gvimrc), gives the name of
-the single Vim root menu item in which the C/C++ submenus will be put. The
-default is
- '&C\/C\+\+.'
-Note the terminating dot. A single root menu can be used if the screen is
-limited or several plugins are used in parallel.
-
-If set to "", this single root menu item will not appear. Now all submenus
-are put into the Vim root menu. This is nice for beginners in a lab
-installation or for C-only programmers.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-4.3 SYSTEM-WIDE INSTALLATION *csupport-system-wide*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-A system-wide installation (one installation for all users) is done as
-follows.
-
-As *** SUPERUSER *** :
-
-(1) Find the Vim installation directory.
-The Vim ex command ':echo $VIM' gives '/usr/local/share/vim' or something like
-that. Beyond this directory you will find the Vim installation, e.g. in
-'/usr/local/share/vim/vim71' if Vim version 7.1 has been installed.
-
-(2) Create a new subdirectory 'vimfiles', e.g. '/usr/local/share/vim/vimfiles'.
-
-(3) Install C/C++ Support
-Copy the archive cvim.zip to this new directory and unpack it:
- unzip cvim.zip
-
-(4) Generate the help tags:
- :helptags $VIM/vimfiles/doc
-
-
-As *** USER *** :
-
-Create your private snippet directory:
-
- mkdir --parents ~/.vim/c-support/codesnippets
-
-You may want to copy the snippets comming with this plugin (in
-$VIM/vimfiles/c-support/codesnippets) into the new directory or to set a
-link to the global directory.
-
-Create your private template directory:
-
- mkdir --parents ~/.vim/c-support/template
-
-Create a private template file 'Templates' in this directory to overwrite some
-macros, e.g.
-
- *|AUTHOR|* = your name
- *|AUTHORREF|* = ...
- *|EMAIL|* = ...
- *|COMPANY|* = ...
- *|COPYRIGHT|* = ...
-
-You can also have local templates which overwrite the global ones. To suppress
-the messages in this case set a global variable in '~/.vimrc' :
-
- let g:C_TemplateOverwrittenMsg= 'no'
-
-The default is 'yes'.
-
-==============================================================================
-5. TEMPLATE FILES AND TAGS *csupport-templates*
-==============================================================================
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-5.1 TEMPLATE FILES *csupport-templates-files*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-Nearly all menu entries insert code snippets or comments. All these stuff is
-taken from template files and can be changed by the user to meet his
-requirements.
-
-The master template file is '$HOME/.vim/c-support/templates/Templates' for a
-user installation and '$VIM/vimfiles/c-support/templates/Templates' for a
-system-wide installation (see|csupport-system-wide|).
-
-The master template file starts with a macro section followed by templates for
-single menu items or better by including other template files grouping the
-templates according to the menu structure of this plugin. The master file
-could look like this:
-
- $
- $ =============================================================
- $ ========== USER MACROS ======================================
- $ =============================================================
- $
- *|AUTHOR|* = Dr. Fritz Mehner
- *|AUTHORREF|* = mn
- *|EMAIL|* = mehner@fh-swf.de
- *|COMPANY|* = FH Südwestfalen, Iserlohn
- *|COPYRIGHT|* = Copyright (c)*|YEAR|, |AUTHOR|*
- $
- $ =============================================================
- $ ========== FILE INCLUDES ====================================
- $ =============================================================
- $
- *|includefile|* = c.comments.template
- *|includefile|* = c.cpp.template
- *|includefile|* = c.idioms.template
- *|includefile|* = c.preprocessor.template
- *|includefile|* = c.statements.template
-
-Lines starting with a dollar sign are comments. The section starting
-with *|AUTHOR|* assigns values to predefined tags
-(see|csupport-templates-macros|) to personalize some templates. Other
-predefined tags with given default values can be used (e.g. *|YEAR|* ).
-
-User defined tags are possible. They have the following syntax:
-
- *|macroname|* = replacement
-
-A macroname starts with a letter (uppercase or lowercase) followed by zero or
-more letters, digits or underscores.
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-5.2 MACROS *csupport-templates-macros*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-The following macro names are predefined. The first group is used to
-personalize templates.
-
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
- PREDEFINED MACROS DEFAULT VALUE
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
-*|AUTHOR|* ""
-*|AUTHORREF|* ""
-*|EMAIL|* ""
-*|COMPANY|* ""
-*|PROJECT|* ""
-*|COPYRIGHTHOLDER|* ""
-*|includefile|* ""
-
-*|BASENAME|* filename without path and suffix
-*|DATE|* the preferred date representation for the current locale
- without the time
-*|FILENAME|* filename without path
-*|PATH|* path without filename
-*|SUFFIX|* filename suffix
-*|TIME|* the preferred time representation for the current locale
- without the date and the time zone or name or abbreviation
-*|YEAR|* the year as a decimal number including the century
-
-*|includefile|* can be used to include an additional template file. A file
-will be included only once. Commenting and uncommenting include macros is a
-simple way to switch between several sets of templates (see also
-|csupport-run-templates|). Overwriting existing macros and templates is
-possible.
-
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
- PREDEFINED TAGS
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
- <CURSOR> The cursor position after insertion of a template
- <SPLIT> The split point when inserting in visual mode
- (see|csupport-templates-definition|)
-
-A dependent template file can start with its own macro section. There is no
-need to have all user defined macros in the master file.
-When the first template definition is found (see below) macro definitions are
-no longer recognized.
-
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
- USER DEFINED FORMATS FOR DATE AND TIME *csupport-templates-date*
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
-The format for *|DATE|* ,*|TIME|* , and*|YEAR|* can be set by the user. The
-defaults are
- *|DATE|* '%x'
- *|TIME|* '%X'
- *|YEAR|* '%Y'
-See the manual page of the C function strftime() for the format. The accepted
-format depends on your system, thus this is not portable! The maximum length
-of the result is 80 characters.
-
-User defined formats can be set using the following global variables in
-~/.vimrc , e.g.
- let g:C_FormatDate = '%D'
- let g:C_FormatTime = '%H:%M'
- let g:C_FormatYear = 'year %Y'
-
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-5.3 TEMPLATES *csupport-templates-names*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
-5.3.1 Template names
-
-The template behind a menu entry is identified by a given name. The first part
-of the name identifies the menu, the second part identifies the item. The
-modes are also hard coded (see|csupport-templates-definition|for the use of
-<SPLIT>).
-
- TEMPLATE NAME MODES
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
- comment.end-of-line-comment normal visual
- comment.frame normal
- comment.function normal
- comment.method normal
- comment.class normal
- comment.file-description normal
- comment.keyword-bug normal
- comment.keyword-compiler normal
- comment.keyword-todo normal
- comment.keyword-tricky normal
- comment.keyword-warning normal
- comment.keyword-workaround normal
- comment.keyword-keyword normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-header-includes normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-macros normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-typedefs normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-data-types normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-class-defs normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-local-variables normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-prototypes normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-function-defs-exported normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-function-defs-local normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-class-implementations-exported normal
- comment.file-section-cpp-class-implementations-local normal
- comment.file-section-hpp-header-includes normal
- comment.file-section-hpp-macros normal
- comment.file-section-hpp-exported-typedefs normal
- comment.file-section-hpp-exported-data-types normal
- comment.file-section-hpp-exported-class-defs normal
- comment.file-section-hpp-exported-variables normal
- comment.file-section-hpp-exported-function-declarations normal
-
- cpp.method-implementation normal
- cpp.class normal
- cpp.class-using-new normal
- cpp.error-class normal
- cpp.template-method-implementation normal
- cpp.template-class normal
- cpp.template-class-using-new normal
- cpp.template-function normal
- cpp.operator-in normal
- cpp.operator-out normal
- cpp.try-catch normal visual
- cpp.catch normal visual
- cpp.catch-points normal visual
- cpp.extern normal visual
- cpp.open-input-file normal
- cpp.open-output-file normal
- cpp.namespace normal visual
-
- idioms.function normal visual
- idioms.function-static normal visual
- idioms.main normal visual
- idioms.enum normal visual
- idioms.struct normal visual
- idioms.union normal visual
- idioms.calloc normal
- idioms.malloc normal
- idioms.open-input-file normal
- idioms.open-output-file normal
- idioms.fprintf normal
- idioms.fscanf normal
-
- preprocessor.define normal
- preprocessor.undefine normal
- preprocessor.if-else-endif normal visual
- preprocessor.ifdef-else-endif normal visual
- preprocessor.ifndef-else-endif normal visual
- preprocessor.ifndef-def-endif normal visual
-
- statements.do-while normal visual
- statements.for normal
- statements.for-block normal visual
- statements.if normal
- statements.if-block normal visual
- statements.if-else normal visual
- statements.if-block-else normal visual
- statements.while normal
- statements.while-block normal visual
- statements.switch normal visual
- statements.case normal
- statements.block normal visual
-
-
-
-5.3.2 Template definition *csupport-templates-definition*
-
-A template definition starts with a template head line with the following
-syntax:
-
- == templatename == [ position == ]
-
-The templatename is one of the above template identifiers. The position
-attribute is optional. Possible attribute values are:
-
- above insert the template before the current line
- append append the template to the current line
- below insert the template below the current line
- insert insert the template at the cursor position
- start insert the template before the first line of the buffer
-
-An example:
-
- == comment.function ==
- /*
- * === FUNCTION =======================================================
- * Name: <CURSOR>
- * Description:
- * ======================================================================
- */
-
-The definition of a template ends at the next head line or at the end of the
-file.
-
-Templates for the visual mode can use <SPLIT>. The text before <SPLIT> will
-than be inserted above the marked area, the text after <SPLIT> will be
-inserted behind the marked area. An example:
-
- == statements.if-block-else ==
- if ( <CURSOR> ) {
- <SPLIT>} else {
- }
-
-If applied to the marked block
-
- xxxxxxxxxxx
- xxxxxxxxxxx
-
-this template yields
-
- if ( ) {
- xxxxxxxxxxx
- xxxxxxxxxxx
- } else {
- }
-
-The templates with a visual mode are shown in the table under
-|csupport-templates-names|.
-
-5.3.3 Template expansion *csupport-templates-expansion*
-
-There are additional ways to control the expansion of a template.
-
-USER INPUT
-----------
-If the usage of a yet undefined user macro starts with a question mark the
-user will be asked for the replacement first, e.g. with the following template
-
- == idioms.function ==
- void<CURSOR>
- *|?FUNCTION_NAME|* ( )
- {
- <SPLIT> return ;
- } /* ----- end of function*|FUNCTION_NAME|* ----- */
-
-The can specify the function name which then will be applied twice. If the
-macro was already in use the old value will be suggested as default.
-
-MACRO MANIPULATION
-------------------
-
-A macro expansion can be controlled by the following attributes
-
- :l change macro text to lowercase
- :u change macro text to uppercase
- :c capitalize macro text
- :L legalize name
-
-The include guard template is an example for the use of ':L' :
-
- == preprocessor.ifndef-def-endif ==
- #ifndef *|?BASENAME:L|_INC*
- #define *|BASENAME|_INC*
- <CURSOR><SPLIT>
- #endif // ----- #ifndef*|BASENAME|_INC* -----
-
-The base name of the file shall be used as part of the include guard name.
-The predefined macro*|BASENAME|* is used to ask for this part because this
-macro has already a defined value. That value can accepted or replaced by the
-user. For the filename 'test test++test.h' the legalized base name
-'TEST_TEST_TEST' will be suggested.
-
-Legalization means:
- - replace all whitespaces by underscores
- - replace all non-word characters by underscores
- - replace '+' and '-' by underscore
-
-
-==============================================================================
-6. C/C++ DICTIONARY *csupport-dictionary*
-==============================================================================
-
-The files
-
- c-c++-keywords.list
- k+r.list
- stl_index.list
-
-are a part of this plugin and can be used (together with your own lists) as
-dictionaries for automatic word completion. This feature is enabled by
-default. The default word lists are
-
- plugin_dir/c-support/wordlists/c-c++-keywords.list
- plugin_dir/c-support/wordlists/k+r.list
- plugin_dir/c-support/wordlists/stl_index.list
-
-The variable plugin_dir will automatically be set by the plugin to one of the
-following values:
- $HOME.'/.vim/' for Linux/Unix
- $VIM.'/vimfiles/' for Windows
-If you want to use an additional list MyC.list put the following lines into
- ~/.vimrc :
-
- let g:C_Dictionary_File = PLUGIN_DIR.'/c-support/wordlists/c-c++-keywords.list,'.
- \ PLUGIN_DIR.'/c-support/wordlists/k+r.list,'.
- \ PLUGIN_DIR.'/c-support/wordlists/stl_index.list,'.
- \ PLUGIN_DIR.'/c-support/wordlists/MyC.list'
-
-When in file ~/.vimrc the name PLUGIN_DIR has to be replaced by $HOME or
-$VIM (see above). Whitespaces in the pathnames have to be escaped with a
-backslash.
-The right side is a comma separated list of files. Note the point at the end
-of the first line (string concatenation) and the backslash in front of the
-second line (continuation line).
-You can use Vim's dictionary feature CTRL-X, CTRL-K (and CTRL-P, CTRL-N).
-
-
-==============================================================================
-7. EXTEND taglist.vim FOR make AND qmake *csupport-taglist*
-==============================================================================
-
-The use of the Vim plugin taglist.vim (Author: Yegappan Lakshmanan) is highly
-recommended. It uses the program ctags which generates tag files for 3 dozen
-languages (Exuberant Ctags, Darren Hiebert, http://ctags.sourceforge.net).
-With the following extensions the list of targets in a makefile can be shown
-in the taglist window.
-
-1) Append the file customization.ctags to the file $HOME/.ctags .
-
-2) Add the following lines (from customization.vimrc) to $HOME/.vimrc :
-
- "
- "-------------------------------------------------------------------
- " taglist.vim : toggle the taglist window
- " taglist.vim : define the title texts for make
- " taglist.vim : define the title texts for qmake
- "-------------------------------------------------------------------
- noremap <silent> <F11> <Esc><Esc>:Tlist<CR>
- inoremap <silent> <F11> <Esc><Esc>:Tlist<CR>
-
- let tlist_make_settings = 'make;m:makros;t:targets'
- let tlist_qmake_settings = 'qmake;t:SystemVariables'
-
- if has("autocmd")
- " ---------- qmake : set file type for *.pro ----------
- autocmd BufNewFile,BufRead *.pro set filetype=qmake
- endif " has("autocmd")
-
-3) restart vim/gvim
-
-The two maps will toggle the taglist window (hotkey F11) in all editing modes.
-The two assignments define the headings for the (q)make sections in the
-taglist window. The autocmd set the file type 'qmake' for the filename
-extension 'pro' (ctags needs this).
-
-==============================================================================
-8. SYNTAX BASED FOLDING *csupport-folding*
-==============================================================================
-
-Syntax based folding can be enabled by adding the following lines to the file
-'~/.vim/syntax/c.vim':
-
- syn region cBlock start="{" end="}" transparent fold
- set foldmethod=syntax
- " initially all folds open:
- set foldlevel=999
-
-You may have to create this file first. See |folding| for more information.
-
-==============================================================================
-9. WINDOWS PARTICULARITIES *csupport-windows*
-==============================================================================
-
-The plugin should go into the directory structure below the local
-installation directory $HOME/.vim/ for LINUX/UNIX and $VIM/vimfiles/ for
-Windows.
-The values of the two variables can be found from inside Vim:
- :echo $VIM
-or
- :echo $HOME
-
-Configuration files:
-
- LINUX/UNIX : $HOME/.vimrc and $HOME/.gvimrc
- Windows : $VIM/_vimrc and $VIM/_gvimrc
-
-Compiler settings:
-
-It could be necessary to add further settings for your compiler. To compile
-C++-programs using a Dev-C++ installation (http://www.bloodshed.net) the
-following item in $VIM/_vimrc is needed (depends on the Dev-C++ install
-directory):
-
- let g:C_CFlags = '-Wall -g -o0 -c -I c:\programs\dev-c++\include\g++'
-
-==============================================================================
-10. TROUBLESHOOTING *csupport-troubleshooting*
-==============================================================================
-
-* I do not see any new main menu item.
- - Was the archive extracted into the right directory?
-
-* How can I see what was loaded?
- - Use ':scriptnames' from the Vim command line.
-
-* No main menu item.
- - Loading of plugin files must be enabled. If not use
- :filetype plugin on
- This is the minimal content of the file '$HOME/.vimrc'. Create one if there
- is none, or better use customization.vimrc.
-
-* Most key mappings do not work.
- - They are defined in a filetype plugin in '$HOME/.vim/ftplugin/'. Use ':filetype'
- to check if filetype plugins are enabled. If not, add the line
- filetype plugin on
- to the file '~/.vimrc'.
-
-* Some hotkeys do not work.
- - The hotkeys might be in use by your graphical desktop environment.
- Under KDE Ctrl-F9 is the hotkey which let you switch to the 9. desktop.
- The key settings can usually be redefined.
-
-* Splint and/or CodeCheck menu item not visible.
- - The program is not installed or not found (path not set) or not executable.
-
-==============================================================================
-11. RELEASE NOTES *csupport-release-notes*
-==============================================================================
-See file c-support/doc/ChangeLog .
-
-==============================================================================
-vim:tw=78:noet:ts=2:ft=help:norl:
diff --git a/dot_vim/doc/haskellmode.txt b/dot_vim/doc/haskellmode.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 905349c..0000000
--- a/dot_vim/doc/haskellmode.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,456 +0,0 @@
-*haskellmode.txt* Haskell Mode Plugins 23/04/2009
-
-Authors:
- Claus Reinke <claus.reinke@talk21.com> ~
-
-Homepage:
- http://projects.haskell.org/haskellmode-vim
-
-CONTENTS *haskellmode*
-
- 1. Overview |haskellmode-overview|
- 1.1 Runtime Requirements |haskellmode-requirements|
- 1.2 Quick Reference |haskellmode-quickref|
- 2. Settings |haskellmode-settings|
- 2.1 GHC and web browser |haskellmode-settings-main|
- 2.2 Fine tuning - more configuration options |haskellmode-settings-fine|
- 3. GHC Compiler Integration |haskellmode-compiler|
- 4. Haddock Integration |haskellmode-haddock|
- 4.1 Indexing |haskellmode-indexing|
- 4.2 Lookup |haskellmode-lookup|
- 4.3 Editing |haskellmode-editing|
- 5. Hpaste Integration |haskellmode-hpaste|
- 6. Additional Resources |haskellmode-resources|
-
-==============================================================================
- *haskellmode-overview*
-1. Overview ~
-
- The Haskell mode plugins provide advanced support for Haskell development
- using GHC/GHCi on Windows and Unix-like systems. The functionality is
- based on Haddock-generated library indices, on GHCi's interactive
- commands, or on simply activating (some of) Vim's built-in program editing
- support in Haskell-relevant fashion. These plugins live side-by-side with
- the pre-defined |syntax-highlighting| support for |haskell| sources, and
- any other Haskell-related plugins you might want to install (see
- |haskellmode-resources|).
-
- The Haskell mode plugins consist of three filetype plugins (haskell.vim,
- haskell_doc.vim, haskell_hpaste.vim), which by Vim's |filetype| detection
- mechanism will be auto-loaded whenever files with the extension '.hs' are
- opened, and one compiler plugin (ghc.vim) which you will need to load from
- your vimrc file (see |haskellmode-settings|).
-
-
- *haskellmode-requirements*
-1.1 Runtime Requirements ~
-
- The plugins require a recent installation of GHC/GHCi. The functionality
- derived from Haddock-generated library indices also requires a local
- installation of the Haddock documentation for GHC's libraries (if there is
- no documentation package for your system, you can download a tar-ball from
- haskell.org), as well as an HTML browser (see |haddock_browser|). If you
- want to use the experimental hpaste interface, you will also need Wget.
-
- * GHC/GHCi ~
- Provides core functionality. http://www.haskell.org/ghc
-
- * HTML library documentation files and indices generated by Haddock ~
- These usually come with your GHC installation, possibly as a separate
- package. If you cannot get them this way, you can download a tar-ball
- matching your GHC version from http://www.haskell.org/ghc/docs/
-
- * HTML browser with basic CSS support ~
- For browsing Haddock docs.
-
- * Wget ~
- For interfacing with http://hpaste.org.
-
- Wget is widely available for modern Unix-like operating systems. Several
- ports also exist for Windows, including:
-
- - Official GNU Wget (natively compiled for Win32)
- http://www.gnu.org/software/wget/#downloading
-
- - UnxUtils Wget (natively compiled for Win32, bundled with other ported
- Unix utilities)
- http://sourceforge.net/projects/unxutils/
-
- - Cygwin Wget (emulated POSIX in Win32, must be run under Cygwin)
- http://cygwin.com/packages/wget/
-
- *haskellmode-quickref*
-1.2 Quick Reference ~
-
-|:make| load into GHCi, show errors (|quickfix| |:copen|)
-|_ct| create |tags| file
-|_si| show info for id under cursor
-|_t| show type for id under cursor
-|_T| insert type declaration for id under cursor
-|balloon| show type for id under mouse pointer
-|_?| browse Haddock entry for id under cursor
-|_?1| search Hoogle for id under cursor
-|_?2| search Hayoo! for id under cursor
-|:IDoc| {identifier} browse Haddock entry for unqualified {identifier}
-|:MDoc| {module} browse Haddock entry for {module}
-|:FlagReference| {s} browse Users Guide Flag Reference for section {s}
-|_.| qualify unqualified id under cursor
-|_i| add 'import <module>(<identifier>)' for id under cursor
-|_im| add 'import <module>' for id under cursor
-|_iq| add 'import qualified <module>(<identifier>)' for id under cursor
-|_iqm| add 'import qualified <module>' for id under cursor
-|_ie| make imports explit for import statement under cursor
-|_opt| add OPTIONS_GHC pragma
-|_lang| add LANGUAGE pragma
-|i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O| insert-mode completion based on imported ids (|haskellmode-XO|)
-|i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U| insert-mode completion based on documented ids (|haskellmode-XU|)
-|i_CTRL-N| insert-mode completion based on imported sources
-|:GHCi|{command/expr} run GHCi command/expr in current module
-
-|:GHCStaticOptions| edit static GHC options for this buffer
-|:DocSettings| show current Haddock-files-related plugin settings
-|:DocIndex| populate Haddock index
-|:ExportDocIndex| cache current Haddock index to a file
-|:HpasteIndex| Read index of most recent entries from hpaste.org
-|:HpastePostNew| Submit current buffer as a new hpaste
-
-
-==============================================================================
- *haskellmode-settings*
-2. Settings ~
-
- The plugins try to find their dependencies in standard locations, so if
- you're lucky, you will only need to set |compiler| to ghc, and configure
- the location of your favourite web browser. You will also want to make
- sure that |filetype| detection and |syntax| highlighting are on. Given the
- variety of things to guess, however, some dependencies might not be found
- correctly, or the defaults might not be to your liking, in which case you
- can do some more fine tuning. All of this configuration should happen in
- your |vimrc|.
->
- " enable syntax highlighting
- syntax on
-
- " enable filetype detection and plugin loading
- filetype plugin on
-<
-
- *haskellmode-settings-main*
-2.1 GHC and web browser ~
-
- *compiler-ghc* *ghc-compiler*
- To use the features provided by the GHC |compiler| plugin, use the
- following |autocommand| in your vimrc:
->
- au BufEnter *.hs compiler ghc
-<
- *g:ghc*
- If the compiler plugin can't locate your GHC binary, or if you have
- several versions of GHC installed and have a preference as to which binary
- is used, set |g:ghc|:
->
- :let g:ghc="/usr/bin/ghc-6.6.1"
-<
- *g:haddock_browser*
- The preferred HTML browser for viewing Haddock documentation can be set as
- follows:
->
- :let g:haddock_browser="/usr/bin/firefox"
-<
-
- *haskellmode-settings-fine*
-2.2 Fine tuning - more configuration options ~
-
- Most of the fine tuning is likely to happen for the haskellmode_doc.vim
- plugin, so you can check the current settings for this plugin via the
- command |:DocSettings|. If all the settings reported there are to your
- liking, you probably won't need to do any fine tuning.
-
- *g:haddock_browser_callformat*
- By default, the web browser|g:haddock_browser| will be started
- asynchronously (in the background) on Windows or when vim is running in a
- GUI, and synchronously (in the foreground) otherwise. These settings seem
- to work fine if you are using a console mode browser (eg, when editing in
- a remote session), or if you are starting a GUI browser that will launch
- itself in the background. But if these settings do not work for you, you
- can change the default browser launching behavior.
-
- This is controlled by |g:haddock_browser_callformat|. It specifies a
- format string which uses two '%s' parameters, the first representing the
- path of the browser to launch, and the second is the documentation URL
- (minus the protocol specifier, i.e. file://) passed to it by the Haddock
- plugin. For instance, to launch a GUI browser on Unix-like systems and
- force it to the background (see also |shellredir|):
->
- :let g:haddock_browser_callformat = '%s file://%s '.printf(&shellredir,'/dev/null').' &'
-<
- *g:haddock_docdir*
- Your system's installed Haddock documentation for GHC and its libraries
- should be automatically detected. If the plugin can't locate them, you
- must point |g:haddock_docdir| to the path containing the master index.html
- file for the subdirectories 'libraries', 'Cabal', 'users_guide', etc.:
->
- :let g:haddock_docdir="/usr/local/share/doc/ghc/html/"
-<
- *g:haddock_indexfiledir*
- The information gathered from Haddock's index files will be stored in a
- file called 'haddock_index.vim' in a directory derived from the Haddock
- location, or in $HOME. To configure another directory for the index file,
- use:
->
- :let g:haddock_indexfiledir="~/.vim/"
-<
- *g:wget*
- If you also want to try the experimental hpaste functionality, you might
- you need to set |g:wget| before the |hpaste| plugin is loaded (unless wget
- is in your PATH):
->
- :let g:wget="C:\Program Files\wget\wget.exe"
-<
-
- Finally, the mappings actually use|<LocalLeader>|behind the scenes, so if
- you have to, you can redefine|maplocalleader|to something other than '_'.
- Just remember that the docs still refer to mappings starting with '_', to
- avoid confusing the majority of users!-)
-
-==============================================================================
- *haskellmode-compiler* *ghc*
-3. GHC Compiler Integration ~
-
- The GHC |compiler| plugin sets the basic |errorformat| and |makeprg| to
- enable |quickfix| mode using GHCi, and provides functionality for show
- info (|_si|), show type (|_t| or mouse |balloon|), add type declaration
- (|_T|), create tag file (|_ct|), and insert-mode completion
- (|i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|) based on GHCi browsing of the current and imported
- modules.
-
- To avoid frequent calls to GHCi, type information is cached in Vim. The
- cache will be populated the first time a command depends on it, and will
- be refreshed every time a |:make| goes through without generating errors
- (if the |:make| does not succeed, the old types will remain available in
- Vim). You can also unconditionally force reloading of type info using
- |:GHCReload| (if GHCi cannot load your file, the type info will be empty).
-
-
- In addition to the standard|quickfix| commands, the GHC compiler plugin
- provides:
-
- *:GHCReload*
-:GHCReload Reload modules and unconditionally refresh cache of
- type info. Usually, |:make| is prefered, as that will
- refresh the cache only if GHCi reports no errors, and
- show the errors otherwise.
-
- *:GHCStaticOptions*
-:GHCStaticOptions Edit the static GHC options for the current buffer.
- Useful for adding hidden packages (-package ghc).
-
- *:GHCi*
-:GHCi {command/expr} Run GHCi commands/expressions in the current module.
-
- *_ct*
-_ct Create |tags| file for the current Haskell source
- file. This uses GHCi's :ctags command, so it will work
- recursively, but will only list tags for exported
- entities.
-
- *_opt*
-_opt Shows a menu of frequently used GHC compiler options
- (selecting an entry adds the option as a pragma to the
- start of the file). Uses popup menu (GUI) or :emenu
- and command-line completion (CLI).
-
- *_lang*
-_lang Shows a menu of the LANGUAGE options supported by GHC
- (selecting an entry adds the language as a pragma to
- the start of the file). Uses popup menu (GUI) or
- :emenu and command-line completion (CLI).
-
- *_si*
-_si Show extended information for the name under the
- cursor. Uses GHCi's :info command. Output appears in
- |preview-window| (when done, close with |:pclose|).
-
- *_t*
-_t Show type for the name under the cursor. Uses cached
- info from GHCi's :browse command.
-
- *_T*
-_T Insert type declaration for the name under the cursor.
- Uses cached info from GHCi's :browse command.
-
- *haskellmode-XO* *haskellmode-omni-completion*
-CTRL-X CTRL-O Standard insert-mode omni-completion based on the
- cached type info from GHCi browsing current and
- imported modules. Only names from the current and from
- imported modules are included (the completion menu
- also show the type of each identifier).
-
-==============================================================================
- *haskellmode-haddock* *haddock*
-4. Haddock Integration ~
-
- Haskell mode integrates with Haddock-generated HTML documentation,
- providing features such as navigating to the Haddock entry for the
- identifier under the cursor (|_?|), completion for the identifier under
- the cursor (|i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|), and adding import statements (|_i| |_im|
- |_iq| |_iqm|) or module qualifier (|_.|) for the identifier under the
- cursor.
-
- These commands operate on an internal Haddock index built from the
- platform's installed Haddock documentation for GHC's libraries. Since
- populating this index takes several seconds, it should be stored as a
- file called 'haddock_index.vim' in the directory specified by
- |g:haddock_indexfiledir|.
-
- Some commands present a different interface (popup menu or command-line
- completion) according to whether the current Vim instance is graphical or
- console-based (actually: whether or not the GUI is running). Such
- differences are marked below with the annotations (GUI) and (CLI),
- respectively.
-
- |:DocSettings| shows the settings for this plugin. If you are happy with
- them, you can call |:ExportDocIndex| to populate and write out the
- documentation index (should be called once for every new version of GHC).
-
- *:DocSettings*
-:DocSettings Show current Haddock-files-related plugin settings.
-
-
- *haskellmode-indexing*
-4.1 Indexing ~
-
- *:DocIndex*
-:DocIndex Populate the Haddock index from the GHC library
- documentation.
-
- *:ExportDocIndex*
-:ExportDocIndex Cache the current Haddock index to a file (populate
- index first, if empty).
-
-
- *haskellmode-lookup*
-4.2 Lookup ~
-
- *_?*
-_? Open the Haddock entry (in |haddock_browser|) for an
- identifier under the cursor, selecting full
- qualifications from a popup menu (GUI) or via
- command-line completion (CLI), if the identifier is
- not qualified.
-
- *_?1*
-_?1 Search Hoogle (using |haddock_browser|) for an
- identifier under the cursor.
-
-
- *_?2*
-_?2 Search Hayoo! (using |haddock_browser|) for an
- identifier under the cursor.
-
- *:IDoc*
-:IDoc {identifier} Open the Haddock entry for the unqualified
- {identifier} in |haddock_browser|, suggesting possible
- full qualifications.
-
- *:MDoc*
-:MDoc {module} Open the Haddock entry for {module} in
- |haddock_browser| (with command-line completion for
- the fully qualified module name).
-
- *:FlagReference*
-:FlagReference {s} Browse Users Guide Flag Reference for section {s}
- (with command-line completion for section headers).
-
-
- *haskellmode-editing*
-4.3 Editing ~
-
- *_.*
-_. Fully qualify the unqualified name under the cursor
- selecting full qualifications from a popup menu (GUI)
- or via command-line completion (CLI).
-
- *_iq* *_i*
-_i _iq Add 'import [qualified] <module>(<identifier>)'
- statement for the identifier under the cursor,
- selecting fully qualified modules from a popup menu
- (GUI) or via command-line completion (CLI), if the
- identifier is not qualified. This currently adds one
- import statement per call instead of merging into
- existing import statements.
-
- *_iqm* *_im*
-_im Add 'import [qualified] <module>' statement for the
- identifier under the cursor, selecting fully qualified
- modules from a popup menu (GUI) or via command-line
- completion (CLI), if the identifier is not qualified.
- This currently adds one import statement per call
- instead of merging into existing import statements.
-
- *_ie*
-_ie On an 'import <module>' line, in a correctly loadable
- module, temporarily comment out import and use :make
- 'not in scope' errors to explicitly list imported
- identifiers.
-
- *haskellmode-XU* *haskellmode-user-completion*
-CTRL-X CTRL-U User-defined insert mode name completion based on all
- names known to the Haddock index, including package
- names. Completions are presented in a popup menu which
- also displays the fully qualified module from which
- each entry may be imported.
-
- CamelCode shortcuts are supported, meaning that
- lower-case letters can be elided, using only
- upper-case letters and module qualifier separators (.)
- for disambiguation:
-
- pSL -> putStrLn
- C.E.t -> Control.Exception.t
- C.M.MP -> Control.Monad.MonadPlus
-
- To reduce unwanted matches, the first letter of such
- shortcuts and the first letter after each '.' have to
- match directly.
-
-==============================================================================
- *haskellmode-hpaste* *hpaste*
-5. Hpaste Integration ~
-
- This experimental feature allows browsing and posting to
- http://hpaste.org, a Web-based pastebin tailored for Haskell code.
-
-
- *:HpasteIndex*
-:HpasteIndex Read the most recent entries from hpaste.org. Show an
- index of the entries in a new buffer, where ',r' will
- open the current highlighted entry [and ',p' will
- annotate it with the current buffer].
-
- *:HpastePostNew*
-:HpastePostNew Submit current buffer as a new hpaste entry.
- [This, and ',p' above, are temporarily disabled,
- needs update to new hpaste.org layout]
-
-==============================================================================
- *haskellmode-resources*
-6. Additional Resources ~
-
- An quick screencast tour through of these plugins is available at:
-
- http://projects.haskell.org/haskellmode-vim/screencasts.html
-
- Other Haskell-related Vim plugins can be found here:
-
- http://www.haskell.org/haskellwiki/Libraries_and_tools/Program_development#Vim
-
- Make sure to read about Vim's other program-editing features in its online
- |user-manual|. Also have a look at Vim tips and plugins at www.vim.org -
- two other plugins I tend to use when editing Haskell are AlignPlugin.vim
- (to line up regexps for definitions, keywords, comments, etc. in
- consecutive lines) and surround.vim (to surround text with quotes,
- brackets, parentheses, comments, etc.).
-
-==============================================================================
- vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:
diff --git a/dot_vim/doc/imaps.txt b/dot_vim/doc/imaps.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 087b3db..0000000
--- a/dot_vim/doc/imaps.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,116 +0,0 @@
- IMAP -- A fluid replacement for :imap
- *imaps.txt*
- Srinath Avadhanula <srinath AT fastmail DOT fm>
-
-
-
- Abstract
- ========
-This plugin provides a function IMAP() which emulates vims |:imap| function. The
-motivation for providing this plugin is that |:imap| suffers from problems
-which get increasingly annoying with a large number of mappings.
-
-Consider an example. If you do >
- imap lhs something
-
-
-then a mapping is set up. However, there will be the following problems:
-1. The 'ttimeout' option will generally limit how easily you can type the lhs.
- if you type the left hand side too slowly, then the mapping will not be
- activated.
-
-2. If you mistype one of the letters of the lhs, then the mapping is deactivated
- as soon as you backspace to correct the mistake.
-
-3. The characters in lhs are shown on top of each other. This is fairly
- distracting. This becomes a real annoyance when a lot of characters initiate
- mappings.
-
-This script provides a function IMAP() which does not suffer from these
-problems.
-
-
-
- *imaps.txt-toc*
-|im_1| Using IMAP
-
-================================================================================
-Viewing this file
-
-This file can be viewed with all the sections and subsections folded to ease
-navigation. By default, vim does not fold help documents. To create the folds,
-press za now. The folds are created via a foldexpr which can be seen in the
-last section of this file.
-
-See |usr_28.txt| for an introduction to folding and |fold-commands| for key
-sequences and commands to work with folds.
-
-================================================================================
-Using IMAP *im_1* *imaps-usage*
-
-
-
-Each call to IMAP is made using the syntax: >
- call IMAP (lhs, rhs, ft [, phs, phe])
-
-
-This is equivalent to having <lhs> map to <rhs> for all files of type <ft>.
-
-Some characters in the <rhs> have special meaning which help in cursor placement
-as described in |imaps-placeholders|. The optional arguments define these
-special characters.
-
-Example One: >
- call IMAP ("bit`", "\\begin{itemize}\<cr>\\item <++>\<cr>\\end{itemize}<++>", "tex")
-
-
-This effectively sets up the map for "bit`" whenever you edit a latex file. When
-you type in this sequence of letters, the following text is inserted: >
- \begin{itemize}
- \item *
- \end{itemize}<++>
-
-where * shows the cursor position. The cursor position after inserting the text
-is decided by the position of the first "place-holder". Place holders are
-special characters which decide cursor placement and movement. In the example
-above, the place holder characters are <+ and +>. After you have typed in the
-item, press <C-j> and you will be taken to the next set of <++>'s. Therefore by
-placing the <++> characters appropriately, you can minimize the use of movement
-keys.
-
-Set g:Imap_UsePlaceHolders to 0 to disable placeholders altogether.
-
-Set g:Imap_PlaceHolderStart and g:Imap_PlaceHolderEnd to something else if you
-want different place holder characters. Also, b:Imap_PlaceHolderStart and
-b:Imap_PlaceHolderEnd override the values of g:Imap_PlaceHolderStart and
-g:Imap_PlaceHolderEnd respectively. This is useful for setting buffer specific
-place holders.
-
-Example Two: You can use the <C-r> command to insert dynamic elements such as
-dates. >
- call IMAP ('date`', "\<c-r>=strftime('%b %d %Y')\<cr>", '')
-
-
-
-With this mapping, typing date` will insert the present date into the file.
-
-================================================================================
-About this file
-
-This file was created automatically from its XML variant using db2vim. db2vim is
-a python script which understands a very limited subset of the Docbook XML 4.2
-DTD and outputs a plain text file in vim help format.
-
-db2vim can be obtained via anonymous CVS from sourceforge.net. Use
-
-cvs -d:pserver:anonymous@cvs.vim-latex.sf.net:/cvsroot/vim-latex co db2vim
-
-Or you can visit the web-interface to sourceforge CVS at:
-http://cvs.sourceforge.net/cgi-bin/viewcvs.cgi/vim-latex/db2vim/
-
-The following modelines should nicely fold up this help manual.
-
-vim:ft=help:fdm=expr:nowrap
-vim:foldexpr=getline(v\:lnum-1)=~'-\\{80}'?'>2'\:getline(v\:lnum-1)=~'=\\{80}'?'>1'\:getline(v\:lnum)=~'=\\{80}'?'0'\:getline(v\:lnum)=~'-\\{80}'?'1'\:'='
-vim:foldtext=substitute(v\:folddashes.substitute(getline(v\:foldstart),'\\s*\\*.*',"",""),'^--','--\ \ \ \ ','')
-================================================================================
diff --git a/dot_vim/doc/latex-suite-quickstart.txt b/dot_vim/doc/latex-suite-quickstart.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 8c18b72..0000000
--- a/dot_vim/doc/latex-suite-quickstart.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,448 +0,0 @@
- A (very) quick introduction to Latex-Suite
- *latex-suite-quickstart.txt*
- Srinath Avadhanula <srinath AT fastmail DOT fm>
-
-
-
- Abstract
- ========
-Latex-Suite is a comprehensive set of scripts to aid in editing, compiling and
-viewing LaTeX documents. A thorough explanation of the full capabilities of
-Latex-Suite is described in the user manual. This guide on the other hand,
-provides a quick 30-45 minute running start to some of the more commonly used
-functionalities of Latex-Suite.
-
- *latex-suite-quickstart.txt-toc*
-|lq_1| Using this tutorial
-|lq_2| Inserting a template
-|lq_3| Inserting a package
-|lq_4| Inserting an Environment
-|lq_5| A few keyboard shortcuts
-|lq_6| Folding in Latex-Suite
-|lq_7| Inserting a Reference
-|lq_8| Compiling a document
- |lq_8_1| Debugging LaTeX source files
-|lq_9| Viewing DVI files
- |lq_9_1| Performing forward searches
- |lq_9_2| Performing inverse searches
-|lq_10| Conclusions
-
-================================================================================
-Viewing this file
-
-This file can be viewed with all the sections and subsections folded to ease
-navigation. By default, vim does not fold help documents. To create the folds,
-press za now. The folds are created via a foldexpr which can be seen in the
-last section of this file.
-
-See |usr_28.txt| for an introduction to folding and |fold-commands| for key
-sequences and commands to work with folds.
-
-================================================================================
-Using this tutorial *lq_1* *lq_a_bc*
- *lsq-using-tutorial*
-
-
-
-This tutorial assumes that you have vim version 6.1+ installed on your machine.
-To check, open vim and type >
- :ver
-You will see the version in the first line of the output. Get the latest vim
-version from http://vim.sf.net |lq_u_1|.
-
-Assuming you have Vim 6.1+ already up and running, follow the instructions here
-|lq_u_2| to set up Latex-Suite. Remember to make sure your 'grepprg' setting of
-Vim works.
-
-Good, now you are all set to start the tutorial. Since this tutorial aims to
-explain the newbie-friendly version of Latex-Suite, it needs some GUI
-functionality. Therefore, at least for this tutorial, open the gui version of
-vim. (On MS windows, this is the default). Open up this help file in either the
-same gvim session in a split window or in a different session and follow the
-(friendly) instructions.
-
-================================================================================
-Inserting a template *lq_2* *lq_a_bd*
- *lsq-inserting-template*
-
-
-
-Start up gvim and begin editing a new file. >
- e newfile.tex
-If the installation went well, you should see a new set of menus appear. Goto
-Tex-Suite > Templates. You will see a number of templates to choose from. For
-now, choose to insert a template for an article. You should get the following in
-the main vim window (after possibly a hit-enter prompt). >
-
- 1 % File: sample.tex
- 2 % Created: Sun Jun 22 04:00 PM 2003 P
- 3 % Last Change: Sun Jun 22 04:00 PM 2003 P
- 4 %
- 5 \documentclass[a4paper]{article}
- 6 \begin{document}
- 7
- 8 \end{document}
- 9
- 10 ~
- 11 ~
- 12 ~
- 13 ~
- -- INSERT -- 7,1 All
-
-
-
-The cursor is left on line 7 (just after the \begin{document} line) from where
-you can start typing straight away. Trying to lessen movement is a recurring
-theme in Latex-Suite.
-
-================================================================================
-Inserting a package *lq_3* *lq_a_be*
- *lsq-lsq-inserting-package*
-
-
-
-Assume that we are writing a mathematical paper and we want to use the popular
-amsmath package. We will use some functionality which Latex-Suite provides
-specifically for including LaTeX packages, providing options etc. Navigate to
-before the \begin{document} line (The portion of the document before the
-\begin{document} is called the _preamble_ in LaTeX). On an empty line in the
-preamble, type the single word amsmath and then press <F5> in normal mode. The
-line will change to >
- \usepackage[]{amsmath}<++>
-with the cursor positioned conviniently between the []'s. For now, do not worry
-about the trailing <++> at the end of this line. Assume we want to provide the
-sumlimits options to amsmath. You can either type in this option manually, or
-choose from a menu of package options which Latex-Suite automatically creates
-when you insert a package using <F5>. With the cursor still placed between the
-[], goto TeX-Suite > Packages > amsmath Options. Choose the sumlimits option.
-The package line should get converted to: >
- \usepackage[sumlimits,]{amsmath}<++>
-
-
-with the cursor before ]. Press <C-j> in insert mode. You will see the cursor
-jump to the end of the package line and the trailing <++> will dissapear. What
-just happened?! You had your first taste of _Placeholders_. Read more about them
-(later) here |lq_u_3|. In short, pressing <C-j> in insert mode takes you to the
-next <++> in the text.
-
-================================================================================
-Inserting an Environment *lq_4* *lq_a_bf*
- *lsq-insert-environment*
-
-
-
-Now let us type in a simple formula in LaTeX. Move back to the body of the
-document (The portion of the document between \begin{document} and
-\end{document} is called the body). Type in a few simple sentences and then on
-an empty line, type the single word eqnarray. Escape to normal mode and press
-<F5>. (Remember: <F5> is very useful!) This time, the line will change to: >
- \begin{eqnarray}
- \label{}<++>
- \end{eqnarray}<++>
-<with the cursor between the {}. Enter a label. We will use eqn:euler. After
-typing in eqn:euler, press <C-j>. This will take you outside the curly-braces.
-Another time you used a Placeholder!
-
-================================================================================
-A few keyboard shortcuts *lq_5* *lq_a_bg*
- *lsq-keyboard-shortcuts*
-
-
-
-Now to type in the famous Euler formula. Our aim is to type >
- e^{j\pi} + 1 &=& 0
-Instead of typing this blindly, let us use a few shortcuts to reduce movement.
-Start out by typing e^. Now instead of typing {, type another ^. You will see
-the e^^ change instantly to e^{}<++> with the cursor between {}'s. (The ^^
-changed to ^{}<++>.) Continue with the following sequence of letters: j`p. This
-will change instantly to j\pi. (The `p changed to \pi.) Having typed in all we
-need to type between the {}'s, press <C-j>. You will pop back out of the
-curly-braces. Continue typing the rest of the formula. You can use == as a
-shortcut for &=&. Latex-Suite provides a large number of such shortcuts which
-should making typing much more fun and fast if you get acquainted with them. A
-list is provided here |lq_u_4|. Definitely spend some time getting a feel for
-them. Most of them are pretty intuitive like `/ for \frac{}{}, `8 for \infty
-etc.
-
-In order to understand the next section better, it will be helpful to have one
-more \label. Lets use the handy <F5> key to insert another equation. This time
-something simple like the following will do: >
- \begin{eqnarray}
- \label{eqn:simple}
- 1 + 1 = 2
- \end{eqnarray}
-
-
-================================================================================
-Folding in Latex-Suite *lq_6* *lq_a_bh* *lsq-folding*
-
-
-
-Okay, we have typed enough. At this stage, hopefully, your file is looking
-something like this: >
-
- 1 % File: sample.tex
- 2 % Created: Sun Jun 22 04:00 PM 2003 P
- 3 % Last Change: Mon Dec 15 07:00 PM 2003
- 4 %
- 5 \documentclass[a4paper]{article}
- 6
- 7 \usepackage[sumlimits,]{amsmath}
- 8
- 9 \begin{document}
- 10 \begin{eqnarray}
- 11 \label{eqn:euler}
- 12 e^{j\pi} + 1 &=& 0
- 13 \end{eqnarray}
- 14 This is the famous euler equation. I
- 15 will type another equation, just as
- 16 true:
- 17 \begin{eqnarray}
- 18 \label{eqn:simple}
- 19 1 + 1 &=& 2
- 20 \end{eqnarray}
- 21 This is my contribution to mathematics.
- 22 \end{document}
-
-In normal mode, press \rf. This will fold up the entire file and you should see
-the file looking as below: >
-
- 1 % File: sample.tex
- 2 % Created: Sun Jun 22 04:00 PM 2003 P
- 3 % Last Change: Mon Dec 15 07:00 PM 2003
- 4 %
- 5 +-- 4 lines: Preamble: \documentclass[a4paper]{article} -----
- 9 \begin{document}
- 10 +-- 4 lines: eqnarray (eqn:euler) \label{eqn:euler} -----------
- 14 This is the famous euler equation. I
- 15 will type another equation, just as
- 16 true:
- 10 +-- 4 lines: eqnarray (eqn:simple) \label{eqn:simple} ---------
- 21 This is my contribution to mathematics.
- 22 \end{document}
-
-What has happened is that Latex-Suite folded away blocks of LaTeX code into
-folded regions. You can open and close folds by using the command za in normal
-mode.
-
-================================================================================
-Inserting a Reference *lq_7* *lq_a_bi*
- *lsq-inserting-reference*
-
-
-
-A necessary part of LaTeX editing is referencing equations, figures,
-bibliographic entries etc. This is done with the \ref and the \cite commands.
-Latex-Suite provides an easy way to do this. Somewhere in the body of the
-document, type in the following sentence >
- This is a reference to (\ref{}).
-With the cursor between the {} press <F9> in insert mode. Your vim session will
-sprout two new windows and it should look like below: >
-
- 9 \begin{document}
- 10 +-- 4 lines: eqnarray (eqn:euler) : \label{eqn:euler}-----------------------
- 14 This is the famous euler equation. I
- 15 will type another equation, just as
- 16 true:
- 17 +-- 4 lines: eqnarray (eqn:simple) : \label{eqn:simple}---------------------
- 21 This is my contribution to mathematics.
- 22 This is a reference to (\ref{}&lt;++&gt;)&lt;++&gt;
- 23 \end{document}
- ~
- ~
- ~
- test.tex [+] 22,29 Bot
- test.tex|11| \label{eqn:euler}
- test.tex|18| \label{eqn:simple}
- ~
- ~
- ~
- [Error List] 1,1 All
- 7 \usepackage[sumlimits,]{amsmath}
- 8
- 9 \begin{document}
- 10 \begin{eqnarray}
- 11 \label{eqn:euler}
- 12 e^{j\pi} + 1 &=& 0
- 13 \end{eqnarray}
- 14 This is the famous euler equation. I
- 15 will type another equation, just as
- 16 true:
- test.tex [Preview][+] 11,2-5 46%
-
-
-
-The cursor will relocate to the middle window which shows all \labels found in
-all the .tex file in the current directory. You can scroll up and down in the
-middle window till you reach the reference you want to insert. Notice how when
-you scroll in the middle window, the bottom "Preview" window scrolls
-automatically to show you the location of the current selection. This helps you
-identify the reference with greater ease because often times, \labels are not
-descriptive enough or there might be too many of them. To insert the reference,
-just position the cursor on the relevant line in the middle window and press
-<enter>. The line which you were editing will change to: >
- This is a reference to (\ref{eqn:euler})
-<and the bottom windows close automatically.
-
-The <F9> key also works for inserting \cite commands to reference bibliographich
-entries, inserting file names for the \inputgraphics command and just plain
-searching for words. Click here |lq_u_5| for more information.
-
-================================================================================
-Compiling a document *lq_8* *lq_a_bj*
- *lsq-compiling*
-
-|lq_8_1| Debugging LaTeX source files
-
-
-Great! We have just created a small latex file. The next step is to make the
-latex compiler create a .dvi file from it. Compiling via latex-suite is simple.
-Goto normal mode and press \ll (replace \ with whatever mapleader setting you
-have). This will call the latex compiler. If all goes well, then the focus
-should return to the vim window.
-
-Nothing happend? Ouch! You might need to do some additional settings as
-described here. |lq_u_6|
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Debugging LaTeX source files *lq_8_1* *lq_a_bk*
- *lsq-debugging*
-
-To illustrate the debugging procedure, let's create a few mistakes in the file.
-Insert the following ``mistakes'' in the file: >
- This is a $\mistake$.
- And this is $\another$
-Now press \ll again. This time you will notice that after compilation finishes,
-the cursor automatically lands on $\mistake$. In addition, 2 new windows will
-appear as shown here:
-
-The middle window is an _Error List_ window showing you the errors which the
-latex compiler found. Th bottom window is a _Log Preview_ window, which shows
-you the context of the error made by displaying the relevant portion of the .log
-file created during the latex compilation procedure. Jump to the _Error List_
-window and try scrolling around in it using either the j, k keys or the arrow
-keys. You will notice that the _Log Preview_ window scrolls automatically to
-retain the context of the error you are currently located on. If you press
-<enter> on any line, you will see the cursor jump to the location of the error.
-Latex-Suite tries to guess the column location as best as it can so you can
-continue typing straight away.
-Having got a taste for compiling, proceed by deleting the erroneous lines and
-re-compiling.
-
-The Latex-Suite compiler is capable of much more including selectively filtering
-out common errors which you might want to ignore for the moment, compiling parts
-of a document, setting levels of verbosity in the compiler output etc. See here
-|lq_u_7| for more.
-
-================================================================================
-Viewing DVI files *lq_9* *lq_a_bl*
- *lsq-viewing-dvi*
-
-|lq_9_1| Performing forward searches
-|lq_9_2| Performing inverse searches
-
-
-Now that you have compiled your first latex source, its time to view it. Again,
-this should be pretty simple. Press \lv in normal mode. Depending on your
-platform, a DVI viewer program should open up and display the dvi file generated
-in compilation step previously.
-
-Nothing happend? Ouch! You might need to do some additional settings as
-described here. |lq_u_8|
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Performing forward searches *lq_9_1* *lq_a_bm*
- *lsq-quick-forward-searching*
-
-If you are using a modern DVI viewer, then it is possible to do what is called
-forward and inverse searching. However, you will need to customize the standard
-Latex-Suite distribution in order to utilize this functionality. Type in the
-following on the command line: >
- :let g:Tex_CompileRule_dvi = 'latex -src-specials -interaction=nonstopmode $*'
- :TCTarget dvi
-
-
-Now recompile the latex file by pressing \ll. This time, instead of pressing \lv
-to view the file, press \ls from within the tex file. If the DVI viewer supports
-forward searching (most of them do), then the viewer will actually display the
-portion of the DVI file corresponding to the location where you were editing the
-tex file.
-
-NOTE: The reason Latex-Suite does not have this setting by default is that on
- some systems this causes unpredictable results in the DVI output. If you
- find the DVI output satisfactory, then you can insert the first of the 2
- lines above into your $VIM/ftplugin/tex.vim file. $VIM is ~/vimfiles for
- windows and ~/.vim for *nix machines.
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Performing inverse searches *lq_9_2* *lq_a_bn*
- *lsq-quick-inverse-searching*
-
-Most DVI viewers also support inverse searching, whereby you can make the DVI
-viewer ask vim to display the tex source corresponding to the DVI file being
-shown. This is extremeley helpful while proofreading large documents.
-
-Simply double-click anywhere in the viewer window. If the viewer supports it,
-then it will attempt to open an editor window at the location corresponding to
-where you double-clicked. On *nix platforms, Latex-Suite attempts to start the
-viewer program in such a way that it already knows to use vim to open the tex
-source. Thus you should see a vim window open up showing the tex file. However,
-if there is an error, or some other program is used, you will need to tell the
-viewer program to use gvim as the editor. On windows platforms, if you use the
-commonly available yap viewer (available as part of the miktex distribution),
-then this option can be set from View > Options > Inverse Search. In the Command
-line: window, write >
- "C:\Program Files\vim\vim61\gvim" -c ":RemoteOpen +%l %f"
-(Customize the path according to where you have installed gvim). If you double
-click in the view pane now, you will see gvim start up and take you to the
-relevant portion of the tex file.
-
-================================================================================
-Conclusions *lq_10* *lq_a_bo*
- *lsq-conclusions*
-
-
-
-Thats all folks! By now, you should know enough of the basic functions of
-latex-suite. Ofcourse, latex-suite is capable of much, much more such as
-compiling files multiple times to resolve changed labels, compiling
-dependencies, handling user packages and more. To get a feel for that, you will
-need to take a look at the Latex-Suite user manual. |lq_u_9|
-
-================================================================================
-URLs used in this file
-
-*lq_u_1* : http://vim.sf.net
-*lq_u_2* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net/index.php?subject=download&title=Download
-*lq_u_3* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net/documentation/latex-suite/latex-macros.html
-*lq_u_4* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net/documentation/latex-suite/auc-tex-mappings.html
-*lq_u_5* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net/documentation/latex-suite/latex-completion.html
-*lq_u_6* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net/index.php?subject=faq&title=FAQ#faq-2
-*lq_u_7* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net/documentation/latex-suite/latex-compiling.html
-*lq_u_8* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net/index.php?subject=faq&title=FAQ#faq-3
-*lq_u_9* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net/index.php?subject=manual&title=Manual#user-manual
-
-================================================================================
-About this file
-
-This file was created automatically from its XML variant using db2vim. db2vim is
-a python script which understands a very limited subset of the Docbook XML 4.2
-DTD and outputs a plain text file in vim help format.
-
-db2vim can be obtained via anonymous CVS from sourceforge.net. Use
-
-cvs -d:pserver:anonymous@cvs.vim-latex.sf.net:/cvsroot/vim-latex co db2vim
-
-Or you can visit the web-interface to sourceforge CVS at:
-http://cvs.sourceforge.net/cgi-bin/viewcvs.cgi/vim-latex/db2vim/
-
-The following modelines should nicely fold up this help manual.
-
-vim:ft=help:fdm=expr:nowrap
-vim:foldexpr=getline(v\:lnum-1)=~'-\\{80}'?'>2'\:getline(v\:lnum-1)=~'=\\{80}'?'>1'\:getline(v\:lnum)=~'=\\{80}'?'0'\:getline(v\:lnum)=~'-\\{80}'?'1'\:'='
-vim:foldtext=substitute(v\:folddashes.substitute(getline(v\:foldstart),'\\s*\\*.*',"",""),'^--','\ \ \ \ \ \ ','')
-================================================================================
diff --git a/dot_vim/doc/latex-suite.txt b/dot_vim/doc/latex-suite.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index a44cd9b..0000000
--- a/dot_vim/doc/latex-suite.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,3418 +0,0 @@
- Latex-Suite Reference
- *latex-suite.txt*
- Srinath Avadhanula <srinath AT fastmail DOT fm>
- Mikolaj Machowski <mikmach AT wp DOT pl>
-
-
-
- Abstract
- ========
-Latex-Suite attempts to provide a comprehensive set of tools to view, edit and
-compile LaTeX documents in Vim. Together, they provide tools starting from
-macros to speed up editing LaTeX documents to functions for forward searching
-.dvi documents. Latex-Suite has been possible because of the contributions of
-many people. Please see latex-suite-credits [|ls_a_dU|] for a list of people who
-have helped.
-
-Latex-Suite is released under the Vim charityware license. For license and
-conditions of use look at |copyright|. Replace all occurrences of ``Vim'' with
-``Latex-Suite''. The current copyright holders of Latex-Suite are Srinath
-Avadhanula and Mikolaj Machowski.
-
-Homepage: http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net |ls_u_1|
-
-
-
- *latex-suite.txt-toc*
-|ls_1| Installation and recommended Settings
-|ls_2| Inserting Templates
-|ls_3| Latex-Suite Macros
- |ls_3_1| Environment Mappings
- |ls_3_2| Command Mappings
- |ls_3_3| Font Mappings
- |ls_3_4| Section Mappings
- |ls_3_5| Greek Letter Mappings
- |ls_3_6| Auc-Tex Key Bindings
- |ls_3_7| Diacritics
- |ls_3_8| BibTeX Shortcuts
- |ls_3_9| Smart Key Mappings
- |ls_3_10| Alt Key Macros
- |ls_3_11| Custom Macros
- |ls_3_12| Making your own Macros via IMAP()
-|ls_4| Package Handling
- |ls_4_1| Inserting package commands
- |ls_4_2| Actions taken for supported packages
- |ls_4_3| Automatic Package detection
- |ls_4_4| Writing supporting for a package
-|ls_5| Latex Completion
- |ls_5_1| Latex-Suite completion example
- |ls_5_2| Latex-Suite \ref completion
- |ls_5_3| Latex-Suite \cite completion
- |ls_5_4| Latex-Suite filename completion
- |ls_5_5| Custom command completion
-|ls_6| LaTeX Compiling
- |ls_6_1| Setting Compilation rules
- |ls_6_2| Handling dependencies in compilation
- |ls_6_3| Compiling multiple times
- |ls_6_4| Customizing the compiler output
- |ls_6_5| Compiling parts of a file
-|ls_7| Latex Viewing and Searching
- |ls_7_1| Setting Viewing rules
- |ls_7_2| Forward Searching DVI documents
- |ls_7_3| Inverse Searching
-|ls_8| Latex Folding
- |ls_8_1| Default Folding Scheme in Latex-Suite
- |ls_8_2| Customizing what to fold
- |ls_8_3| Editing the folding.vim file directly
-|ls_9| Multiple file LaTeX projects
- |ls_9_1| Latex-Suite project settings
- |ls_9_2| Specifying which file to compile
-|ls_10| Latex-Suite Commands and Maps
- |ls_10_1| Latex-Suite Maps
- |ls_10_2| Latex Suite Commands
-|ls_11| Customizing Latex-Suite
- |ls_11_1| General Settings
- |ls_11_2| Place-Holder Customization
- |ls_11_3| Macro Customization
- |ls_11_4| Smart Key Customization
- |ls_11_5| Latex Completion Customization
- |ls_11_6| Compiler Customization
- |ls_11_7| Viewer Customization
- |ls_11_8| Menu Customization
- |ls_11_9| Folding Customization
- |ls_11_10| Package Handling Customization
-|ls_12| Credits
-
-================================================================================
-Viewing this file
-
-This file can be viewed with all the sections and subsections folded to ease
-navigation. By default, vim does not fold help documents. To create the folds,
-press za now. The folds are created via a foldexpr which can be seen in the
-last section of this file.
-
-See |usr_28.txt| for an introduction to folding and |fold-commands| for key
-sequences and commands to work with folds.
-
-================================================================================
-Installation and recommended Settings *ls_1* *ls_a_bc*
- *recommended-settings*
-
-
-
-If you are reading this, it most probably means that you have already installed
-Latex-Suite and the help files. If this is not the case, follow the detailed
-instructions on Latex-Suite's download page |ls_u_2|.
-
-Make sure that you create a few necessary settings in your ~/.vimrc. >
-
- " REQUIRED. This makes vim invoke Latex-Suite when you open a tex file.
- filetype plugin on
-
- " IMPORTANT: win32 users will need to have 'shellslash' set so that latex
- " can be called correctly.
- set shellslash
-
- " IMPORTANT: grep will sometimes skip displaying the file name if you
- " search in a singe file. This will confuse Latex-Suite. Set your grep
- " program to always generate a file-name.
- set grepprg=grep\ -nH\ $*
-
- " OPTIONAL: This enables automatic indentation as you type.
- filetype indent on
-
-
-
-In addition, the following settings could go in your ~/.vim/ftplugin/tex.vim
-file: >
- " this is mostly a matter of taste. but LaTeX looks good with just a bit
- " of indentation.
- set sw=2
- " TIP: if you write your \label's as \label{fig:something}, then if you
- " type in \ref{fig: and press <C-n> you will automatically cycle through
- " all the figure labels. Very useful!
- set iskeyword+=:
-
-
-
-================================================================================
-Inserting Templates *ls_2* *ls_a_bd*
- *latex-suite-templates*
-
-
-
-This functionality is available via the TeX-Suite > Templates menu. This module
-provides a way to insert custom templates at the beginning of the current file.
-
-When Latex-Suite first starts up, it scans the
-$VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/templates/ directory and creates menu items based on
-the files found there. When you select a template from this menu, the file will
-be read in above the first line of the current file.
-
-A template file can utilize placeholders for initializing the cursor position
-when the template is read in and subsequent movement. In addition, template
-files can contain dynamic elements such as the time of creation of a file etc,
-by using vim expressions.
-
-You can place your own templates in the $VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/templates/
-directory in order for them to be available via the menu. Unless Latex-Suite
-releases a template with the same name, these files should not get over-written
-when you install a new release over an existing one.
-
-NOTE: Templates are also accessible for non-gui users with the command
- |:TTemplate|. The argument should be name of the corresponding template
- file. If the command is called without arguments (preferred usage), then a
- list of available templates is displayed and the user is asked to choose
- one of them.
-
-
-
-================================================================================
-Latex-Suite Macros *ls_3* *ls_a_be*
- *latex-macros*
-
-|ls_3_1| Environment Mappings
-|ls_3_2| Command Mappings
-|ls_3_3| Font Mappings
-|ls_3_4| Section Mappings
-|ls_3_5| Greek Letter Mappings
-|ls_3_6| Auc-Tex Key Bindings
-|ls_3_7| Diacritics
-|ls_3_8| BibTeX Shortcuts
-|ls_3_9| Smart Key Mappings
-|ls_3_10| Alt Key Macros
-|ls_3_11| Custom Macros
-|ls_3_12| Making your own Macros via IMAP()
-
-
-Latex-Suite ships with a very comprehensive set of insert mode and |visual-mode|
-mappings and menu items to typeset most of the LaTeX elements.
-
-NOTE: These mappings are are not standard mappings in the sense that only the
- last character is mapped. See plugin/imaps.vim for further documentation.
- For example, in the case of the mapping EFI provided by Latex-Suite you
- can press the characters 'E', 'F' and 'I' as slowly as you wish (unlike
- the normal imap command where timeout issues are involved). The characters
- are visible as you type them (unlike normal imaps) and you can use the
- movement or backspace key to correct yourself unlike normal mappings.
-
-
- *place-holder* *ls_a_dV*
- *place-holders* *ls_a_eD*
-NOTE: Place Holders
- -------------
- Almost all macros provided in Latex-Suite implement Stephen Riem's
- bracketing system and Gergely Kontra's JumpFunc() for handling
- place-holders. This consists of using "place-holders" to mark off
- locations where the next relevant editing has to be done. As an example,
- when you type EFI in |insert-mode|, you will get the following: >
- \begin{figure}[h]
- \centerline{\psfig{figure=<+eps file+>}}
- \caption{<+caption text+>}
- \label{fig:<+label+>}
- \end{figure}<++>
-< The text <+eps file+> will be selected and you will be left in
- |select-mode| so that you can continue typing straight away. After having
- typed in the file name, you can press <Ctrl-J> (while still in
- insert-mode). This will take you directly to the next "place-holder". i.e,
- <+caption text+> will be visually selected with Vim in select mode again
- for typing in the caption. This saves on a lot of key presses.
-
-
- *overriding-macros* *ls_a_eE*
-NOTE: Over-riding Latex-Suite Macros
- ------------------------------
- If you wish to change these macros from their default values, for example,
- if you wish to change `w to expand to \omega instead of its default
- expansion to \wedge, you should use the IMAP function as described in the
- Using IMAP() [|ls_a_bG|] section.
-
- An important thing to note is that if you wish to over-ride macros created
- by Latex-Suite rather than merely create new macros, you should place the
- IMAP() calls in a script which gets sourced after the files in
- Latex-Suite. A good place typically is as a file-type plugin file in the
- ~/.vim/after/ftplugin/ directory. (Use ~/vimfiles if you are using
- WINDOWS). For example to over-ride `w to \omega instead of \wedge, place
- the following line in (say) ~/.vim/after/ftplugin/tex_macros.vim: >
- call IMAP('`w', '\omega', 'tex')
-<
-
- NOTE: It is important to use a file-name which will get sourced on a
- FileType event. Therefore you must use a file-name which conforms to
- the standards as described in |ftplugin-name|.
-
-
-
- *pausing-imaps* *ls_a_eF*
-NOTE: Pausing Macro expansion
- -----------------------
- If you wish to temporarily suspend the imaps functionality, then you can
- set the Imap_FreezeImap to 1. If you set g:Imap_FreezeImap to 1, then it
- will be a system-wide setting. Setting b:Imap_FreezeImap will affect only
- the current buffer.
-
-
-The following sections describe the various editing macros provided by
-Latex-Suite.
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Environment Mappings *ls_3_1* *ls_a_bf*
- *environment-mappings*
-
-Latex-Suite provides a rich set of mappings to insert, enclose and modify LaTeX
-environments, i.e, \begin{...} ... \end{...} pairs.
-
-Inserting Environments *ls_3_1_1* *ls_a_bg*
- *inserting-environments*
-
-Latex-Suite provides the following ways to insert environments
-
-
-
-Method 1: Pressing <F5> *ls_3_1_1_1* *ls_a_bh*
- *inserting-env-f5*
-
-If you press <F5> in the insert or normal mode while on an empty line,
-Latex-Suite prompts you with a list of environments you might want to insert.
-You can either choose one from the list or type in a new environment name. If
-you press <F5> on a line which already has a word, then that word is used
-instead of prompting.
-
-See Tex_Env_name [|ls_a_cZ|] for a description of how Latex-Suite uses the word
-to form the expansion and how to modify Latex-Suite's behavior.
-
-The list of environments which Latex-Suite prompts you with (when <F5> is
-pressed on an empty line) is formed from the Tex_PromptedEnvironments
-[|ls_a_di|] setting.
-
-In addition to this setting, Latex-Suite also lists environments found in custom
-packages as described in the section Package actions. [|ls_a_bL|]
-
-
-Method 2: Using <S-F1>-<S-F4> *ls_3_1_1_2* *ls_a_bi*
- *inserting-env-shift-f1*
-
-The shifted function keys, <S-F1> to <S-F4> can be mapped to insert very
-commonly used environments. The environments mapped to each key can be
-customized via the g:Tex_HotKeyMappings [|ls_a_dj|] setting.
-
-
-Method 3: Using three letter sequences *ls_3_1_1_3* *ls_a_bj*
- *inserting-env-threeletter*
-
-Environments can also be inserted by pressing a 3 capital letter sequence
-starting with an E. The sequence of 3 letters generally tries to follow the
-following rules:
-
-
-1. All environment mappings begin with E
-
-2. If the environment can be broken up into 2 distinct words, such as flushright
- (flush + right), then the next 2 letters are the first letters of the 2
- words. Example: >
- flushleft (_f_lush + _l_eft) ---> EFL
- flushright (_f_lush + _r_ight) ---> EFR
- eqnarray (_e_qn + _a_rray) ---> EEA
-< If on the other hand, the environment name cannot be broken up into 2
- distinct words, then the next 2 letters are the first 2 letters of the name
- of the environment. Example: >
- equation (_eq_uation) ---> EEQ
-<
-Unfortunately there are some environments that cannot be split in two words and
-first two letters in name are identical. In this case shortcut is created from
-E, first and last letter. Example: >
- quote (_q_uot_e_) ---> EQE
- quotation (_q_uotatio_n_) ---> EQN
-Of course, not every last one of the environments can follow this rule because
-of ambiguities. In case of doubt, pull down the Tex-Environments menu. The menu
-item should give the hint for the map.
-
-
-Enclosing in Environments *ls_3_1_2* *ls_a_bk*
- *enclosing-environments*
-
-Latex-Suite provides visual-mode mappings which enclose visually selected
-portions of text in environments. There are two ways provided to do this.
-
-
-
-Method 1: Pressing <F5> *ls_3_1_2_1* *ls_a_bl*
- *enclosing-env-f5*
-
-You can also select a portion of text visually and press <F5> while still in
-visual mode. This will prompt you with a list of environments. (This list can be
-customized via the g:Tex_PromptedEnvironments [|ls_a_di|] setting). You can
-either choose from this list or type in a new environment name. Once the
-selection is done, Latex-Suite encloses the visually selected portion in the
-chosen environment.
-
-
-Method 2: Using three letter mappings *ls_3_1_2_2* *ls_a_bm*
- *enclosing-env-threeletter*
-
-You can also select text visually and press a sequence of three characters
-beginning with , (the single comma character) and the selected text will be
-enclosed in the chosen environment. The three letter sequence follows directly
-from the three letter sequence used to insert environments as described here
-[|ls_a_bj|]. The following example describes the rule used:
-
-If ECE inserts a \begin{center}...\end{center} environment, then to enclose a
-block of selected text in \begin{center}...\end{center}, simply select the text
-and press ,ce. The rule simply says that the leading E is converted to , and the
-next 2 letters are small case.
-Some of the visual mode mappings are sensitive to whether you choose line-wise
-or character-wise. For example, if you choose a word and press ,ce, then you get
-\centerline{word}, whereas if you press ,ce on a line-wise selection, you get: >
- \begin{center}
- line
- \end{center}
-
-
-
-Changing Environments *ls_3_1_3* *ls_a_bn*
- *changing-environments*
-
-Pressing <S-F5> in normal mode detects which environment the cursor is presently
-located in and prompts you to replace it with a new one. The innermost
-environment is detected. For example, in the following source: >
- \begin{eqnarray}
- \begin{array}{ccc}
- 2 & 3 & 4
- \end{array}
- \end{eqnarray}
-if you are located in the middle "2 & 3 & 4" line, then pressing <S-F5> will
-prompt you to change the array environment, not the eqnarray environment. In
-addition, Latex-Suite will also try to change lines within the environment to be
-consistent with the new environment. For example, if the original environment
-was an eqnarray environment with a \label command, then changing it to an
-eqnarray* environment will delete the \label.
-
-Pressing <F5> in normal mode has the same effect as pressing <F5> in
-insert-mode, namely you will be prompted to choose an environment to insert.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Command Mappings *ls_3_2* *ls_a_bo*
- *latex-command-maps*
-
-Latex-Suite provides a rich set of mappings to insert, enclose and modify LaTeX
-commands.
-
-Inserting LaTeX commands *ls_3_2_1* *ls_a_bp*
- *inserting-commands*
-
- *ls-imap-f7* *ls_a_dW*
- *ls-imap-s-f7* *ls_a_dX*
-Pressing <F7> in insert or normal mode while the cursor is touching a word will
-insert a command formed from the word touching the cursor.
-
-For certain common commands, Latex-Suite will expand them to include additional
-arguments as needed. For example, frac becomes \frac{<++>}{<++>}<++>. Otherwise,
-it will simply change the word under the cursor as follows >
- word --> \word{<++>}<++>
-You can define custom expansions of commands using the Tex_Com_{name} setting as
-described in here [|ls_a_da|].
-
-If <F7> is pressed when the cursor is on white-space, then Latex-Suite will
-prompt you to choose a command and insert that instead.The list of commands is
-constructed from the g:Tex_PromptedCommands [|ls_a_dk|] setting and also from
-commands which Latex-Suite finds while scanning custom packages which
-Latex-Suite finds. See the Package actions [|ls_a_bL|] section for details on
-which files are scanned etc.
-
-
-Enclosing in a command *ls_3_2_2* *ls_a_bq*
- *enclosing-commands*
-
-You can select a portion of text visually and press <F7> while still in visual
-mode. This will prompt you with a list of commands. (This list can be customized
-via the g:Tex_PromptedCommands [|ls_a_dk|] setting). You can either choose from
-this list or type in a new command name. Once the selection is done, Latex-Suite
-encloses the visually selected portion in the chosen command.
-
-
-Changing commands *ls_3_2_3* *ls_a_br*
- *changing-commands*
-
- *ls-vmap-f7* *ls_a_dY*
-In both insert and normal mode <S-F7> will find out if you are presently within
-an environment and then prompt you with a list of commands to change it to.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Font Mappings *ls_3_3* *ls_a_bs* *font-maps*
-
-These mappings insert font descriptions such as: \textsf{<++>}<++> with the
-cursor left in place of the first placeholder [|ls_a_eD|] (the <++> characters).
-
-Mnemonic:
-1. first letter is always F (F for font)
-
-2. next 2 letters are the 2 letters describing the font.
-
-Example: Typing FEM in insert-mode expands to \emph{<++>}<++>.
-
-Just like environment mappings, you can visually select an area and press `sf to
-have it enclosed in: \textsf{word} or >
- {\sffamily
- line
- }
-depending on character-wise or line-wise selection.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Section Mappings *ls_3_4* *ls_a_bt*
- *section-mappings*
-
-These maps insert LaTeX sections such as: >
- \section{<++>}<++>
-etc. Just as in the case of environments and fonts, can be enclosed with a
-visual selection. The enclosing is not sensitive to character or line-wise
-selection.
-
-Mnemonic: (make your own!) >
- SPA for part
- SCH for chapter
- SSE for section
- SSS for subsection
- SS2 for subsubsection
- SPG for paragraph
- SSP for subparagraph
-
-
-Example: SSE in insert mode inserts >
- \section{<++>}<++>
-If you select a word or line and press ,se, then you get >
- \section{section name}
-The menu item in Tex-Environments.Sections have a sub-menu called 'Advanced'.
-Choosing an item from this sub-menu asks a couple of questions (whether you want
-to include the section in the table of contents, whether there is a shorter name
-for the table of contents) and then creates a more intelligent template.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Greek Letter Mappings *ls_3_5* *ls_a_bu*
- *greek-letter-mappings*
-
-Lower case
-
-`a through `z expand to \alpha through \zeta.Upper case:
-
- >
- `D = \Delta
- `F = \Phi
- `G = \Gamma
- `Q = \Theta
- `L = \Lambda
- `X = \Xi
- `Y = \Psi
- `S = \Sigma
- `U = \Upsilon
- `W = \Omega
-NOTE: LaTeX does not support upper case for all greek alphabets.
-
-
-Just like other Latex-Suite mappings, these mappings are not created using the
-standard imap command. Thus you can type slowly, correct using <BS> etc.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Auc-Tex Key Bindings *ls_3_6* *ls_a_bv*
- *auc-tex-mappings*
-
-These are simple 2 key expansions for some very commonly used LaTeX elements:
-
- >
- `^ Expands To \Hat{<++>}<++>
- `_ expands to \bar{<++>}<++>
- `6 expands to \partial
- `8 expands to \infty
- `/ expands to \frac{<++>}{<++>}<++>
- `% expands to \frac{<++>}{<++>}<++>
- `@ expands to \circ
- `0 expands to ^\circ
- `= expands to \equiv
- `\ expands to \setminus
- `. expands to \cdot
- `* expands to \times
- `& expands to \wedge
- `- expands to \bigcap
- `+ expands to \bigcup
- `( expands to \subset
- `) expands to \supset
- `< expands to \le
- `> expands to \ge
- `, expands to \nonumber
- `~ expands to \tilde{<++>}<++>
- `; expands to \dot{<++>}<++>
- `: expands to \ddot{<++>}<++>
- `2 expands to \sqrt{<++>}<++>
- `| expands to \Big|
- `I expands to \int_{<++>}^{<++>}<++>
-(again, notice the convenient place-holders)
-
-In addition the visual mode macros are provided:
-
- >
- `( encloses selection in \left( and \right)
- `[ encloses selection in \left[ and \right]
- `{ encloses selection in \left\{ and \right\}
- `$ encloses selection in $$ or \[ \] depending on characterwise or
- linewise selection
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Diacritics *ls_3_7* *ls_a_bw*
- *diacritic-mappings*
-
-These mappings speed up typing European languages which contain diacritic
-characters such as a-umlaut etc. >
- +<l> expands to \v{<l>}
- =<l> expands to \'{<l>}
-where <l> is an alphabet.
-
- >
- +} expands to \"{a}
- +: expands to \^{o}
-Latex-Suite also ships with smart backspacing [|ls_a_dZ|] functionality which
-provides another convenience while editing languages with diacritics.
-
-NOTE: Diacritics are disabled by default in Latex-Suite because they can
- sometimes be a little too intrusive. Moreover, most European users can
- nowadays use font encodings which display diacritic characters directly
- instead of having to rely on Latex-Suite's method of displaying
- diacritics.
-
- Set the g:Tex_Diacritics [|ls_a_df|] variable to enable diacritics.
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-BibTeX Shortcuts *ls_3_8* *ls_a_bx*
- *bibtex-bindings*
-
-Latex-Suite provides an easy way of entering bibliographic entries. Four
-insert-mode mappings: BBB, BBL, BBH and BBX are provided, all of which
-essentially act in the same manner. When you type any of these in insert-mode,
-you will get a prompt asking you to choose a entry type for the bibliographic
-entry.
-
-When you choose an entry type, a bibliographic entry template will be inserted.
-For example, if you choose the option 'book' via the map BBB, then the following
-template will be inserted: >
- @BOOK{<+key+>,
- author = {<++>},
- editor = {<++>},
- title = {<++>},
- publisher = {<++>},
- year = {<++>},
- otherinfo = {<++>}
- }<++>
-
-
-<+key+> will be highlighted in select-mode and you can type in the bib-key.
-After that you can use <Ctrl-J> to navigate to successive locations in the
-template and enter new values.
-
-BBB inserts a template with only the fields mandatorily required for a given
-entry type. BBL inserts a template with commonly used extra options. BBH inserts
-a template with more options which are not as commonly used. BBX inserts a
-template with all the fields which the entry type supports.
-
-NOTE: Mnemonic
- --------
- B for Bibliographic entry, L for Large entry, H for Huge entry, and X
- stands for all eXtras.
-
-
-
-
-Customizing Bib-TeX fields *ls_3_8_1* *ls_a_by*
- *adding-bib-options*
-
-If you wish the BBB command to insert a few additional fields in addition to the
-fields it creates, then you will need to define global variables of the form >
- g:Bib_{type}_options
-in you $VIM/ftplugin/bib.vim file, where {type} is a string like 'article',
-'book' etc. This variable should contain one of the letters defined in the
-following table
-
-Character Field Type~
-w address
-a author
-b booktitle
-c chapter
-d edition
-e editor
-h howpublished
-i institution
-k isbn
-j journal
-m month
-z note
-n number
-o organization
-p pages
-q publisher
-r school
-s series
-t title
-u type
-v volume
-y year
-
-For example, by default, choosing 'article' via BBB inserts the following
-template by default >
- @ARTICLE{<+key+>,
- author = {<++>},
- title = {<++>},
- journal = {<++>},
- year = {<++>},
- otherinfo = {<++>}
- }<++>
-However, if g:Bib_article_options is defined as 'mnp', then 'article' will
-insert the following template >
- @ARTICLE{<+key+>,
- author = {<++>},
- title = {<++>},
- journal = {<++>},
- year = {<++>},
- month = {<++>},
- number = {<++>},
- pages = {<++>},
- otherinfo = {<++>}
- }<++>
-
-
-If you have some other fields you wish to associate with an article which are
-not listed above, then you will have to use the Bib_{type}_extrafields option.
-This is a newline separated string of complete field names which will be
-included in the template. For example, if you define >
- let g:Bib_article_extrafields = "crossref\nabstract"
-then the article template will include the lines >
- crossref = {<++>},
- abstract = {<++>},
-
-
-NOTE: You will need to define Bib_* settings in your
- $VIMRUNTIME/ftplugin/bib.vim file.
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Smart Key Mappings *ls_3_9* *ls_a_bz*
- *smart-keys*
-
-Latex-Suite ships with the following smart keys:
-
-Smart Backspace
----------------
- *smart-backspace* *ls_a_dZ*
-Pressing <BS> in insert mode checks to see whether we are just after something
-like \'{a} and if so, deletes all of it. i.e, diacritics are treated as single
-characters for backspacing.
-
-Smart Quotes
-------------
-Pressing " (English double quote) will insert `` or '' by making an intelligent
-guess about whether we intended to open or close a quote.
-
-Smart Space
------------
-Latex-Suite maps the <space> key in such a way that $ characters are not broken
-across lines. It does this by first setting tw=0 so that Vim will not
-automatically break lines and then maps the <space> key to insert newlines
-keeping $$'s on the same line.
-
-Smart Dots
-----------
-Pressing ... (3 dots) results in \ldots outside math mode and \cdots in math
-mode.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Alt Key Macros *ls_3_10* *ls_a_bA*
- *altkey-mappings*
-
-Latex-Suite utilizes a set of macros originally created by Carl Mueller in
-auctex.vim to make inserting all the \left ... \right stuff very easy and to
-also make some use of the heavily under-utilized <Alt> key.
-
-NOTE: By default, typing Alt-<key> in Vim takes focus to the menu bar if a menu
- with the hotkey <key> exists. If in your case, there are conflicts due to
- this behavior, you will need to set >
- set winaltkeys=no
-< in your $VIM/ftplugin/tex.vim in order to use these maps.
-
-
-NOTE: Customizing the maps
- --------------------
- If for some reason, you wish to not map the <Alt> keys, (some European
- users need to use the <Alt> key to enter diacritics), you can change these
- maps to other keys as described in the section Customizing Alt-key maps
- [|ls_a_cx|].
-
-
-
-
-<Alt-L> *ls_3_10_1* *ls_a_bB* *Alt-L*
-
-This is a polymorphic insert-mode mapping which expands to one of the following
-depending on the character just before the cursor location.
-
-Character before cursor Expansion~
-( \left( <++> \right)
-[ \left[ <++> \right]
-| \left| <++> \right|
-{ \left\{ <++> \right\}
-< \langle <++> \rangle
-q \lefteqn{<++>}<++>
-
-If the character before the cursor is none of the above, then it will simply
-insert a \label{<++>}<++>.
-
-
-<Alt-B> *ls_3_10_2* *ls_a_bC* *Alt-B*
-
-This insert-mode mapping encloses the previous character in \mathbf{}.
-
-
-<Alt-C> *ls_3_10_3* *ls_a_bD* *Alt-C*
-
-In insert mode, this key is polymorphic as follows:
-
-
-1. If the previous character is a letter or number, then capitalize it and
- enclose it in \mathcal{}.
-
-2. otherwise insert \cite{}.
-In visual mode, it will simply enclose the selection in \mathcal{}
-
-
-<Alt-I> *ls_3_10_4* *ls_a_bE* *Alt-I*
-
-This mapping inserts an \item command at the current cursor location depending
-on which environment the cursor is enclosed in. The style of the \item command
-is dependent on the enclosing environment. By default, <Alt-I> has styles
-defined forthe following environments:
-
-Environment Style~
-itemize \item
-enumerate \item
-theindex \item
-thebibliography \item[<+biblabel+>]{<+bibkey+>} <++>
-description \item[<+label+>] <++>
-
-<Alt-I> is intelligent enough to account for nested environments. For example, >
- \begin{itemize}
- \item first item
- \item second item
- \begin{description}
- \item[label1] first desc
- \item[label2] second
- % <Alt-I> will insert "\item[<+label+>] <++>" if
- % used here
- \end{description}
- \item third item
- % <Alt-I> will insert "\item " when if used here.
- \end{itemize}
- % <Alt-I> will insert nothing ("") if used here
-<
-
-The style used by <Alt-I> can be customized using the
-g:Tex_ItemStyle_environment [|ls_a_dl|] variable.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Custom Macros *ls_3_11* *ls_a_bF*
- *custom-macros-menu*
-
-This functionality available via the TeX-Suite.Macros menu, provides a way of
-inserting customized macros into the current file via the menu.
-
-When Latex-Suite starts up, it scans the $VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/macros/
-directory and creates a menu from the files found there. Each file is considered
-as a single macro. You can place your own macros in this directory, using
-placeholders [|ls_a_eD|] if wanted.
-
-When you choose a macro from the menu, the corresponding file is read into the
-current buffer after the current cursor position. In non-gui mode, you can use
-the |TMacro| command instead of choosing from the menu. This command takes the
-macro file name as an argument. When called without arguments (preferred usage),
-then a list of available macro files is displayed and the user is prompted to
-choose one of them).
-
-There are some other tools provided in this menu, namely:
-
-
-{New} Creates a new (unnamed) buffer in the latex-suite/macros/ directory.
- Use the command :TexMacroNew in non-gui mode.
-{Edit} Opens up the corresponding macro file for editing. Use |:TexMacroEdit|
- in non-gui mode. When you try to edit {macro} not from local directory
- Latex-Suite will copy it to your local directory with suffix "-local".
- If local copy already exists Latex-Suite prompt for overwriting it.
-{Delete} Deletes the corresponding macro. Use the prefixed numbers for fast
- navigation of menus. Use |:TexMacroDelete| in non-gui mode. When you
- choose to delete {macro} which is not in your local directory
- Latex-Suite will refuse to delete it.
-{Redraw} Rescans the macros/ directories and refreshes the macros list.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Making your own Macros via IMAP() *ls_3_12* *ls_a_bG*
- *ls-new-macros*
-
-If you find the need to create your own macros, then you can use the IMAP()
-function provided with Latex-Suite. See [|ls_a_bH|] for a short explanation of
-why you might prefer IMAP() over Vim's standard :imap command. An example best
-explains the usage: >
- :call IMAP('NOM', '\nomenclature{<++>}<++>', 'tex')
-This will create a Latex-Suite-style mapping, where if you type NOM in insert
-mode, you will get \nomenclature{<++>}<++> with the cursor left in place of the
-first <++> characters. See [|ls_a_bI|] for a detailed explanation of the IMAP()
-command.
-
-For maps which are triggered for a given filetype, the IMAP() command above
-should be put in the filetype plugin script for that file. For example, for
-tex-specific mappings, the IMAP() calls should go in $VIM/ftplugin/tex.vim. For
-globally visible maps, you will need to use the following in either your
-~/.vimrc or a file in your $VIM/plugin directory. >
- augroup MyIMAPs
- au!
- au VimEnter * call IMAP('Foo', 'foo', '')
- augroup END
-
-
-
-
-Why use IMAP() *ls_3_12_1* *ls_a_bH*
- *why-IMAP*
-
-Using IMAP instead of Vim's built-in :imap command has a couple of advantages:
-1. The 'ttimeout' option will generally limit how easily you can type the left
- hand side for a normal :imap. if you type the left hand side too slowly, then
- the mapping will not be activated.
-
-2. If you mistype one of the letters of the lhs, then the mapping is deactivated
- as soon as you backspace to correct the mistake.
-
-3. The characters in lhs are shown on top of each other. This is fairly
- distracting. This becomes a real annoyance when a lot of characters initiate
- mappings.
-
-
-IMAP() syntax *ls_3_12_2* *ls_a_bI*
- *ls-imaps-syntax*
-
-Formally, the syntax which is used for the IMAP function is: >
- call IMAP (lhs, rhs, ft [, phs, phe])
-
-
-Argument Explanation~
-lhs This is the "left-hand-side" of the mapping. When you use IMAP, only
- the last character of this word is actually mapped, although the
- effect is that the whole word is mapped.
-
- If you have two mappings which end in a common lhs, then the mapping
- with the longer lhs is used. For example, if you do >
- call IMAP('BarFoo', 'something', 'tex')
- call IMAP('Foo', 'something else', 'tex')
-< Then typing BarFoo inserts "something", whereas Foo by itself inserts
- "something else".
-
- Also, the nature of IMAP() makes creating certain combination of
- mappings impossible. For example if you have >
- call IMAP('foo', 'something', 'tex')
- call IMAP('foobar', 'something else', 'tex')
-< Then you will never be able to trigger "foobar" because typing "foo"
- will immediately insert "something". This is the "cost" which you
- incur over the normal :imap command for the convenience of no
- 'timeout' problems, the ability to correct lhs etc.
-
-
-rhs The "right-hand-side" of the mapping. This is the expansion you will
- get when you type lhs.
-
- This string can also contain special characters such as <enter> etc.
- To do this, you will need to specify the second argument in
- double-quotes as follows: >
- :call IMAP('EFE', "\\begin{figure}\<CR><++>\\end{figure}<++>", 'tex')
-< With this, typing EFE is equivalent to typing in the right-hand side
- with all the special characters in insert-mode. This has the advantage
- that if you have filetype indentation set up, then the right hand side
- will also be indented just as if you had typed it in normally.
-
- *IMAP_PutTextWithMovement* *ls_a_ea*
- You can also set up a Latex-Suite style mapping which calls a custom
- function as follows: >
- :call IMAP('FOO', "\<C-r>=MyFoonction()\<CR>", 'tex')
-< where MyFoonction is a custom function you have written. If
- MyFoonction also has to return a string containing <++> characters,
- then you will need to use the function IMAP_PutTextWithMovement(). An
- example best explains the usage:
-
- >
- call IMAP('FOO', "\<C-r>=AskVimFunc()\<CR>", 'vim')
- " Askvimfunc: Asks For Function Name And Sets Up Template
- " Description:
- function! AskVimFunc()
- let name = input('Name of the function : ')
- if name == ''
- let name = "<+Function Name+>"
- end
- let islocal = input('Is this function scriptlocal ? [y]/n : ', 'y')
- if islocal == 'y'
- let sidstr = '<SID>'
- else
- let sidstr = ''
- endif
- return IMAP_PutTextWithMovement(
- \ "\" ".name.": <+short description+> \<cr>" .
- \ "Description: <+long description+>\<cr>" .
- \ "\<C-u>function! ".name."(<+arguments+>)<++>\<cr>" .
- \ "<+function body+>\<cr>" .
- \ "endfunction \" "
- \ )
- endfunction
-<
-
-
-ft The file type for which this mapping is active. When this string is
- left empty, the mapping applies for all file-types. A filetype
- specific mapping will always take precedence.
-
-
-phs, phe If you prefer to write the rhs with characters other than <+ and +> to
- denote place-holders, you can use the last 2 arguments to specify
- which characters in the rhs specify place-holders. By default, these
- are <+ and +> respectively.
-
- Note that the phs and phe arguments do not control what characters
- will be displayed for the placeholders when the mapping is actually
- triggered. What characters are used to display place-holders when you
- trigger an IMAP are controlled by the Imap_PlaceHolderStart
- [|ls_a_cV|] and Imap_PlaceHolderEnd [|ls_a_er|] settings.
-
-
-
-================================================================================
-Package Handling *ls_4* *ls_a_bJ*
- *latex-packages*
-
-|ls_4_1| Inserting package commands
-|ls_4_2| Actions taken for supported packages
-|ls_4_3| Automatic Package detection
-|ls_4_4| Writing supporting for a package
-
-
-Latex-Suite has a lot of functionality written to ease working with packages.
-Packages here refers to files which you include into the LaTeX document using
-the \usepackage command.
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Inserting package commands *ls_4_1* *ls_a_bK*
- *inserting-packages*
-
-When you first invoke Latex-Suite, it scans the
-$VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/packages directory for package script files and
-creates a menu from all the files found there. This menu is created under
-TeX-Suite > Packages > Supported. This menu contains a list of packages
-"supported" by Latex-Suite. When you choose one of the packages from this menu
-(for example the amsmath package), then a line of the form >
- \usepackage[<++>]{amsmath}<++>
-will be inserted into the current file.
-
-The \usepackage line can also be inserted in an easy manner in the current file
-by pressing <F5> while in the preamble of the current document. This will set up
-a prompt from the supported packages and ask you to choose from one of them. If
-you do not find the package you want to insert in the list, you can type in a
-package-name and it will use that. Pressing <F5> in the preamble on a line
-containing a single word will construct a \usepackage line from that word.
-
-You can also use the TPackage [|ls_a_cD|] to insert the \usepackage line.
-
-Once you have inserted a \usepackage line, for supported packages, you can use
-the Options and Commands menus described in the next section [|ls_a_bL|].
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Actions taken for supported packages *ls_4_2* *ls_a_bL*
- *package-actions*
-
-Latex-Suite takes the following actions for packages detected when a file is
-loaded, or a new \usepackage line is inserted using one of the methods described
-in the previous section [|ls_a_bK|].
-
-If you are using the GUI and you have g:Tex_Menus [|ls_a_dI|] set to 1,
-Latex-Suite will create the following sub-menus
-TeX-Suite > Packages > <package> Options
-
-TeX-Suite > Packages > <package> Commands
-
-where <package> is the package you just inserted (or was detected). You can use
-these menus to insert commands, environments and options which Latex-Suite
-recognizes as belonging to this package.
-
-NOTE: While inserting an option, you need to position yourself in the
- appropriate place in the document, most commonly inside the square braces
- in the \usepackage[]{packname} command. Latex-Suite will not navigate to
- that location.
-
-
-In addition to creating these sub-menus, Latex-Suite will also scan the
-$VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/dictionaries directory and if a dictionary file
-corresponding to the package file is found, then it will add the file to the
-'dict' setting in Vim so you can use the <C-X><C-K> command to complete words
-from that file.
-
-For example, the SIUnits package has a custom dictionary.
-
- *latex-package-scanning* *ls_a_eb*
-If a package detected at startup is found by Latex-Suite in the current
-directory or in a location specified by the g:Tex_TEXINPUTS [|ls_a_dT|]
-variable, Latex-Suite will scan the package for \newenvironment and newcommand
-lines and also append any commands and environments found to the list of
-commands and environments which you are prompted with when you press <F5>
-[|ls_a_bh|] or <F7> [|ls_a_dW|] in insert mode.
-In addition, the TeX-Suite > Packages menu also contains the following submenus
-
-Update
-------
-This command is to be invoked with the cursor placed on the package name. If the
-corresponding package is found, then a sub-menu with the supported commands and
-options is created.
-
-Update All
-----------
-This function reads the preamble of the document for \usepackage lines and if
-Latex-Suite supports the detected packages, then sub-menus containing the
-package options and commands are created.
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Automatic Package detection *ls_4_3* *ls_a_bM*
- *automatic-package-detection*
-
-Whenever Latex-Suite begins editing a new LaTeX file, it scans it for
-\usepackage{name} lines, and if a supported package is found, then it will
-create sub-menus and add to the 'dict' setting as described above.
-
-If a master-file [|ls_a_ct|] has been specified, then it will scan that file
-instead of the current file. See the section Custom Packages [|ls_a_bN|] to see
-which files Latex-Suite will scan in more detail.
-
-For all the packages detected in this manner, Latex-Suite will take certain
-actions as described in the section package support. [|ls_a_bL|].
-
-
-
-Custom Packages *ls_4_3_1* *ls_a_bN*
- *custom-packages*
-
-Often times, the preamble can become too long, and some people prefer to put
-most of their personalization in a custom package and include that using a
-\usepackage line. Latex-Suite tries to search such customs package for other
-\usepackage lines, so that supported packages included in this indirect manner
-can also be used to create sub-menus, extend the 'dict' setting etc. The most
-obvious place to place such custom packages is in the same directory as the
-edited file. In addition, LaTeX also supports placing custom packages in places
-pointed to by the $TEXINPUTS environment variable.
-
-If you use the $TEXINPUTS variable in LaTeX, and you wish Latex-Suite to search
-these custom packages for \usepackage lines, then you need to initialize the
-g:Tex_TEXINPUTS [|ls_a_dT|] variable.
-
-The g:Tex_TEXINPUTS variable needs to be set in the same format which Vim uses
-for the 'path' setting. This format is explained in detail if you do >
- :help file-searching
-from within Vim.
-
-Therefore the value of g:Tex_TEXINPUTS will most probably be different from
-$TEXINPUTS which your native LaTeX distribution uses.
-
-Example: >
- let g:Tex_TEXINPUTS = '~/texmf/mypackages/**,./**'
-The ** indicates that all directories below the directory ~/texmf/mypackages and
-./ are to be scanned for custom packages.
-
-NOTE: The present directory '.' is always searched. You need not include that in
- g:Tex_TEXINPUTS.
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Writing supporting for a package *ls_4_4* *ls_a_bO*
- *supporting-packages*
-
-Supporting a package is easy and consists of writing a vim script with the same
-name as the package and placing it in the $VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/packages
-directory. A package script should define two variables as described in the next
-two sections. In addition to these two variables, you can also define any
-functions, environment definitions etc. in this file.
-
-
-
-g:Tex_package_option_<package> *ls_4_4_1* *ls_a_bP*
-
-This setting is a string containing a comma separated list of options supported
-by this package.
-
-Example: >
- g:Tex_package_option_mypack = 'opt1,opt2=,sbr:group1,opt3,opt4'
-The = suffix means that the option takes a value. Use sbr:group name to separate
-options into sub-menus. All successive options will be clubbed into the group1
-sub-menu till the next sbr: option is encountered.
-
-
-g:Tex_package_<package> *ls_4_4_2* *ls_a_bQ*
-
- >
-
- g:TeX_package_<package> = "pre:Command,pre:Command1"
- More detailed example is in latex-suite/packages/exmpl file (slightly
- outdated).
- Here is short summary of prefixes which can be used in package files:
- (x - place with cursor, <++> - |placeholder|)
-
- {env:command} Environment: creates simple environment template
- \begin{command}
- x
- \end{command}<++>
- {eno:command} Environment with option:
- \begin[x]{command}
- <++>
- \end{command}<++>
- {ens:command[<<option>>]...} Environment special:
- \begin[<<option>>]...{command}
- <++>
- \end{command}<++>
- {bra:command} Brackets:
- \command{x}<++>
- {brd:command} Brackets double:
- \command{x}{<++>}<++>
- {brs:command[<<option>>]...} Brackets special (as environment special:
- \command[<+x+>]{<++>}{<++>}<++>
- {nor:command} Normal:
- \command<Space
- {noo:command} Normal with option:
- \command[x]<++>
- {nob:command} Normal with option and brackets:
- \command[x]{<++>}<++>
- {pla:command} Plain:
- command<Space
- {spe:command} Special:
- command <-literal insertion of command
- {sep:command} creates separator. Good for aesthetics and usability :)
- {sbr:command} Breaks menu into submenus. <command> will be title of submenu.
- Can be used also in package variable.
-
- Command can be also given without prefix:. The result is
- \command
-
-
-
-================================================================================
-Latex Completion *ls_5* *ls_a_bR*
- *latex-completion*
-
-|ls_5_1| Latex-Suite completion example
-|ls_5_2| Latex-Suite \ref completion
-|ls_5_3| Latex-Suite \cite completion
-|ls_5_4| Latex-Suite filename completion
-|ls_5_5| Custom command completion
-
-
-Latex-Suite provides an easy way to insert references to labels and
-bibliographic entries and also provide filename arguments to commands such as
-\includegraphics. Although the completion capabilities are very diverse,
-Latex-Suite only uses a single key (<F9> by default) to do all of it. Pressing
-the <F9> key does different things based on where you are located. Latex-Suite
-tries to guess what you might be trying to complete at the location where you
-pressed <F9>. For example, pressing <F9> when you are within a \ref command will
-try to list the \label's in the present directory. Pressing it when you are in a
-\cite command will list bibliography keys. Latex-Suite also recognizes commands
-which need a file name argument and will put up an explorer window for you to
-choose a filename.
-
- *ls-set-grepprg* *ls_a_eG*
-NOTE: Before you start with Latex-Suite's completion function...
- ----------------------------------------------------------
- All of Latex-Suite's completion capabilities depend on a external program
- being available on your system which can search through a number of files
- for a reg-exp pattern. On *nix systems, the pre-installed grep utility is
- more than adequate. Most windows systems come with a utility findstr, but
- that has proven to be very inadequate (for one, it does not have an option
- to force the file name to be displayed when searching through a single
- file). Your best bet is to install cygwin |ls_u_3|, but if you think
- that's overkill, you can search for |ls_u_4| a windows implementation of
- GNU grep. (Latex-Suite testing on windows has been done with cygwin's port
- of GNU grep).
-
- Once you have a grep program installed, you need to set the 'grepprg'
- option for vim. Make sure you use a setting which forces the program to
- display file names even when you are searching through a single file. For
- GNU grep, the syntax is >
- set grepprg=grep\ -nH\ $*
-<
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Latex-Suite completion example *ls_5_1* *ls_a_bS*
- *ls-completion-usage*
-
-Consider the situation where you are editing a file with two equations labelled
-eqn:euler and eqn:einstein. Now you want to insert a reference to one of these
-equations. To do this, you type the \ref{eqn:} command and with the cursor
-placed after eqn:, press <F9>. This will bring up two new windows beneath the
-main window you were working in as shown in the figure below. >
-
- 8 These are a couple of equations:
- 9 +-- 4 lines: eqnarray (eqn:euler) : e^{j\pi} + 1 &=& 0---------------
- 13 +-- 4 lines: equation (eqn:einstein) : E = m c^2---------------------
- 17
- 18 These are a couple of figures:
- 19 +-- 7 lines: figure (fig:monkeys) : Monkeys can Type-------------------
- 26 +-- 7 lines: figure (fig:shakespeare) : Shakespeare could not type-----
- 33
- 34 This is a reference to \ref{eqn:}<++>
- 35
- 36
- 37 \end{document}
- 38
- ~
- ~
- ~
- newfile.tex 34,32 Bot
- newfile.tex|11| \label{eqn:euler}
- newfile.tex|15| \label{eqn:einstein}
- ~
- [Error List] 1,1 All
- 7
- 8 These are a couple of equations:
- 9 \begin{eqnarray}
- 10 e^{j\pi} + 1 &=& 0
- 11 \label{eqn:euler}
- 12 \end{eqnarray}
- 13 \begin{equation}
- 14 E = m c^2
- 15 \label{eqn:einstein}
- 16 \end{equation}
- newfile.tex [Preview] 11,3 21%
-
-
-
-The first window (shown as [ErrorList] above) is a |cwindow| containing a list
-of possible matches for the reference. The cursor will be located in the first
-line of this window. The bottom window is a preview-window showing the context
-of the \label. Moving around in the [ErrorList] window automatically scrolls the
-preview window so as to always keep showing the context of the \label being
-viewed in the [ErrorList] window. You can also press J and K in the [ErrorList]
-window to scroll the preview window up and down.
-
-To insert one of the labels, simply position the cursor in the correct line in
-the [ErrorList] window and press <enter>. This will immediately close the two
-newly opened windows, get back to the correct location in the original file
-being edited and insert the label into the \ref command.
-
-If you notice carefully in the example above, the [ErrorList] window only showed
-the matches for the equations and did not list any of the figure labels. This is
-because we pressed <F9> after \ref{eqn: instead of simply after \ref{. This
-caused Latex-Suite to search only for those labels which started with the string
-eqn:. If you had pressed <F9> after a \ref{, you would have been shown matches
-from _all_ labels, not just those starting with eqn:.
-
-Thus prefixing all your labels with eqn:, fig:, tab: etc. depending on what you
-are labelling will lead to an easier time completing references.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Latex-Suite \ref completion *ls_5_2* *ls_a_bT*
- *ls-completion-ref*
-
-Pressing <F9> when you are within a partially completed \ref command will split
-open a window (named __OUTLINE__) which contains a nicely formatted list of all
-the \labels found in the present project. The \labels are heirarchically
-arranged according to which \section, \subsection etc of the overall document
-structure they are present in. For example, when you first press <F9> after
-typing \ref{, you should see something like: >
-
- +-- 54 lines: 2. Kinematics--------------------------------
- +-- 98 lines: 3. Aerodynamics of the MFI thorax------------
- +-- 40 lines: 4. Jump Resonance in Fourbar Mechanisms------
- +-- 28 lines: 5. Design and Fabrication Issues-------------
-
-Each chapter is |fold|ed away so that you can quickly jump to the correct
-section/subsection in which the relevant equation is defined. This makes
-inserting references significantly faster for large projects with hundreds of
-equations. You can then open some of the folds to see for example: >
-
- +-- 54 lines: 2. Kinematics--------------------------------
- 3. Aerodynamics of the MFI thorax
- 3.1. Aerodynamic modeling of the MFI wing forces
- 3.1.1. Geometric Specification
- eqn:wingnormal-pos
- \nhat = T_z(\theta_2) T_y(\theta_y)T_x(\theta_x)\nhat_0,
- eqn:T-1
- T_1(\theta_2) &=& T_z(\theta_2)
-
-The <Tab> key is mapped in this window to toggle folds so that you can quickly
-open/close folds in order to navigate the heirarchy faster. Once you are
-positioned on a label, press <Enter>. This closes the __OUTLINE__ window,
-returns to the window in which you pressed <F9> and inserts the reference at the
-current cursor position.
-
-NOTE: Filtering labels by prefix
- --------------------------
- You can press <F9> after typing part of the \label. In this case,
- Latex-Suite only presents \labels which begin with the already filled
- characters. You can use this to choose between equations, figures, tables
- etc. if you consistently label equations to begin with eqn:, figures to
- begin with fig: etc. For example, with this scheme, pressing <F9> after
- typing \ref{eqn: will only list equations.
-
-
-NOTE: Latex-Suite works the same way if you press <F9> after any command which
- contains the letters ref. Thus you can complete \eqref in exactly the same
- manner.
-
-
-NOTE: Requirements
- ------------
- This method of preseting the \labels depends on Vim being compiled with
- python support. To check if you have this, see the output of the :ver
- command. If you see something like +python, you are all set. Failing this,
- you will need to have python somewhere in your $PATH.
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Latex-Suite \cite completion *ls_5_3* *ls_a_bU*
- *latex-completion-cite*
-
-Latex-Suite provides an easy way to insert references to bibliographic entries.
-Pressing <F9> when the cursor is placed inside a partially completed \cite
-command will split open a new window (named __OUTLINE__) which contains a
-formatted and syntax highlighted list of all bibtex entries found. For example,
-pressing <F9> after typing \ref{ should present you with a window which looks
-something like this: >
-
- Article [dickinson:science:99]
- "Wing rotation and aerodynamic basis of insect flight"
- M. H. Dickinson and F-O. Lehman and S. P. Sane
- In Science, 1999
-
- Article [ellington:84:part1]
- "The Aerodynamics of Hovering Insect Flight. I. The Quasi-Steady Analysis"
- Ellington, C P
- In Philosophical Transactions of the Royal Society of London. Series B, Biological Sciences, 1984
-
- Article [ellington:84:part2]
- "The Aerodynamics of Hovering Insect Flight. II. Morphological Parameters"
- Ellington, C P
- In Philosophical Transactions of the Royal Society of London. Series B, Biological Sciences, 1984
-
-
-
-You can easily jump from one entry to another using the 'n' and 'p' keys (to go
-to the next / previous entry respectively).
-
-You can also filter out a subset of the bibtex entries by pressing 'f' while in
-this window. Doing this presents the following prompt: >
-
- Field acronyms: (`:let g:Tex_EchoBibFields = 0` to avoid this message)
- [t] title [a] author [b] booktitle
- [j] journal [y] year [p] bibtype
- (you can also enter the complete field name)
- Enter filter criterion [field<space>value]:
-
-At the prompt, type >
- a ellington
-Notice that the letter a is an acronym for author according to the prompt above.
-Therefore this filter only shows those bibtex entries whose author field
-contains the text ellington. You can keep narrowing your selection by repeatedly
-filtering the results. If you would like to remove all the filters and see all
-entries again, press 'a', which removes all the filters.
-
-You can also sort the bibtex entries based on a field. To do this, press 's'.
-This will present you with a prompt like in the case of the filter and you are
-asked to choose a field. In this case, you would type in a single character.
-This sorts the entries according to that field.
-
-NOTE: <F9> will also work in a similar way after any command which contains the
- word cite in it. For example, pressing <F9> will also work with \citenum
- etc.
-
-
-The following logic is applied to find out which bibliographic entries are
-included in the completion.
-
-
-1. Firstly, if the present file has a master-file [|ls_a_ct|] defined for it,
- then Latex-Suite will perform the following steps on that file instead of on
- the current file.
-
-2. First, the file is scanned for a \bibliography command. To explain better,
- assume that a command >
- \bibliography{file1,file2}
-< is found in the present file. For each bibliography file, say file1,
- Latex-Suite first tries to see if a .bib file, file1.bib can be found. If so,
- it will scan it for bib-keys of the form @BOOK{ etc., and add these searches
- to the completion list. If a .bib file cannot be found, then it will try to
- see if file1.bbl can be found. If so, Latex-Suite will search it for bib-keys
- of the form \bibitem and add these to the completion list.
-
- You can set the location where Latex-Suite will search for .bib and .bbl
- files using the |Tex_BIBINPUTS| [|ls_a_dr|] variable.
-
-3. If a \bibliography command is not found, then Latex-Suite tries to scan the
- present file for a \begin{thebibliography} environment. If found, Latex-Suite
- searches the present file for bib-keys of the form \bibitem.
-
-4. Finally, it will try to see if this file includes other files via the \input
- command. For each such file found, Latex-Suite will repeat the previous two
- steps stopping at the first file which has either a \bibliography command or
- a thebibliography environment.
-
-
-Caching the \cite completion results *ls_5_3_1* *ls_a_bV*
- *cite-search-caching*
-
- *TClearCiteHist* *ls_a_ec*
-Often times, the editing cycle proceeds by first laying out a comprehensive
-bibliography and then completing all the \cite commands in one session. In such
-situations, it is inefficient to scan the whole list of bibliography files for
-bib-keys each time. Latex-Suite provides a way to cache the results of the cite
-completion search using the Tex_RememberCiteSearch [|ls_a_du|] variable. If set,
-Latex-Suite will perform the search only the first time <F9> is used. Next time
-on, it will reuse the search results. If you wish to redo the search results,
-issue the command >
- TClearCiteHist
-This will redo the completion list next time you use <F9>.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Latex-Suite filename completion *ls_5_4* *ls_a_bW*
- *ls-filename-completion*
-
-When you press <F9> at a location where Latex-Suite guesses a filename needs to
-be typed, then a new explorer window will open up with the list of files. You
-can use this window to change directories etc. Pressing <enter> on a filename in
-the explorer window will automatically close the explorer window, return to the
-location where you pressed <F9> from and insert the filename into that position.
-
-Latex-Suite also tries to guess what kinds of files you might not want to insert
-and hides those accordingly. For example, if you press <F9> when you are located
-at \includegraphics{, then Latex-Suite knows that you will not want to insert
-.tex files. Therefore, the explorer window will automatically hide these files.
-
-As of now, Latex-Suite recognizes the following commands for filename
-completion. Along with the commands, this table also lists the files which
-Latex-Suite will not show for completing each command.
-
-command hide pattern~
-\bibliography '^\.,\.[^b]..$'
-\include \includeonly '^\.,\.[^t]..$'
-\includegraphics \psfig '^\.,\.tex$,\.bib$,\.bbl$,\.zip$,\.gz$'
-\input ''
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Custom command completion *ls_5_5* *ls_a_bX*
- *ls-completion-custom*
-
-Latex-Suite also recognizes certain commonly used LaTeX commands for the <F9>
-key. At the moment, the \bibliographystyle, \addtocontents and the
-\addcontentsline commands are recognized, although more will be added in the
-future. When you press the <F9> after such a command, Latex-Suite will prompt
-you with a list of arguments which make sense for the command.
-
-This functionality is available for commands for which a global variable of the
-form g:Tex_completion_{<command>} is defined where <command> is the command
-name. This variable is a comma separated list of values which this command
-takes. For example, the argument to the \bibliographystyle command is commonly
-one of abbr,alpha,plain,unsrt. Therefore, Latex-Suite defines >
- let g:Tex_completion_bibliographystyle = 'abbr,alpha,plain,unsrt'
-You can define your own completion variables in a similar manner for commands
-which you might use.
-
-================================================================================
-LaTeX Compiling *ls_6* *ls_a_bY*
- *latex-compiling*
-
-|ls_6_1| Setting Compilation rules
-|ls_6_2| Handling dependencies in compilation
-|ls_6_3| Compiling multiple times
-|ls_6_4| Customizing the compiler output
-|ls_6_5| Compiling parts of a file
-
-
-This functionality, available via the TeX-Suite menu, provides various tools to
-compile and debug LaTeX files from within Vim.
-
-If you are using commonly used LaTeX tools, then you should be all set as soon
-as you download and install Latex-Suite. In order to compile a LaTeX file,
-simply press \ll while editing the file. This runs latex on the current file and
-displays the errors in a |quickfix-window| below the file being edited. You can
-then scroll through the errors and press <enter> to be taken to the location of
-the corresponding error. Along with the errors being listed in the quickfix
-window, the corresponding log file is also opened in |preview| mode beneath the
-quickfix window. It is scrolled automatically to keep in sync with the error
-being viewed in the quickfix window. You will be automatically taken to the
-location of the first error/warning unless you set the g:Tex_GotoError
-[|ls_a_dD|] variable to 0.
-
-Latex-Suite also supports compiling LaTeX into formats other than DVI. By
-default, Latex-Suite supports PDF and PS formats. In order to choose a format
-other than DVI, use the TTarget command or the TeX-Suite > Target Format menu
-item. This will ask you to type in the name of the target format you want to
-compile to. If a rule has been defined for the format (as described in the next
-section [|ls_a_bZ|]), then Latex-Suite will switch to that format.
-
-Trying to choose a format for which no rule has been defined will result in
-Latex-Suite displaying a warning message without taking any action.
-
-If you are using a multiple file project and need to compile a master file while
-editing other files, then Latex-Suite provides a way to specify the file to be
-compiled as described in latex-master-file [|ls_a_ct|].
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Setting Compilation rules *ls_6_1* *ls_a_bZ*
- *compiler-rules*
-
-In order to compile LaTeX files into various formats, Latex-Suite needs to know
-which external programs to call and in which way they need to be called. This
-information is provided to Latex-Suite via a number of "rules". For each format
-you want to compile to, you need to specify a rule. A rule is specified by
-defining a variable of the form: >
- g:Tex_CompileRule_<format>
-where <format> is a string like "pdf", "dvi" etc.
-
-Example: By default, Latex-Suite uses the following rule for compiling LaTeX
-documents into DVI. >
- g:Tex_CompileRule_dvi = 'latex --interaction=nonstopmode $*'
-
-
-Default values are also provided for ps and pdf formats. You might want to
-change these rules in texrc according to your local tex environment.
-
-NOTE: For win32 users user MikTeX, sometimes the latex compiler's output has a
- bug where a single number is split across different lines. In this case,
- put the included vim-latex file distributed with Latex-Suite.
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Handling dependencies in compilation *ls_6_2* *ls_a_ca*
- *compiler-dependency*
-
-Latex-Suite also handles compiling dependencies automatically via certain rules
-which specify the "dependency chain" for each target format. For example, if in
-your case, you use >
- .tex -> .dvi -> .ps -> .pdf
-to generate pdf files from dvi files, then you will need to specify the
-following setting in your Latex-Suite configuration (see customizing Latex-Suite
-[|ls_a_cP|] for where these settings should go): >
-
- let g:Tex_FormatDependency_pdf = 'dvi,ps,pdf'
-
-This is a comma separated string of formats specifying the order in which the
-formats to be compiled into should be chosen. With this setting, if you set the
-target format to pdf, then the next time you compile via the \ll shortcut,
-Latex-Suite will first generate a dvi file, then use that to generate the ps
-file and finally create the pdf file from that.
-
-NOTE: If any of the intermediate formats is listed in the
- g:Tex_MultipleCompileFormats setting as described in the section Compiling
- multiple times [|ls_a_cb|], then Latex-Suite might make multiple calls to
- the compiler to generate the output file of that format.
-
-
-Along with the g:Tex_FormatDependency_{format} setting, you should ofcourse
-specify the rule for compiling to each of the formats as described in the
-previous section [|ls_a_bZ|]. For example, with the setting above, you could
-use: >
-
- let g:Tex_CompileRule_dvi = 'latex --interaction=nonstopmode $*'
- let g:Tex_CompileRule_ps = 'dvips -Ppdf -o $*.ps $*.dvi'
- let g:Tex_CompileRule_pdf = 'ps2pdf $*.ps'
-
-
-NOTE: By default, Latex-Suite does not specify any compiler dependencies. Each
- target format for which a rule has been derived will be compiled
- independently.
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Compiling multiple times *ls_6_3* *ls_a_cb*
- *compiling-multiple*
-
-Most LaTeX compilers need to be re-run several times in several commonly
-occurring situations in order to get a final camera ready copy. For example,
-when \label's change, when new \cite commands are added etc. If the target
-format you are compiling to requires multiple compilations, then you will need
-to include the format in the g:Tex_MultipleCompileFormats setting. This is a
-comma separated string of formats which need multiple compilations to be
-generated correctly.
-
-By default, this setting contains just the dvi format. If you use the pdflatex
-compiler to generate pdf files, then you might want to also include pdf into the
-above setting.
-
-For every format included in the g:Tex_MultipleCompileFormats setting described
-above, Latex-Suite will use the following logic to generate the file. Note that
-although the following description uses latex to refer to the compiler, it could
-be some other compiler such as pdflatex for generating pdf output.
-
-1. If there was a .idx file, then remember its contents.
-
-2. Run latex.
-
-3. If the .idx file changed due to the latex compiler, then run makeindex to
- redo the .ind file and then remember to rerun latex.
-
-4. If the .aux file generated by the latex compiler contains a \bibdata line,
- then it means that we are using a .bib file. Therefore, run bibtex.
-
- NOTE: This means that we will always run bibtex whenever we use the
- \bibliography command whether or not we actually need to. At this time,
- Latex-Suite does not parse the .aux file before and after the latex
- compiler to see if we are required to rerun bibtex.
-
-5. If the .bbl file changes because of this, then remember to rerun latex again.
-
-6. Also, we check to see if the LaTeX compiler gives certain standard warnings
- which notify that we need to compile once again. In this case also, remember
- to rerun LaTeX.
-
-7. If we found we had to rerun latex, then we repeat the steps above but not
- running makeindex or bibtex again.
-
-The LaTeX file is compiled atmost 5 times using this logic. These steps will
-ensure that on most platforms/environments, you will get a clean output with all
-the cross-references, citations etc correctly labelled and ordered.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Customizing the compiler output *ls_6_4* *ls_a_cc*
- *compiler-output-customization*
-
-Most LaTeX compilers produce a very large amount of output during compilation,
-most of which is not relevant to debugging type-setting errors. The compiler
-plugin provided with Latex-Suite (which is an enhanced version of the standard
-compiler plugin maintained by Artem Chuprina), provides a way to filter the
-compiler output so that the actual errors/warnings can be presented much more
-concisely.
-
-The compiler plugin is set up by default to function in a "non-verbose",
-"ignore-common-warnings" mode, which means that irrelevant lines from the
-compiler output will be ignored and some very common warnings are also ignored.
-Latex-Suite does this via the global variable g:Tex_IgnoredWarnings [|ls_a_dA|].
-This is a list of patterns, which can be used to filter out (or ignore) some or
-the warnings and errors reported by the compiler. See the link above for its
-default value.
-
-Latex-Suite uses the g:Tex_IgnoreLevel [|ls_a_dB|] setting to set a default
-ignore level. For example, for the default value of 4, Latex-Suite ignores
-warnings and errors matching the first 4 patterns in g:Tex_IgnoredWarnings.
-
-In addition to setting a default value of the ignore level, Latex-Suite provides
-the ability to set the level dynamically, using the TCLevel command. For
-example, if you issue the command: >
- TCLevel 3
-from within Vim, then the next time you compile the document, Latex-Suite will
-ignore warnings and errors which match the first three patterns in
-g:Tex_IgnoredWarnings.
-
-When TCLevel is called with the unquoted string strict as follows: >
- TClevel strict
-then Latex-Suite switches to a "verbose", "no-lines-ignored" mode which is
-useful when you want to make final checks of your document and want to be
-careful not to let things slip by.
-
-See the explanation of the settings g:Tex_IgnoredWarnings [|ls_a_dA|] and
-g:Tex_IgnoreLevel [|ls_a_dB|] to find out how to customize the filtering done by
-Latex-Suite
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Compiling parts of a file *ls_6_5* *ls_a_cd*
- *part-compiling*
-
-Latex-Suite also provides a way to compile a fragment of a document. This can be
-very useful while debugging a complex equation or one chapter in a book, etc.
-
-To do this, visually select a portion of the text and press \ll while in visual
-mode. The visually selected portion will be saved to a temporary file with the
-preamble from the current document prepended. Latex-Suite will then switch focus
-to this temporary file and compile it. Continue to debug this file as required
-and then replace the portion of the original file with this one.
-
-Pressing \lv while viewing the temporary file will view the output file
-generated from the temporary file, not the original file
-
-Two commands |TPartComp| and |TPartView| are provided to be able to get this
-functionality via the command line.
-
-From release 1.6 onwards of Latex-Suite, the temporary file created for part
-compilation will reside in the same directory as the file from which the
-fragment is being created. This ensures that any relative path-names defined in
-the fragment will still work. Latex-Suite will attempt to clean the temporary
-file(s) created when Vim exits.
-
-================================================================================
-Latex Viewing and Searching *ls_7* *ls_a_ce*
- *latex-viewing*
-
-|ls_7_1| Setting Viewing rules
-|ls_7_2| Forward Searching DVI documents
-|ls_7_3| Inverse Searching
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Setting Viewing rules *ls_7_1* *ls_a_cf*
- *latex-viewing-rules*
-
-In order to view the output files created by compiling the source files, you
-need to specify which external program Latex-Suite should call. You can specify
-the external program using one of two settings Tex_ViewRule_format [|ls_a_dF|]
-or Tex_ViewRuleComplete_format [|ls_a_dG|]. By default, Latex-Suite has default
-settings for viewing various common output formats via the Tex_ViewRule_format
-settings, so that if you are using commonly used programs, you should be all set
-to view compiled files from within Vim by simply pressing \lv.
-
-NOTE: The viewing function also takes the *.latexmain [|ls_a_ct|] file into
- account to decide which file to show.
-
-
-If pressing \lv does not work, then it most probably has to do with incorrect
-settings of the g:Tex_ViewRule_<format> [|ls_a_dF|] where <format> is the format
-you are attempting to view. See the link above for how to set this according to
-your system.
-
-In addition to viewing the files, Latex-Suite also supports forward and inverse
-searching for certain common tools for viewing DVI documents. At the moment,
-there is built-in support for YAP on windows (which ships with MikTeX), and the
-popular xdvi on *nix platforms. See the next few sections for details on forward
-and inverse searching.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Forward Searching DVI documents *ls_7_2* *ls_a_cg*
- *forward-searching*
-
-Forward searching refers to making a DVI viewer display a given document at a
-given location from within Vim. At present, this functionality is supported for
-YAP on windows and xdvi on *nix machines. Pressing \ls from within Vim should
-make the DVI viewer display the portion of the document where your cursor is
-placed.
-
- *enabling-searching* *ls_a_ed*
-NOTE: Enabling Forward and Inverse Searching
- --------------------------------------
- Most DVI viewers need "source-special" information in order to do forward
- (and inverse) searching. This information is embedded in the dvi file if
- the LaTeX source is compiled with the --src-specials option. By default,
- Latex-Suite does not supply this argument to the compiler. See the section
- on to find out how this option can be set.
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Inverse Searching *ls_7_3* *ls_a_ch*
- *inverse-searching*
-
-Inverse searching refers to the DVI viewer telling Vim to display the LaTeX
-source file at a given location when you double-click in the DVI viewer window.
-
-You will need to enable searching [|ls_a_ed|] in order to use this
-functionality.
-
-You will also need to specify certain settings to the DVI viewer conveying the
-syntax which it needs to use to tell Vim how to display the source file. In YAP,
-you can set this option in View > Options > Inverse Search. The Command Line
-field needs to be set as follows: >
- "C:\Program Files\vim\vim61\gvim" -c ":RemoteOpen +%l %f"
-The command :RemoteOpen is supplied when you install Latex-Suite.
-
-On *nix machines, Latex-Suite attempts to call the DVI viewer in such a way that
-it already knows how to communicate with Vim. If this does not seem to be
-working, you can use the RemoteOpen command described above.
-
-================================================================================
-Latex Folding *ls_8* *ls_a_ci*
- *latex-folding*
-
-|ls_8_1| Default Folding Scheme in Latex-Suite
-|ls_8_2| Customizing what to fold
-|ls_8_3| Editing the folding.vim file directly
-
-
-Latex-Suite ships with the plugin SyntaxFolds.vim which is a plugin for creating
-"fake" syntax folds on the fly. The fold method is actually manual but the
-folding is based on LaTeX syntax. This offers a speed increase over regular
-syntax folding. Ofcourse it has the disadvantage that the folds are not dynamic,
-i.e newly created syntax items are not automatically folded up. (This is a
-compromise between speed and convenience).
-
-When you open up a LaTeX file, all the portions will be automatically folded up.
-However, no new folds will be created until you press <F6> or \rf. (rf stands
-for "refresh folds").
-
-The fold-text is set to the first line of the folded text unless the fold is a
-table, figure etc. (an environment). In this case, if a \caption and/or a label
-is found in the folded region, then those are used to make a more meaningful
-fold-text, otherwise the second line of the environment is displayed along with
-the name of the environment. In other words, the following >
- \begin{figure}[h]
- \centerline{\psfig{figure=slidercrank.eps,height=6cm}}
- \caption{The Slider Crank Mechanism.}
- \label{fig:slidercrank}
- \end{figure}
- % a LaTeX comment.
- \begin{eqnarray}
- \sin(\pi) = 0
- \end{eqnarray}
-
-
-will be shown as: >
- +--- 5 lines: figure (fig:slidercrank) : The Slider Crank Mechanism. -----
- % a LaTeX comment.
- +--- 3 lines: eqnarray () : \sin(\pi) = 0 --------------------------------
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Default Folding Scheme in Latex-Suite *ls_8_1* *ls_a_cj*
- *default-folding*
-
-By default Latex-Suite creates folds in the following manner:
-
- >
- \chapter
- \section
- %%fakesection
- \subsection
- \subsubsection
- \item
- \equation
- \eqnarray
- \figure
- \table
- \footnote
-The indentation shows the "nestedness" of the folding scheme. See the next
-section [|ls_a_ck|] to see how you can change this scheme.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Customizing what to fold *ls_8_2* *ls_a_ck*
- *customizing-what-to-fold*
-
-From version 1.6 onwards, the folding in Latex-Suite can be controlled to a
-large extent via a number of global variables.
-
-
-
-Tex_FoldedSections *ls_8_2_1* *ls_a_cl*
- *Tex_FoldedSections*
-
-This entry defines which sections will be folded. This setting is a comma
-separated list of section names. The default value is: >
- part,chapter,section,%%fakesection,
- subsection,subsubsection,paragraph
-Each of the entries in the list will fold up a section of the corresponding
-name. The %%fakesection section is provided as a means for the user to group
-lines into "fake" sections. A %%fakesection is assumed to start on a line which
-begins with the string %%fakesection and continue till the start of the next
-\section, \subsection or any other section.
-
-See also advanced fold settings [|ls_a_cp|].
-
-
-Tex_FoldedEnvironments *ls_8_2_2* *ls_a_cm*
- *Tex_FoldedEnvironments*
-
-This entry defines which environments will be folded. It is a comma separated
-string of words each of which defines a single environment. The default setting
-is >
- verbatim,comment,eq,gather,
- align,figure,table,thebibliography,
- keywords,abstract,titlepage
-The words need not be standard Latex environments. You can add any word you
-like. Also, each word will fold up all environments whose name begins with that
-word. For example, in the setting above, the word "eq" folds up the
-\begin{equation}, \begin{eqnarray}, \begin{eqnarray*} environments. To avoid
-this, you can replace the word "eq" with "eq}".
-
-See also advanced fold settings [|ls_a_cp|].
-
-
-Tex_FoldedCommands *ls_8_2_3* *ls_a_cn*
- *Tex_FoldedCommands*
-
-This entry defines which commands will be folded. It is a comma separated string
-of words each of which defines a single command. The default setting is empty,
-i.e no commands are folded. The words need not be standard Latex commands. You
-can use whatever words you like. Each word will fold all commands whose name
-begins with that word as in the case of the Tex_FoldedEnvironments [|ls_a_cm|]
-variable.
-
-NOTE: It is very difficult to fold commands reliably because it is very
- difficult to create a regexp which will match a line containing unmatched
- parentheses (or curly brackets), but will not match a line containing
- matched parentheses.
-
- Just to make things safer, only lines which start a command but do not
- contain additional curly braces after the command has started are folded.
- In other words, if you wanted to fold the the command "mycommand", then
- the lines >
- \mycommand{This is a line
- and some more text on the next line
- }
-< will be folded, but the lines >
- \mycommand{This is a \textbf{line}
- and some more text
- }
-< will not be folded. This is a bug which is very difficult to fix.
-
-
-See also advanced fold settings [|ls_a_cp|].
-
-
-Tex_FoldedMisc *ls_8_2_4* *ls_a_co*
- *Tex_FoldedMisc*
-
-This entry defines fold syntax for certain items which do not naturally fit into
-the section, environment of command lists. It is a comma separated list of
-words. The default value is: >
- item,preamble,<<<
-NOTE: Unlike the other Tex_FoldedXXXX variables, the words in this setting are
- limited to take values from the following list:
-
- Value Meaning~
- comments Folds up contiguous blocks of comments
- item Folds up the \items within list environments
- preamble Folds up the preamble of a document. (The part between the
- \documentclass command and the \begin{document} environment)
- <<< Folds defined manually by the user using the <<< and >>> strings
- as fold-markers.
-
- Any other words in the Tex_FoldedMisc setting are silently ignored.
-
-
-
-See also advanced fold settings [|ls_a_cp|].
-
-
-Advanced Fold setting details *ls_8_2_5* *ls_a_cp*
- *fold-setting-advanced*
-
-The order of the words in the Tex_FoldedXXXX variables is _important_. The order
-defines the order in which the folds are nested. For example, the value
-"subsection,section" for the Tex_FoldedSections variable will not fold any
-subsections at all. This is because the folds are created in the _reverse_ order
-in which they occur in the Tex_FoldedSections setting and also, once a fold is
-created, the interior of the fold is not examined for creating additional folds.
-In the above case, this means that a \section is folded first and then its
-interior is not examined further. The correct value should have been
-"section,subsection"
-
- *fold-setting-adding* *ls_a_ee*
-Each of the fold setting variables Tex_FoldedSections, Tex_FoldedEnvironments
-etc., as explained previously is a comma separated string of variables. However,
-to make it easier to _add_ to the default settings without having to repeat the
-whole default setting again, Latex-Suite uses the following logic in forming the
-complete setting string from the Tex_FoldedXXXX variables. If the variable
-starts with a comma, then Tex_FoldedXXXX is added to the end of the default
-string rather than replacing it. Similarly, if it ends with a comma, then it
-will be prepended to the beginning of the default setting rather than replacing
-it.
-
-For example, if Tex_FoldedEnvironments is set to the string "myenv", then only
-an environment of the form \begin{myenv} will be folded. However, if the
-Tex_FoldedEnvironments setting is ",myenv", then the \begin{myenv} environment
-will be folded after all other environments in the default setting have been
-folded. On the other hand if Tex_FoldedEnvironments is of the form "myenv,", the
-\begin{myenv} environment will be folded before the rest of the environments in
-the default setting.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Editing the folding.vim file directly *ls_8_3* *ls_a_cq*
- *editing-folding*
-
-If you are using version 1.5 of Latex-Suite or older, you will need to directly
-edit the $VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/folding.vim file if you wish to modify the
-folding scheme. You will need to modify the function MakeTexFolds() defined in
-that file to modify the fold syntax. MakeTexFolds makes a number of calls to
-AddSyntaxFoldItem. Each such call defines a new "fold item". The order in which
-these calls are made defines how the folds are nested. For example, if you
-desire an figure environment to be nested within a section, then you should
-define the fold for the figure first. The syntax of AddSyntaxFoldItem is as
-follows: >
- AddSyntaxFoldItem(startpat, endpat, startoff, endoff [, startskip, endskip])
-If the last two arguments are omitted, then they are assumed to default to the
-empty strings ''. The explanation for each argument is as follows:
-
-Argument Explanation~
-startpat a line matching this pattern defines the beginning of a fold.
-endpat a line matching this pattern defines the end of a fold.
-startoff this is the offset from the starting line at which folding will
- actually start
-endoff like startoff, but gives the offset of the actual fold end from the
- line satisfying endpat. startoff and endoff are necessary when the
- folding region does not have a specific end pattern corresponding to
- a start pattern. for example in LaTeX, \section{Section Name} defines
- the beginning of a section, but there is no command which
- specifically ends a section. Thus a \section is assumed to end 1 line
- _before_ another section starts.
-startskip A Pattern Which Defines The Beginning Of A "Skipped" Region.
-
- For example, suppose we define a \itemize fold as follows: >
- = '^\s*\\item',
- = '^\s*\\item\|^\s*\\end{\(enumerate\|itemize\|description\)}',
- = 0,
- = -1
-<
-
- This defines a fold which starts with a line beginning with an \item
- and ending one line before a line beginning with an \item or
- \end{enumerate} etc.
-
- Then, as long as \item's are not nested things are fine. However,
- once items begin to nest, the fold started by one \item can end
- because of an \item in an \itemize environment within this \item.
- i.e, the following can happen: >
- \begin{itemize}
- \item Some text <------- fold will start here
- This item will contain a nested item
- \begin{itemize} <----- fold will end here because next line contains \item...
- \item Hello
- \end{itemize} <----- ... instead of here.
- \item Next item of the parent itemize
- \end{itemize}
-<
-
- Therefore, in order to completely define a folding item which allows
- nesting, we need to also define a "skip" pattern. startskip and end
- skip do that. Leave '' when there is no nesting.
-endskip the pattern which defines the end of the "skip" pattern for nested
- folds.
-
-NOTE: Example 1
- ---------
- A syntax fold region for the latex section is defined with the following
- arguments to AddSyntaxFoldItem: >
- startpat = "\\section{"
- endpat = "\\section{"
- startoff = 0
- endoff = -1
- startskip = ''
- endskip = ''
-< Note that the start and end patterns are thus the same and endoff has a
- negative value to capture the effect of a section ending one line before
- the next starts.
-
-
-NOTE: Example 2
- ---------
- A syntax fold region for the \itemize environment is: >
- startpat = '^\s*\\item',
- endpat = '^\s*\\item\|^\s*\\end{\(enumerate\|itemize\|description\)}',
- startoff = 0,
- endoff = -1,
- startskip = '^\s*\\begin{\(enumerate\|itemize\|description\)}',
- endskip = '^\s*\\end{\(enumerate\|itemize\|description\)}'
-< Note the use of startskip and endskip to allow nesting.
-
-
-
-================================================================================
-Multiple file LaTeX projects *ls_9* *ls_a_cr*
- *latex-project*
-
-|ls_9_1| Latex-Suite project settings
-|ls_9_2| Specifying which file to compile
-
-
- *latex-project-example* *ls_a_ef*
-Many LaTeX projects contain multiple source files which are \included from a
-master file. A typical example of this situation is a directory layout such as
-the following
-
- >
- thesis/
- main.tex
- abstract.tex
- intro/
- intro.tex
- figures/
- fig1.eps
- fig2.eps
- chapter1/
- chap1.tex
- figures/
- fig1.eps
- conclusion/
- conclusion.tex
- figures/
-
-
-In the above case, main.tex will typically look like
-
- >
- % file: main.tex
- \documentclass{report}
- \begin{document}
-
- \input{abstract.tex}
- \input{intro/intro.tex}
- \input{chapter1/chap1.tex}
- \input{conclusion/conclusion.tex}
-
- \end{document}
-
-
- *latex-master-file-specification* *ls_a_eg*
-In such situations, you will need to convey to Latex-Suite that main.tex is the
-main file which \inputs the other files. This is done by creating a file called
-main.tex.latexmain in the same directory in which main.tex resides. This file is
-called the _master file_ in this manual. See Tex_MainFileExpression [|ls_a_eh|]
-for an alternative way of specifying the master file.
-
-NOTE: Here main.tex.latexmain is (obviously) a different file from main.tex
- itself. main.tex need not be renamed. This ofcourse restricts each
- directory to have a single master file.
-
-
-Each time Latex-Suite opens a new LaTeX file, it will try to see if it is part
-of a multiple file project by searching upwards (to the root of the file-system)
-from the current file's directory to see if it finds a file of the form
-*.latexmain. If such a file is found, then it is considered that the current
-file is part of a larger project. The name of the LaTeX master file is inferred
-directly from the first part of the *.latexmain file as described in the example
-above.
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Latex-Suite project settings *ls_9_1* *ls_a_cs*
- *latex-project-settings*
-
-If a master file [|ls_a_ct|] is found, then Latex-Suite :sources the file. Thus
-this file needs to contain valid Vim commands. This file is typically used to
-store project specific settings.
-
-Some typical per-project settings which are best put in the master file are
-Tex_ProjectSourceFiles [|ls_a_dt|]
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Specifying which file to compile *ls_9_2* *ls_a_ct*
- *latex-master-file*
-
-In the example described previously [|ls_a_ef|], if you are editing
-intro/intro.tex and press \ll, then you still want Latex-Suite to compile
-main.tex, because intro/intro.tex is merely a fragment which is \input'ed into
-main.tex. If the master file is already specified using the *.latexmain
-convention described previously [|ls_a_ef|], then Latex-Suite will automatically
-compile the master file when you are editing any of its \input'ed fragments.
-Thus pressing \ll while editing intro/intro.tex will compile main.tex.
-
- *Tex_MainFileExpression* *ls_a_eh*
-If you wish to use some different logic to specify the main file name, you can
-specify a custom expression via the Tex_MainFileExpression variable. This is a
-string containing a valid vim expression. In addition, you can use a variable
-modifier which is in the format used for |filename-modifiers|, for example,
-':p:h'. You should utilize this variable to modify the filename of the main
-file. >
- let g:Tex_MainFileExpression = 'MainFile(modifier)'
- function! MainFile(fmod)
- if glob('*.latexmain') != ''
- return fnamemodify(glob('*.latexmain'), a:fmod)
- else
- return ''
- endif
- endif
-
-
-================================================================================
-Latex-Suite Commands and Maps *ls_10* *ls_a_cu*
- *latex-suite-commands-maps*
-
-|ls_10_1| Latex-Suite Maps
-|ls_10_2| Latex Suite Commands
-
-
-This section describes the maps and commands used in Latex-Suite. It also
-describes a way to change the map sequences according to your preference.
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Latex-Suite Maps *ls_10_1* *ls_a_cv*
- *latex-suite-maps*
-
- *remapping-latex-suite-keys* *ls_a_ei*
-Most of the mappings used in Latex-Suite can be mapped to a different key
-combination to suit your particular needs. An example best explains the
-procedure for doing this. Suppose you want to remap the <C-j> key which
-Latex-Suite (actually imaps.vim) uses to jump to the next placeholder. To do
-this, you first need to find out which <Plug> mapping <C-j> is derived from. You
-will need to look at the relevant section of this manual to do this. For
-example, the section IMAP mappings [|ls_a_cw|] has the information that the
-<C-j> key is derived from <Plug>IMAP_JumpForward. Therefore to remap the <C-j>
-key to say <C-space>, you will need to put a statement like the following in
-your ~/.vimrc. >
- imap <C-space> <Plug>IMAP_JumpForward
-
-
-NOTE: To change the IMAP mappings which affect jumping between placeholders, the
- map statement above has to be placed in your ~/.vimrc. For other mappings
- you can place the map statement in your $VIM/ftplugin/tex.vim file. The
- reason for this is that the <C-j> maps are created in plugin/imaps.vim,
- which is sourced as soon as Vim starts before sourcing any ftplugin files.
-
-
-
-
-IMAP mappings *ls_10_1_1* *ls_a_cw*
- *customize-imap-maps*
-
-These mappings are utilized for jumping between placeholders as described here
-[|ls_a_eD|]. See the parent section [|ls_a_cv|] to find out how to use this
-information to change the default maps.
-
- *Plug_IMAP_JumpForward* *ls_a_ej*
- *Plug_IMAP_JumpBack* *ls_a_ek*
- *Plug_IMAP_DeleteAndJumpForward* *ls_a_el*
- *Plug_IMAP_DeleteAndJumBack* *ls_a_em*
-Plug map Default Key~
-<Plug>IMAP_JumpForward <C-j>
-<Plug>IMAP_JumpBack (none)
-<Plug>IMAP_DeleteAndJumpForward (none)
-<Plug>IMAP_DeleteAndJumpBack (none)
-
-<Plug>IMAP_JumpForward takes you to the location of the next place-holder
-[|ls_a_eD|].
-
-<Plug>IMAP_JumpBack takes you to the previous place-holder [|ls_a_eD|].
-
-<Plug>IMAP_DeleteAndJumpForward deletes the presently selected place-holder and
-jumps to the next place-holder irrespective of whether the present placeholder
-is empty or not and ignoring the value of place-holder settings like
-g:Imap_DeleteEmptyPlaceHolders [|ls_a_cW|] and g:Imap_StickyPlaceHolders
-[|ls_a_cX|]
-
-<Plug>IMAP_DeleteAndJumpBack deletes the presently selected place-holder and
-jumps to the previous place-holder irrespective of whether the present
-placeholder is empty or not and ignoring the value of place-holder settings like
-g:Imap_DeleteEmptyPlaceHolders [|ls_a_cW|] and g:Imap_StickyPlaceHolders
-[|ls_a_cX|]
-
-
-Alt-Key mappings *ls_10_1_2* *ls_a_cx*
- *customize-alt-key-maps*
-
-These mappings are are described in the section Alt key macros [|ls_a_bA|]. See
-the parent section [|ls_a_ei|] to see how to use the following information to
-remap keys.
-
- *Plug_Tex_MathBF* *ls_a_en*
- *Plug_Tex_MathCal* *ls_a_eo*
- *Plug_Tex_LeftRight* *ls_a_ep*
- *Plug_Tex_InsertItem* *ls_a_eq*
-Plug Mapping Default Key~
-<Plug>Tex_MathBF <Alt-B>
-<Plug>Tex_MathCal <Alt-C>
-<Plug>Tex_LeftRight <Alt-L>
-<Plug>Tex_InsertItem <Alt-I>
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Latex Suite Commands *ls_10_2* *ls_a_cy*
- *latex-suite-commands*
-
-
-
-:TMacro [{macro}] *ls_10_2_1* *ls_a_cz* *TMacro*
-
-When used without any arguments lists all available macros defined in runtime
-ftplugin/latex-suite/macros/ directories and prompts you to choose one of them.
-With one argument |:read| this macro under cursor position. With more than one
-argument it will not work :) In Vim >= 6.2 works completion of names of macros
-(see 'wildmenu', 'wildmode' for more about command-line completion).
-
-
-:TMacroEdit [{macro}] *ls_10_2_2* *ls_a_cA*
- *TMacroEdit*
-
-Splits window for editing {macro}. When used without any arguments lists all
-available macros defined in runtime ftplugin/latex-suite/macros/ directories and
-prompt you to choose one of them. When you try to edit {macro} not from local
-directory Latex-Suite will copy it to your local directory with suffix "-local".
-If local copy already exists Latex-Suite prompt for overwriting it. In Vim >=
-6.2 works completion of names of macros (see 'wildmenu', 'wildmode' for more
-about command-line completion).
-
-
-:TMacroNew *ls_10_2_3* *ls_a_cB*
- *TMacroNew*
-
-Splits window to write new macro. Directory in new buffer is locally changed to
-Latex-Suite/macros/.
-
-
-:TMacroDelete [{macro}] *ls_10_2_4* *ls_a_cC*
- *TMacroDelete*
-
-Delets {macro} from your local ftplugin/latex-suite/macros/ directory. When used
-without any arguments lists all available macros defined in Latex-Suite/macros/
-directory and prompt you to choose one of them. When you choose to delete
-{macro} which is not in your local directory Latex-Suite will refuse to delete
-it. In Vim >= 6.2 works completion of names of macros (see 'wildmenu',
-'wildmode' for more about command-line completion)
-
-
-:TPackage [{package, ...}] *ls_10_2_5* *ls_a_cD*
- *TPackage*
-
-When used without any arguments lists name of the packages for which support is
-available. If you are using Vim GUI and have Tex_Menus set to 1, then it will
-list all files found in the $VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/packages directory.
-Otherwise, Latex-Suite will list files found in the
-$VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/dictionaries directory. Choosing a file from the list
-will insert a >
- \usepackage[<++>]{<packname>}
-line into the buffer at the current cursor location. For Vim 6.2 and above, you
-can use command-line completion to choose a package file. You can also call
-TPackage with one or more package names separated with spaces in which case,
-Latex-Suite will insert \usepackage lines for each of them in turn.
-
-After inserting the \usepackage line(s), Latex-Suite will support it (them) in
-various ways as described in the section Actions taken for supported packages
-[|ls_a_bL|].
-
-
-:TPackageUpdate *ls_10_2_6* *ls_a_cE*
- *TPackageUpdate*
-
-This command `reads' name of package under cursor and turns on possible support.
-
-
-:TPackageUpdateAll *ls_10_2_7* *ls_a_cF*
- *TPackageUpdateAll*
-
-After issuing this command latexSuite scans the file in looking for not declared
-packages, removing not needed entries from Packages menu and turning off not
-necessary packages' dictionaries.
-
-
-:TTemplate [{template}] *ls_10_2_8* *ls_a_cG*
- *TTemplate*
-
-When used without any arguments lists all available templates from
-latex-suite/templates/ directory and prompts to choose one of them. With one
-argument :0|read| {template} file. With more than one argument it will not work
-:) In Vim >= 6.2 works completion of names of macros (see 'wildmenu', 'wildmode'
-for more about command-line completion)
-
-
-:TSection [{argument}] *ls_10_2_9* *ls_a_cH*
- *TSection*
-
-Used without any arguments inserts last section type (|latex-sectioning|).
-Accepts arguments: n> inserts section name in <n> logical level. Levels are:
-0 part
-1 chapter
-2 section
-3 subsection
-4 subsubsection
-5 paragraph
-6 subparagraph
-
-
-+<n> inserts section name <n> logical levels above the last used comand
--<n> inserts section name <n> logical levels below the last used comand
-+ inserts section name one logical level below the last used command (equal
- to +1).
-++ inserts section name two logical levels below the last used command (equal
- to +2).
-- inserts section name one logical level over the last used command (equal
- to -1).
--- inserts section name two logical levels over the last used command (equal
- to -2).
-
-
-
-Command accepts also latexSuite mappings (|latex-macros|) without preceding S
-and in lowercase: >
- :TSection pa
-will result in \part{}. It is possible to use full names of sections: :TSection
-part
-
-
-:TSectionAdvanced *ls_10_2_10* *ls_a_cI*
- *TSectionAdvanced*
-
-Accepts the same arguments as |TSection| but leads to a couple of questions
-(whether you want to include the section in the table of contents, whether there
-is a shorter name for the table of contents) and then creates a more intelligent
-template.
-
-
-:TLook *ls_10_2_11* *ls_a_cJ* *TLook*
-
-Accepts one argument. Will look through .tex files in directory of edited file
-for argument. It can be regexp. You don't have to enclose argument in "". <cr>
-takes you to location. Other keys work as described in |latex-viewer|. Note:
-TLook uses :grep command and is using 'grepprg'. Its regular expressions can be
-different from those of Vim.
-
-
-:TLookBib *ls_10_2_12* *ls_a_cK*
- *TLookBib*
-
-Accepts one argument. Will look through .bib files in directory of edited file
-for argument. It can be regexp. You don't have to enclose argument in "". <cr>
-takes you to location. Other keys work as described in |latex-viewer|.
-
-NOTE: TLookBib uses :grep command and is using 'grepprg'. Its regular
- expressions can be different from those of Vim.
-
-
-
-
-:TLookAll *ls_10_2_13* *ls_a_cL*
- *TLookAll*
-
-Accepts one argument. Will look through all files in directory of edited file
-for argument. It can be regexp. You don't have to enclose argument in "". <cr>
-takes you to location. Other keys work as described in |latex-viewer|. Note:
-TLook uses :grep command and is using 'grepprg'. Its regular expressions can be
-different from those of Vim.
-
-
-:TPartComp *ls_10_2_14* *ls_a_cM*
- *TPartComp*
-
-No argument allowed but accepts range in all formats. Define fragment of
-interest with :'a,'b, :/a/,/b/, :'<,'> or :20,30. All other rules of compilation
-apply.
-
-
-:TPartView *ls_10_2_15* *ls_a_cN*
- *TPartView*
-
-Show last compiled fragment. All rules of viewing apply but |latex-searching|.
-
-
-:Tshortcuts [{arg}] *ls_10_2_16* *ls_a_cO*
- *Tshortcuts*
-
-Show shortcuts in terminal (not using menu). Without {arg} you will see simple
-menu prompting for one of them. Possible arguments:
-g General shortcuts
-e Environment shortcuts
-f Font shortcuts
-s Section shortcuts
-m Math shortcuts
-a All shortcuts
-
-================================================================================
-Customizing Latex-Suite *ls_11* *ls_a_cP*
- *customizing-latex-suite*
-
-|ls_11_1| General Settings
-|ls_11_2| Place-Holder Customization
-|ls_11_3| Macro Customization
-|ls_11_4| Smart Key Customization
-|ls_11_5| Latex Completion Customization
-|ls_11_6| Compiler Customization
-|ls_11_7| Viewer Customization
-|ls_11_8| Menu Customization
-|ls_11_9| Folding Customization
-|ls_11_10| Package Handling Customization
-
-
-Customizing Latex-Suite is done by defining certain global variables in
-$VIM/ftplugin/tex.vim, where $VIM corresponds to ~/.vim for *nix machines and
-~/vimfiles for windows machines. This file is not part of the Latex-Suite
-distribution. You will need to create this file yourself (or modify it if it
-exists) if you need to change any default settings. Since this file is not
-included as part of the Latex-Suite distribution, it will not be over-written in
-subsequent updates.
-
-The default settings in Latex-Suite are defined in
-$VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/texrc. Please take a look at this file if you find
-this documentation incomplete or confusing. That file is also well documented.
-
-This chapter describes the various settings which effect Latex-Suite and their
-default values. The settings are broken up into sections according to the
-behavior which they influence.
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-General Settings *ls_11_1* *ls_a_cQ*
- *ls-general-purpose-settings*
-
-
-
-Tex_Debug *ls_11_1_1* *ls_a_cR*
- *Tex_Debug*
-
-Type boolean
-Default Value 0
-
-If set to 1, then Latex-Suite will create certain global debug statements which
-can be printed by doing >
- :call Tex_PrintDebug()
-
-
-
-Tex_UsePython *ls_11_1_2* *ls_a_cS*
- *Tex_UsePython*
-
-Type boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-If Latex-Suite detects that your vim is python enabled (using has('python')),
-then it tries to use python in certain places to speed things up. If this
-misbehaves, you can set this to zero, in which case, Latex-Suite will use
-vimscript to accomplish the same.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Place-Holder Customization *ls_11_2* *ls_a_cT*
- *customizing-place-holders*
-
-Latex-Suite uses place-holders [|ls_a_eD|] to minimize using the movement keys
-while typing. The following settings affect how place-holders are used.
-
-NOTE: These setting need to be set in your ~/.vimrc, not $VIM/ftplugin/tex.vim
- because these settings affect the behavior of imaps.vim, which is a global
- plugin, not a file-type plugin.
-
-
-
-
-g:Imap_UsePlaceHolders *ls_11_2_1* *ls_a_cU*
- *Imap_UsePlaceHolders*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-Setting this to zero completely disables using place-holders.
-
-
-g:Imap_PlaceHolderStart & g:Imap_PlaceHolderEnd *ls_11_2_2* *ls_a_cV*
- *Imap_PlaceHolderStart*
-
- *Imap_PlaceHolderEnd* *ls_a_er*
-Setting Type Value~
-Imap_PlaceHolderStart String '<+'
-Imap_PlaceHolderEnd String '+>'
-
-These settings affect the strings displayed at the beginning and end of the
-place-holder string. Set these strings to a value different than a commonly
-occurring sequence of characters.
-
-NOTE: TIP
- ---
- If you use the latin1 encoding and do not type in french, then you can set
- these strings to the \xab and \xbb characters (the french quotation
- marks).
-
-
-
-
-g:Imap_DeleteEmptyPlaceHolders *ls_11_2_3* *ls_a_cW*
- *Imap_DeleteEmptyPlaceHolders*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-When set to one, non-descriptive or empty place-holders are deleted on pressing
-<Ctrl-J>.
-
-
-g:Imap_StickyPlaceHolders *ls_11_2_4* *ls_a_cX*
- *Imap_StickyPlaceHolders*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-When set to 1, in visual mode, <Ctrl-J> takes you to the next placeholder
-without deleting the current placeholder.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Macro Customization *ls_11_3* *ls_a_cY*
- *customizing-macros*
-
-
-
-Tex_Env_name *ls_11_3_1* *ls_a_cZ*
- *Tex_Env_name*
-
-If you wish to wish to expand certain environments differently from the way
-Latex-Suite does it, you can define custom expansions using global variables of
-the form Tex_Env_{name} where name corresponds to the environment.
-
-For example, if you press <F5> after typing theorem, Latex-Suite will by default
-expand it to >
- \begin{theorem}
- \label{<++>}<++>
- \end{theorem}<++>
-However, if you wish change this to >
- \begin{theorem}
- <++>
- \end{theorem}<++>
-then define the following variable >
- let g:Tex_Env_theorem = "\\begin{theorem}\<CR><++>\<CR>\\end{theorem}"
-<
-
-If the expansion uses special keys such as carriage return etc, then use
-double-quotes and use the "\<key>" notation for special keys. Backslashes have
-to be doubled.
-
-You could even use strings returned by functions as the expansion by using the
-IMAP_PutTextWithMovement() [|ls_a_ea|] function.
-
-If the name of the environment contains special characters (for example, the
-eqnarray* environment), then use the following form: >
- let g:Tex_Env_{'eqnarray*'} =
- \ "\\begin{eqnarray*}\<CR><++> &=& <++>\<CR>\\end{eqnarray*}<++>"
-This will make pressing <F5> after eqnarray* expand to >
- \begin{eqnarray*}
- <++> &=& <++>
- \end{eqnarray*}<++>
-
-
-
-Tex_Com_name *ls_11_3_2* *ls_a_da*
- *Tex_Com_name*
-
-If you wish to define new expansions for fast command insertion as described
-here [|ls_a_bo|], or redefine expansions from the default values in Latex-Suite,
-you will need to define variables of the form g:Tex_Com_{name} where name is a
-command name. For example, with the setting >
- let g:Tex_Com_frac = "\\frac{<++>}{<++>}<++>"
-pressing <F7> after typing frac will change it to \frac{<++>}{<++>}<++>
-
-See Tex_Env_name [|ls_a_cZ|] for additional details on how to create this
-setting in various special circumstances.
-
-
-Enabling / disabling macros *ls_11_3_3* *ls_a_db*
- *macro-enabling*
-
-The following variables disable various parts of the macro functionality of
-Latex-Suite. See the links to the relevant sections to see what functionality
-setting each of the variables to zero will take away.
-
- *Tex_EnvironmentMaps* *ls_a_es*
- *Tex_EnvironmentMenus* *ls_a_et*
- *Tex_FontMaps* *ls_a_eu*
- *Tex_FontMenus* *ls_a_ev*
- *Tex_SectionMaps* *ls_a_ew*
- *Tex_SectionMenus* *ls_a_ex*
-Setting Link to relevant section Default Value~
-g:Tex_EnvironmentMaps Environment Mappings [|ls_a_bf|] 1
-g:Tex_EnvironmentMenus 1
-g:Tex_FontMaps Font Mappings [|ls_a_bs|] 1
-g:Tex_FontMenus 1
-g:Tex_SectionMaps Section Mappings [|ls_a_bt|] 1
-g:Tex_SectionMenus 1
-
-
-g:Tex_UseMenuWizard *ls_11_3_4* *ls_a_dc*
- *Tex_UseMenuWizard*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 0
-
-If this variable is set to 1, then when an environment is chosen from the menu
-then for selected environments, Latex-Suite asks a series of questions on the
-command line and inserts a template with the corresponding fields already filled
-in. Setting this to zero will insert a template with place-holders [|ls_a_eD|]
-marking off the places where fields need to be filled.
-
-
-g:Imap_FreezeImap *ls_11_3_5* *ls_a_dd*
- *Imap_FreezeImap*
-
-Type boolean
-Default Value 0
-
-This option when set to 1, temporarily freezes Latex-Suite's macro expansion. It
-might be useful when you are using some other keymap which is causing excessive
-macro expansion. Use a buffer-local variable of the same name if you wish to
-affect just the present buffer.
-
-
-g:Tex_CatchVisMapErrors *ls_11_3_6* *ls_a_de*
- *Tex_CatchVisMapErrors*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-With so many visual maps, its helpful to have a way of catching typing errors
-made in visual mode. What this does is to prompt you to correct your visual mode
-mapping if you start out with and then type some illegal keys. It basically maps
-just the g:Tex_Leader character to a function.
-
-
-g:Tex_Diacritics *ls_11_3_7* *ls_a_df*
- *Tex_Diacritics*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 0
-
-Whether or not you want to use diacritics [|ls_a_bw|].
-
-
-g:Tex_Leader *ls_11_3_8* *ls_a_dg*
- *Tex_Leader*
-
-
-Type String
-Default Value '`'
-
-The mappings in Latex-Suite are by default prefixed with the back-tick
-character. For example, `/ inserts \frac{<++>}{<++>}<++> etc. You can change the
-prefix with the following setting. ',', '/', '`' are preferred values. '' or '\'
-will lead to a _lot_ of trouble.
-
-g:Tex_Leader is also used for visual mode mappings for fonts.
-
-
-g:Tex_Leader2 *ls_11_3_9* *ls_a_dh*
- *Tex_Leader2*
-
-
-Type String
-Default Value ','
-
-In order to avoid clashes between the large number of visual mode macros
-provided, the visual mode macros for environments [|ls_a_bm|] and sections start
-with a character different from g:Tex_Leader.
-
-
-g:Tex_PromptedEnvironments *ls_11_3_10* *ls_a_di*
- *Tex_PromptedEnvironments*
-
-
-Type String
-Default Value 'eqnarray*,eqnarray,equation,equation*,\[,$$,align,align*'
-
-This string represents a comma separated list of fields corresponding to
-environments. Pressing <F5> in insert-mode in the body of the document asks you
-to choose from one of these environments to insert.
-
-Leaving this string empty will leave the <F5> key unmapped
-
-
-g:Tex_HotKeyMappings *ls_11_3_11* *ls_a_dj*
- *Tex_HotKeyMappings*
-
-
-Type String
-Default Value 'eqnarray*,eqnarray,bmatrix'
-
-This string represents a comma separated list of environments which are mapped
-to <Shift-F-1> through <Shift-F-4>. For example, pressing <Shift-F-2> with this
-setting inserts the eqnarray environment.
-
-Leaving this string empty will leave <Shift-F-1> through <Shift-F-4> unmapped.
-
-NOTE: Only the first four fields of this list are used. The rest are silently
- ignored.
-
-
-
-
-g:Tex_PromptedCommands *ls_11_3_12* *ls_a_dk*
- *Tex_PromptedCommands*
-
-
-Type String
-Default Value 'footnote,cite,pageref,label'
-
-This string represents a comma separated list of LaTeX commands which
-Latex-Suite uses for the <F7> and <S-F7> maps as described here [|ls_a_bo|].
-
-Leaving this string empty will leave the <F7> key unmapped.
-
-
-Tex_ItemStyle_environment *ls_11_3_13* *ls_a_dl*
- *Tex_ItemStyle_environment*
-
-This setting affects the style which Latex-Suite uses to insert an \item when
-<Alt-I> is pressed as described here [|ls_a_bE|]. By default Latex-Suite defines
-styles for the following environments:
-
-Environment Style~
-itemize \item
-enumerate \item
-theindex \item
-thebibliography \item[<+biblabel+>]{<+bibkey+>} <++>
-description \item[<+label+>] <++>
-
-Each style is defined by a variable of the form g:Tex_ItemStyle_{envname} where
-envname is the name of the environment for which the style is defined. For
-example, by default >
- g:Tex_ItemStyle_description = '\item[<+label+>] <++>'
-Redefining the style for a particular environment or defining a style for an
-entirely new environment is simply a matter of setting the value of a variable
-of the corresponding name.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Smart Key Customization *ls_11_4* *ls_a_dm*
- *customizing-smart-keys*
-
-These settings affect the smart key functionality as described here [|ls_a_bz|].
-
-
-
-g:Tex_SmartKeyBS *ls_11_4_1* *ls_a_dn*
- *Tex_SmartKeyBS*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-Whether or not <Backspace> deletes diacritics.
-
-
-g:Tex_SmartKeyQuote *ls_11_4_2* *ls_a_do*
- *Tex_SmartKeyQuote*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-Whether or not the smart quotes [|ls_a_bz|] functionality is available.
-
-If enabled, the quote characters can be customized by setting the following
-variables:
-
-Setting Value~
-g:Tex_SmartQuoteOpen "``"
-g:Tex_SmartQuoteClose "''"
-
-Non-English users will want to change these settings to their locale. These
-global variables will be ignored if there are buffer-local variables (with the
-same name), which may be set in the language specific package files, such as
-$VIM/ftplugin/latex-suite/packages/german.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Latex Completion Customization *ls_11_5* *ls_a_dp*
- *customizing-latex-completion*
-
-The following settings affect the completion [|ls_a_bR|] functionality in
-Latex-Suite.
-
-
-
-Window size settings *ls_11_5_1* *ls_a_dq*
- *completion-window-preferences*
-
-These three settings affect the aesthetics of the completion functionality.
-
- *Tex_ViewerCwindowHeight* *ls_a_ey*
- *Tex_ViewerPreviewHeight* *ls_a_ez*
- *Tex_ExplorerHeight* *ls_a_eA*
- *Tex_ImageDir* *ls_a_eB*
-Setting Explanation Default Value~
-g:Tex_ViewerCwindowHeight The height of the cwindow which 5
- displays the list of \labels
- etc.
-g:Tex_ViewerPreviewHeight The height of the preview window 10
- which shows the context of a
- \label etc.
-g:Tex_ExplorerHeight The height of the explorer 10
- window which lists the files
- from which to choose an image
- file.
-g:Tex_ImageDir The directory to scan for images ''
-
-
-g:Tex_BIBINPUTS *ls_11_5_2* *ls_a_dr*
- *Tex_BIBINPUTS*
-
-
-Type string
-Default Value ''
-
-This string describes the directories which are scanned while trying to search
-for .bib and .bbl files. See the cite completion section [|ls_a_bU|] for more
-details.
-
-This string should be set in the syntax accepted by Vim's native 'path' setting.
-Do not include the present directory '.'. While searching for bibliography
-files, the present directory will be prepended to this variable.
-
-
-Tex_UseSimpleLabelSearch *ls_11_5_3* *ls_a_ds*
- *Tex_UseSimpleLabelSearch*
-
-When set to 1, Latex-Suite searches for \labels in all .tex files in the
-directory containing the file being edited when <F9> is pressed. See \ref
-completion [|ls_a_bT|] for details.
-
-
-g:Tex_ProjectSourceFiles *ls_11_5_4* *ls_a_dt*
- *Tex_ProjectSourceFiles*
-
-
-Type String
-Default Value ''
-
-This setting is meant to be initialized on a per-project basis using the
-Latex-Suite master file [|ls_a_ct|] as described in Latex-Suite Project
-[|ls_a_cr|] section. It is a list of source files which are used in the project.
-If defined, then instead of using the logic described in
-Tex_UseSimpleLabelSearch [|ls_a_ds|] to search for files in which to search for
-\labels, we simply search for \labels in this list. This significantly reduces
-the time it takes to generate the list of possible completions for large
-projects.
-
-The list is specified as a whitespace separated list of filenames relative to
-the location of the main file.
-
-
-g:Tex_RememberCiteSearch *ls_11_5_5* *ls_a_du*
- *Tex_RememberCiteSearch*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 0
-
-When this variable is non-zero, then Latex-Suite will try to remember results
-from the \cite completion as described in this section [|ls_a_bV|].
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Compiler Customization *ls_11_6* *ls_a_dv*
- *customizing-compiling*
-
-The following settings affect Latex-Suite's compilation functionality
-
-
-
-g:Tex_DefaultTargetFormat *ls_11_6_1* *ls_a_dw*
- *Tex_DefaultTargetFormat*
-
-
-Type String
-Default Value dvi for windows/*nix and pdf for mac
-
-Use this setting to choose the default target format. For example, setting this
-to pdf makes Latex-Suite compile a pdf file when you press \ll and fire up the
-pdf viewer on pressing \lv. Make sure that a rules for compiling and viewing
-have been defined for this target format as described here [|ls_a_dx|] and here
-[|ls_a_dF|].
-
-
-g:Tex_CompileRule_<format> *ls_11_6_2* *ls_a_dx*
- *Tex_CompileRule_format*
-
-Here <format> refers to the target format for which this rule is defined.
-Latex-Suite supports compiling into dvi, ps and pdf by default. All these rules
-are strings defined by default as follows:
-
-
-g:Tex_CompileRule_dvi 'latex -interaction=nonstopmode $*'
-g:Tex_CompileRule_ps 'ps2pdf $*'
-g:Tex_CompileRule_pdf 'pdflatex -interaction=nonstopmode $*'
-
-If you desire forward and inverse searching via Latex-Suite, you will need to
-change g:Tex_CompileRule_dvi to include -src-specials. However, this has been
-known to cause problems with the output file. Therefore, use this with care.
-
-
-g:Tex_FormatDependency_<format> *ls_11_6_3* *ls_a_dy*
-
-Type string
-Default Value ''
-
-By default, there are no format dependencies defined. Each definition is of the
-form above where <format> is a string such as 'dvi' etc.
-
-The value of each string is a comma separated string such as 'dvi,ps'. See the
-Compiler dependency [|ls_a_ca|] section to see how to use/specify this setting
-
-
-g:Tex_MultipleCompileFormats *ls_11_6_4* *ls_a_dz*
- *Tex_MultipleCompileFormats*
-
-Type string
-Default Value 'dvi'
-
-This is a comma separated string of formats for which the compiler needs to be
-called multiple times in order to get cross-references, citations etc right. See
-the Compiling multiple times [|ls_a_cb|] section for details.
-
-
-g:Tex_IgnoredWarnings *ls_11_6_5* *ls_a_dA*
- *Tex_IgnoredWarnings*
-
-
-Type String
-Default Value a new-line separated list of patterns as described below
-
-The default value of this setting is >
- \"Underfull\n".
- \"Overfull\n".
- \"specifier changed to\n".
- \"You have requested\n".
- \"Missing number, treated as zero.\n".
- \"There were undefined references\n"
- \"Citation %.%# undefined"
-This setting defines a set of patterns which will be filtered out when
-displaying the output from the latex compiler. This is to aid in filtering out
-very common warnings/errors.
-
-NOTE: Remember to check the value of g:Tex_IgnoreLevel [|ls_a_dB|] when you
- change this setting. For example, if you append a new pattern which you
- would like to ignore by default, increase the value of g:Tex_IgnoreLevel.
-
-
-
-
-g:Tex_IgnoreLevel *ls_11_6_6* *ls_a_dB*
- *Tex_IgnoreLevel*
-
-
-Type Integer
-Default Value 7
-
-This setting defines a "filter level" or an "ignore level". A value of 7 for
-instance means that any warning/error matching with any of the first 7 fields of
-g:Tex_IgnoredWarnings [|ls_a_dA|] will be ignored. Setting this value to zero
-will mean that no error/warning is ignored. However, even with a value of zero,
-Latex-Suite will filter out most of the text which a LaTeX compiler typically
-produces. Use >
- TCLevel strict
-from within Vim in order to see all the lines from the compiler's output.
-
-
-Tex_UseMakefile *ls_11_6_7* *ls_a_dC*
- *Tex_UseMakefile*
-
-Type boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-When set to 1, then if a makefile or Makefile is present in the current
-directory, then Latex-Suite sets the makeprg option to just "make <target>",
-where <target> is the target format chosen using the TCTarget or TTarget
-commands.
-
-When set to 0, then Latex-Suite will set the makeprg setting to whatever is
-defined by the g:Tex_CompileRule_target [|ls_a_dx|] setting.
-
-
-g:Tex_GotoError *ls_11_6_8* *ls_a_dD*
- *Tex_GotoError*
-
-
-Type boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-If set to 1, then pressing \ll will take you to the location of the first
-warning/error, otherwise you will remain in the original location but the
-errors/warnings will be listed in the preview window.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Viewer Customization *ls_11_7* *ls_a_dE*
- *customizing-viewing*
-
-The following settings affect how Latex-Suite will display compiled files.
-
-
-
-g:Tex_ViewRule_<format> *ls_11_7_1* *ls_a_dF*
- *Tex_ViewRule_format*
-
-Here <format> refers to a format such as dvi, ps, etc. This variable defines the
-program which will be called to display a file of that format.
-
-By default, Latex-Suite defines viewer programs for viewing DVI, PS and PDF
-formats as follows:
-
- Windows Unix~
-g:Tex_ViewRule_dvi 'yap -1' 'xdvi'
-g:Tex_ViewRule_ps 'gsview32' 'ghostview'
-g:Tex_ViewRule_pdf 'AcroRd32' 'xpdf'
-
-For Macintosh systems, these strings are left empty by default. This lets the
-system pick the program for each format. If you define these variables for Mac,
-the system choice will be over-ridden.
-
-Latex-Suite appends file.format to the above settings while calling the external
-programs. For example, with >
- let g:Tex_ViewRule_dvi = 'yap -1'
-yap is called as >
- !start yap -1 file.dvi
-from within Vim. (The initial start is used on Windows platforms is to make yap
-start as a separate process.) If you find the way Latex-Suite constructs the
-command line too restrictive, you can use the Tex_ViewRuleComplete_format
-[|ls_a_dG|] setting for more complete control on how the command line is
-constructed while calling the external program for viewing.
-
-NOTE: For windows, you will need to set the $PATH variable to include the paths
- to yap, AcroRd32, gsview32 and any other programs. See your system
- documentation for how to do this.
-
-
-NOTE: Default Viewing Format
- ----------------------
- To change the default format for viewing files, set the
- g:Tex_DefaultTargetFormat [|ls_a_dw|] variable.
-
-
-
-
-Tex_ViewRuleComplete_<format> *ls_11_7_2* *ls_a_dG*
- *Tex_ViewRuleComplete_format*
-
-Here <format> refers to the extension of a output format such as dvi, html etc.
-
-Tex_ViewRuleComplete_format takes precedence over Tex_ViewRule_format if both
-are specified. By default, Latex-Suite does not define values for
-Tex_ViewRuleComplete_format for any format. Unlike in the case of
-Tex_ViewRule_format, Latex-Suite does not modify Tex_ViewRuleComplete_format at
-all in constructing the command line. The only modification is to substitute
-'$*' everywhere in the string with the name of the file being viewed (without
-the extension).
-
-NOTE: IMPORTANT
- ---------
- Make sure you make the process go into the background otherwise vim will
- wait for the viewer to terminate before letting you edit the file again.
-
- To make a process go into the background on a *nix platform, use a
- trailing & in the setting. On Windows, use start at the beginning of the
- setting. Example: Suppose you have a latex->html converter which converts
- a file say foo.tex to a file foo/index.html. Then you would use: >
- " On *nix platform
- let g:Tex_ViewRuleComplete_html = 'MozillaFirebird $*/index.html &'
- " On windows platform
- let g:Tex_ViewRuleComplete_html = 'start MozillaFirebird $*/index.html'
-<
-
-
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Menu Customization *ls_11_8* *ls_a_dH*
- *customizing-menus*
-
-In addition to using the variables defined in this section to affect the
-menu-layout permanently (i.e, the layout Latex-Suite will start with), you can
-also use the TeX-Suite > Configure Menu menu to dynamically configure the menu
-layout after Latex-Suite has started.
-
-
-
-g:Tex_Menus *ls_11_8_1* *ls_a_dI*
- *Tex_Menus*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-If set to 0, Latex-Suite will suppress showing all menus. Useful if you mostly
-work in terminals.
-
-
-g:Tex_MainMenuLocation *ls_11_8_2* *ls_a_dJ*
- *Tex_MainMenuLocation*
-
-
-Type number
-Default Value 80
-
-This setting decides the location of the first top-level Latex-Suite menu. You
-can for example shift all the menus created by Latex-Suite to the very end by
-setting this value to a large number like 990.
-
-
-g:Tex_MathMenus *ls_11_8_3* *ls_a_dK*
- *Tex_MathMenus*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-The Tex-Math menu consists of hundreds of mathematical symbols used in LaTeX.
-This menu comprises about 75% of the menus.
-
-
-g:Tex_NestElementMenus *ls_11_8_4* *ls_a_dL*
- *Tex_NestElementMenus*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-This setting controls the "compactness" of the menus. If set to 1, then the
-Font, Counter and Dimensioning menus are collected together in a single menu
-called Tex-Elements, otherwise, they will each get a separate menu.
-
-
-g:Tex_PackagesMenu *ls_11_8_5* *ls_a_dM*
- *Tex_PackagesMenu*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-Setting this to zero will stop Latex-Suite from automatically creating the
-TeX-Suite > Packages > Supported menu at startup. You can still create the menu
-after startup by going to TeX-Suite > Configure Menu.
-
-
-g:Tex_NestPackagesMenu *ls_11_8_6* *ls_a_dN*
- *Tex_NestPackagesMenu*
-
-
-Type String
-Default Value 'TeX-'
-
-This string is the prefix added to all the menus created by Latex-Suite. If you
-define this variable with a dot ('.') as the last character, then all the menus
-created by Latex-Suite will be nested under a single master menu. For example,
-set this to '&LaTeX-Suite.' to nest all menus under a menu called &LaTeX-Suite.
-
-
-g:Tex_UseUtfMenus *ls_11_8_7* *ls_a_dO*
- *Tex_UseUtfMenus*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 0
-
-This setting controls whether Latex-Suite uses utf-8 symbols to display some of
-the mathematical symbols in the TeX-Math menu. It is necessary for your
-system/GUI to support utf-8. Setting this to 1 has the side-effect of setting
-the 'encoding' option of Vim to 'utf-8'.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Folding Customization *ls_11_9* *ls_a_dP*
- *customizing-folding*
-
-The following settings control the folding [|ls_a_ci|] functionality of
-Latex-Suite.
-
-
-
-g:Tex_Folding *ls_11_9_1* *ls_a_dQ*
- *Tex_Folding*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-Setting this to zero completely disables Latex-Suite's folding functionality.
-However, the TexFoldTextFunction() is still available in case you want to use
-another folding scheme but still want to continue using the fold text function.
-
-
-g:Tex_AutoFolding *ls_11_9_2* *ls_a_dR*
- *Tex_AutoFolding*
-
-
-Type Boolean
-Default Value 1
-
-This setting controls whether Latex-Suite automatically creates manual folds for
-a file when it is opened. You can still use the \rf mapping to refresh/create
-folds even when this variable is set to zero.
-
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-Package Handling Customization *ls_11_10* *ls_a_dS*
- *customizing-packages*
-
-These settings affect the custom packages [|ls_a_bN|] functionality in
-Latex-Suite
-
-
-
-g:Tex_TEXINPUTS *ls_11_10_1* *ls_a_dT*
- *Tex_TEXINPUTS*
-
-
-Type string
-Default Value ''
-
-This setting describes the directories scanned by Latex-Suite while searching
-for custom user packages as described in the custom packages [|ls_a_bN|]
-section. Do not include the present directory in this setting. The present
-directory is always scanned for custom packages.
-
-This string should be set in the syntax accepted by Vim's native 'path' setting.
-
-================================================================================
-Credits *ls_12* *ls_a_dU*
- *latex-suite-credits*
-
-
-
-And finally, the credits:
-
-
-Artur R. Czechowski maintains the BSD package of Latex-Suite. Lots of valuable
- feedback.
-Lubomir Host provided the diacritics and also helped in development.
-Alexander Wagner valuable suggestions during development.
-Luc Hermitte his variation of Stephen Riehm's bracketing system is used
- in Latex-Suite.
-Gergely Kontra the clever little JumpFunc() in imaps.vim is due to him.
- The implementation of the templates also borrows from
- mu-template.vim by him.
-Dimitri Antoniou author of ltags and also provided the nice tip about
- forward / reverse search on DVI documents.
-Stephen Riehm the extremely helpful bracketing system is from him.
-Alan Schmitt provided macros/folding elements. Continued feedback,
- bug-reports/fixes.
-Hari Krishna Dara for ExecMap(), the clever little function which makes
- typing visual mode mappings so much easier and error-free.
-Alan G Isac for the comprehensive BibT() function for entering bibtex
- entries.
-Gontran Baerts for libList.vim
-Peter Heslin useful discussion and also a lot of bug fixes. the
- %%fakesection in folding.vim.
-Zhang Lin-bo lots of very useful additions to folding. The code for
- customizing the folding scheme is due to him.
-
-A large number of functions in Latex-Suite come from various other people. Some
-of those people might have been missed here. Each function should however have
-the author's name/e-mail above it. Thats the more authoritative place to check
-out who has done what.
-
- *latex-suite-maintainer* *ls_a_eC*
-The current maintainer(s) of Latex-Suite is(are)
-
-
-Srinath Avadhanula <srinath@fastmail.fm>
-
-Mikolaj Machowski <mikmach@wp.pl>
-
-Benji Fisher <benji@member.AMS.org>
-
-================================================================================
-URLs used in this file
-
-*ls_u_1* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net
-*ls_u_2* : http://vim-latex.sourceforge.net/index.php?subject=download
-*ls_u_3* : http://www.cygwin.com
-*ls_u_4* : http://www.google.com/search?q=windows%20gnu%20grep
-
-================================================================================
-About this file
-
-This file was created automatically from its XML variant using db2vim. db2vim is
-a python script which understands a very limited subset of the Docbook XML 4.2
-DTD and outputs a plain text file in vim help format.
-
-db2vim can be obtained via anonymous CVS from sourceforge.net. Use
-
-cvs -d:pserver:anonymous@cvs.vim-latex.sf.net:/cvsroot/vim-latex co db2vim
-
-Or you can visit the web-interface to sourceforge CVS at:
-http://cvs.sourceforge.net/cgi-bin/viewcvs.cgi/vim-latex/db2vim/
-
-The following modelines should nicely fold up this help manual.
-
-vim:ft=help:fdm=expr:nowrap
-vim:foldexpr=getline(v\:lnum-1)=~'-\\{80}'?'>2'\:getline(v\:lnum-1)=~'=\\{80}'?'>1'\:getline(v\:lnum)=~'=\\{80}'?'0'\:getline(v\:lnum)=~'-\\{80}'?'1'\:'='
-vim:foldtext=substitute(v\:folddashes.substitute(getline(v\:foldstart),'\\s*\\*.*',"",""),'^--','\ \ \ \ \ \ ','')
-================================================================================
diff --git a/dot_vim/doc/latexhelp.txt b/dot_vim/doc/latexhelp.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 2782424..0000000
--- a/dot_vim/doc/latexhelp.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2430 +0,0 @@
-*latexhelp.txt* For Vim version 6.0. Last change: 2001 Dec 20
-
-
- LATEX HELP 1.6
- translated (with minor changes) for vim
- by Mikolaj Machowski
-
-This file documents LaTeX2e, a document preparation system. LaTeX2e is a
-macro package for TeX.
-
- This is edition 1.6 of the LaTeX2e documentation, and is for the Texinfo
-that is distributed as part of Version 19 of GNU Emacs. It uses version
-2.134 or later of the texinfo.tex input file.
-
- This is translated from LATEX.HLP v1.0a in the VMS Help Library. The
-pre-translation version was written by George D. Greenwade of Sam Houston
-State University.
-
- The LaTeX 2.09 version was written by Stephen Gilmore <stg@dcs.ed.ac.uk>.
-
- The LaTeX2e version was adapted from this by Torsten Martinsen
-<bullestock@dk-online.dk>.
-
- Version for vim of this manual was written by Mikolaj Machowski
-<mikmach@wp.pl>
-
- Copyright 1988,1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Copyright 1994-1996
-Torsten Martinsen. Copyright for `translation' for vim Mikolaj Machowski 2001.
-
- Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual
-provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved on
-all copies.
-
- Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
-manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire
-resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission
-notice identical to this one.
-
- Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
-into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions,
-except that the sections entitled "Distribution" and "General Public
-License" may be included in a translation approved by the author instead of
-in the original English.
-
-==============================================================================
-*LaTeX* *latex*
-
-The LaTeX command typesets a file of text using the TeX program and the LaTeX
-Macro package for TeX. To be more specific, it processes an input file
-containing the text of a document with interspersed commands that describe how
-the text should be formatted.
-
-1. Commands |latex-commands|
-2. Counters |latex-counters|
-3. Cross References |latex-references|
-4. Definitions |latex-definitions|
-5. Document Classes |latex-classes|
-6. Layout |latex-layout|
-7. Environments |latex-environments|
-8. Footnotes |latex-footnotes|
-9. Lengths |latex-lengths|
-10. Letters |latex-letters|
-11. Line & Page Breaking |latex-breaking|
-12. Making Paragraphs |latex-paragraphs|
-13. Margin Notes |latex-margin-notes|
-14. Math Formulae |latex-math|
-15. Modes |latex-modes|
-16. Page Styles |latex-page-styles|
-17. Sectioning |latex-sectioning|
-18. Spaces & Boxes |latex-spaces-boxes|
-19. Special Characters |latex-special-char|
-20. Splitting the Input |latex-inputting|
-21. Starting & Ending |latex-start-end|
-22. Table of Contents |latex-toc|
-23. Terminal Input/Output |latex-terminal|
-24. Typefaces |latex-typefaces|
-25. Parameters |latex-parameters|
-
-==============================================================================
-1. Commands *latex-commands*
-
-A LaTeX command begins with the command name, which consists of a \ followed
-by either
- (a) a string of letters or
- (b) a single non-letter.
-
-Arguments contained in square brackets, [], are optional while arguments
-contained in braces, {}, are required.
-
-NOTE: LaTeX is case sensitive. Enter all commands in lower case unless
-explicitly directed to do otherwise.
-
-==============================================================================
-2. Counters *latex-counters*
-
-|\addtocounter| Add a quantity to a counter
-|\alph| Print value of a counter using letters
-|\arabic| Print value of a counter using numerals
-|\fnsymbol| Print value of a counter using symbols
-|\newcounter| Define a new counter
-|\refstepcounter| Add to counter, resetting subsidiary counters
-|\roman| Print value of a counter using roman numerals
-|\setcounter| Set the value of a counter
-|\stepcounter| Add to counter, resetting subsidiary counters
-|\usecounter| Use a specified counter in a list environment
-|\value| Use the value of a counter in an expression
-
-Everything LaTeX numbers for you has a counter associated with it. The name of
-the counter is the same as the name of the environment or command that
-produces the number, except with no |\\|. (|lc-enumi| - |lc-enumiv| are used
-for the nested |\enumerate| environment.) Below is a list of the counters
-used in LaTeX's standard document classes to control numbering.
-
- |part| |paragraph| |figure| |enumi| |itemi|
- |chapter| |subparagraph| |table| |enumii| |itemii|
- |section| |page| |footnote| |enumiii| |itemiii|
- |subsection| |equation| |mpfootnote| |enumiv| |itemiv|
- |subsubsection|
-
-
-\addtocounter{counter}{value} *\addtocounter*
- Increments the {counter} by the amount specified by the
- {value} argument. The {value} argument can be negative.
-
-\alph{counter} *\alph* *\Alph*
-\Alph{counter}
- This command causes the value of the counter to be printed in
- alphabetic characters. |\alph| command uses lower case
- alphabetic alphabetic characters, i.e., a, b, c... while the
- |\Alph| command uses upper case alphabetic characters, i.e.,
- A, B, C....
-
-\arabic{counter} *\arabic*
- Causes the value of the {counter} to be printed in Arabic
- numbers, i.e., 3.
-
-\fnsymbol{counter} *\fnsymbol*
- Causes the value of the {counter} to be printed in a specific
- sequence of nine symbols that can be used for numbering
- footnotes.
- Note: counter must have a value between 1 and 9 inclusive.
-
-\newcounter{foo}[counter] *\newcounter*
- Defines a new counter named {foo}. The counter is initialized
- to zero. The optional argument [counter] causes the counter
- {foo} to be reset whenever the counter named in the optional
- argument is incremented.
-
-\refstepcounter{counter} *\refstepcounter*
- Command works like |\stepcounter|, except it also defines the
- current |\ref| value to be the result of \thecounter.
-
-\roman{counter} *\roman* *\Roman*
-\Roman{counter}
- Causes the value of the {counter} to be printed in Roman
- numerals. The |\roman| command uses lower case Roman numerals,
- i.e., i, ii, iii..., while the |\Roman| command uses upper case
- Roman numerals, i.e., I, II, III....
-
-\stepcounter{counter} *\stepcounter*
- Adds one to the {counter} and resets all subsidiary counters.
-
-\setcounter{counter}{value} *\setcounter*
- Sets the value of the {counter} to that specified by the
- {value} argument.
-
-\usecounter{counter} *\usecounter*
- Command is used in the second argument of the |list|
- environment to allow the {counter} specified to be used to
- number the list items.
-
-\value{counter} *\value*
- Produces the value of the {counter} named in the mandatory
- argument. It can be used where LaTeX expects an integer or
- number, such as the second argument of a |\setcounter| or
- |\addtocounter| command, or in: >
- \hspace{\value{foo}\parindent}
-< It is useful for doing arithmetic with counters.
-
-==============================================================================
-3. Cross References *latex-references*
-
-One reason for numbering things like figures and equations is to refer the
-reader to them, as in "See Figure 3 for more details."
-
-|\label| Assign a symbolic name to a piece of text
-|\pageref| Refer to a page number
-|\ref| Refer to a section, figure or similar
-
-
-\label{key} *\label*
- Command appearing in ordinary text assigns to the {key} the
- number of the current sectional unit; one appearing inside a
- numbered environment assigns that number to the {key}.
-
- A {key} can consist of any sequence of letters, digits, or
- punctuation characters. Upper and lowercase letters are
- different.
-
- To avoid accidentally creating two labels with the same name,
- it is common to use labels consisting of a prefix and a suffix
- separated by a colon. The prefixes conventionally used are
- * 'cha' for chapters
- * 'sec' for lower-level sectioning commands
- * 'fig' for figures
- * 'tab' for tables
- * 'eq' for equations
- Thus, a label for a figure would look like: >
- \label{fig:bandersnatch}
-
-\pageref{key} *\pageref*
- Command produces the page number of the place in the text
- where the corresponding |\label| command appears. ie. where
- \label{key} appears.
-
-\ref{key} *\ref*
- Command produces the number of the sectional unit, equation
- number, ... of the corresponding |\label| command.
-
-==============================================================================
-4. Definitions *latex-definitions*
-
-|\newcommand| Define a new command
-|\newenvironment| Define a new environment
-|\newtheorem| Define a new theorem-like environment
-|\newfont| Define a new font name
-
-
-\newcommand{cmd}[args]{definition} *\newcommand* *\renewcommand*
-\newcommand{cmd}[args][default]{definition}
-\renewcommand{cmd}[args]{definition}
-\renewcommand{cmd}[args][default]{definition}
-
-These commands define (or redefine) a command.
-
-{cmd} A command name beginning with a |\\|. For |\newcommand| it must
- not be already defined and must not begin with |\end|; for
- |\renewcommand| it must already be defined.
-
-{args} An integer from 1 to 9 denoting the number of arguments of the
- command being defined. The default is for the command to have
- no arguments.
-
-{default} If this optional parameter is present, it means that the
- command's first argument is optional. The default value of the
- optional argument is default.
-
-{definition} The text to be substituted for every occurrence of {cmd}; a
- parameter of the form #n in {cmd} is replaced by the text of
- the nth argument when this substitution takes place.
-
- *\newenvironment* *\renewenvironment*
-\newenvironment{nam}[args]{begdef}{enddef}
-\newenvironment{nam}[args][default]{begdef}{enddef}
-\renewenvironment{nam}[args]{begdef}{enddef}
-
-These commands define or redefine an environment.
-
-{nam} The name of the environment. For |\newenvironment| there must
- be no currently defined environment by that name, and the
- command \nam must be undefined. For |\renewenvironment| the
- environment must already be defined.
-
-{args} An integer from 1 to 9 denoting the number of arguments of
- the newly-defined environment. The default is no arguments.
-
-{default} If this is specified, the first argument is optional, and
- default gives the default value for that argument.
-
-{begdef} The text substituted for every occurrence of \begin{nam}; a
- parameter of the form #n in {cmd} is replaced by the text of
- the nth argument when this substitution takes place.
-
-{enddef} The text substituted for every occurrence of \end{nam}. It
- may not contain any argument parameters.
-
-
-\newtheorem{envname}{caption}[within] *\newtheorem*
-\newtheorem{envname}[numberedlike]{caption}
-
-This command defines a theorem-like environment.
-
-{envname} The name of the environment to be defined. A string of
- letters. It must not be the name of an existing environment or
- counter.
-
-{caption} The text printed at the beginning of the environment, right
- before the number. This may simply say "Theorem", for example.
-
-{within} The name of an already defined counter, usually of a sectional
- unit. Provides a means of resetting the new theorem counter
- within the sectional unit.
-
-{numberedlike} The name of an already defined theorem-like environment.
-
-The |\newtheorem| command may have at most one optional argument.
-
-
-\newfont{cmd}{fontname} *\newfont*
- Defines the command name {cmd}, which must not be currently
- defined, to be a declaration that selects the font named
- {fontname} to be the current font.
-
-==============================================================================
-5. Document Classes *latex-classes*
-
-
-\documentclass[options]{class} *\documentclass*
-
-Valid LaTeX document classes include:
- *article *article-class*
- *report *report-class*
- *letter *letter-class*
- *book *book-class*
- *slides *slides-class*
-
-All the standard classes (except slides) accept the following options for
-selecting the typeface size (10 pt is default):
-
-10pt, 11pt, 12pt
-
-All classes accept these options for selecting the paper size (default is
-letter):
-
-a4paper, a5paper, b5paper, letterpaper, legalpaper, executivepaper
-
-Miscellaneous options:
-
-landscape *landscape*
- Selects landscape format. Default is portrait.
-
-titlepage, notitlepage *notitlepage*
- Selects if there should be a separate title page.
-
-leqno *leqno* *rqno*
- Equation number on left side of equations. Default is
- right side.
-
-fleqn *fleqn*
- Displayed formulas flush left. Default is centred.
-
-openbib *openbib*
- Use "open" bibliography format.
-
-draft, final *draft* *final*
- Mark/do not mark overfull boxes with a rule. Default is
- final.
-
-These options are not available with the slides class:
-
-oneside, twoside *oneside* *twoside*
- Selects one- or twosided layout. Default is oneside,
- except for the book class.
-
-openright, openany *openright* *openany*
- Determines if a chapter should start on a right-hand page.
- Default is openright for book.
-
-onecolumn, twocolumn *onecolumn* *twocolumn*
- One or two columns. Defaults to one column.
-
-The slides class offers the option clock for printing the time at the bottom
-of each |\note|.
-
-If you specify more than one option, they must be separated by a comma.
-
-\usepackage[options]{pkg} *\usepackage*
- Additional packages are loaded by this. If you
- specify more than one package, they must be separated by a
- comma.
-
-Any options given in the |\documentclass| command that are unknown by the
-selected document class are passed on to the packages loaded with |\usepackage|.
-
-==============================================================================
-6. Layout *latex-layout*
-
-Miscellaneous commands for controlling the general layout of the page.
-
-|\flushbottom| Make all text pages the same height.
-|\onecolumn| Use one-column layout.
-|\raggedbottom| Allow text pages of differing height.
-|\twocolumn| Use two-column layout.
-
-\flushbottom *\flushbottom*
- Makes all text pages the same height, adding extra vertical
- space when necessary to fill out the page. This is the
- standard if twocolumn mode is selected.
-
-\onecolumn *\onecolumn*
- Starts a new page and produces single-column output.
-
-\raggedbottom *\raggedbottom*
- Makes all pages the height of the text on that page. No extra
- vertical space is added.
-
-\twocolumn[text] *\twocolumn*
- Starts a new page and produces two-column output. If the
- optional [text] argument is present, it is typeset in
- one-column mode.
-
-==============================================================================
-7. Environments *latex-environments*
-
- *\begin* *\end*
-LaTeX provides a number of different paragraph-making environments. Each
-environment begins and ends in the same manner: >
-
- \begin{environment-name}
- .
- .
- .
- \end{environment-name}
-<
-a. |array| Math arrays
-b. |center| Centred lines
-c. |description| Labelled lists
-d. |enumerate| Numbered lists
-e. |eqnarray| Sequences of aligned equations
-f. |equation| Displayed equation
-g. |figure| Floating figures
-h. |flushleft| Flushed left lines
-i. |flushright| Flushed right lines
-j. |itemize| Bulleted lists
-k. |letter| Letters
-l. |list| Generic list environment
-m. |minipage| Miniature page
-n. |picture| Picture with text, arrows, lines and circles
-o. |quotation| Indented environment with paragraph indentation
-p. |quote-l| Indented environment with no paragraph indentation
-q. |tabbing| Align text arbitrarily
-r. |table| Floating tables
-s. |tabular| Align text in columns
-t. |thebibliography| Bibliography or reference list
-u. |theorem| Theorems, lemmas, etc
-v. |titlepage| For hand crafted title pages
-x. |verbatim| Simulating typed input
-y. |verse| For poetry and other things
-
-==============================================================================
- a. array *array*
->
- \begin{array}{col1col2...coln}
- column 1 entry & column 2 entry ... & column n entry \\
- .
- .
- .
- \end{array}
-
-Math arrays are produced with the |array| environment. It has a single mandatory
-argument describing the number of columns and the alignment within them. Each
-column, coln, is specified by a single letter that tells how items in that row
-should be formatted.
- * c -- for centred
- * l -- for flush left
- * r -- for flush right
-Column entries must be separated by an |&|. Column entries may include other
-LaTeX commands. Each row of the array must be terminated with the string |\\|.
-
-Note that the |array| environment can only be used in |math-mode|, so normally
-it is used inside an |equation| environment.
-
-==============================================================================
-b. center *center*
->
- \begin{center}
- Text on line 1 \\
- Text on line 2 \\
- .
- .
- .
- \end{center}
-
-The |\center| environment allows you to create a paragraph consisting of lines
-that are centred within the left and right margins on the current page. Each
-line must be terminated with the string |\\|.
-
-\centering *\centering*
- This declaration corresponds to the |center| environment. This
- declaration can be used inside an environment such as
- |quote-l| or in a |\parbox|. The text of a |figure| or |table|
- can be centred on the page by putting a |\centering| command
- at the beginning of the |figure| or |table| environment.
- Unlike the |center| environment, the |\centering| command does
- not start a new paragraph; it simply changes how LaTeX formats
- paragraph units. To affect a paragraph unit's format, the
- scope of the declaration must contain the blank line or |\end|
- command (of an environment like |quote-l|) that ends the
- paragraph unit.
-
-==============================================================================
-c. description *description*
->
- \begin{description}
- \item [label] First item
- \item [label] Second item
- .
- .
- .
- \end{description}
-
-The |description| environment is used to make labelled lists. The label is
-bold face and flushed right.
-
-==============================================================================
-d. enumerate *enumerate*
->
- \begin{enumerate}
- \item First item
- \item Second item
- .
- .
- .
- \end{enumerate}
-
-The |enumerate| environment produces a numbered list. Enumerations can be
-nested within one another, up to four levels deep. They can also be nested
-within other paragraph-making environments.
-
-\item Each item of an enumerated list begins with an |\item|
- command. There must be at least one |\item| command
- within the environment.
-
-The |enumerate| environment uses the |\enumi| through |\enumiv| counters (see
-section |latex-counters|). The type of numbering can be changed by redefining
-\theenumi etc.
-
-==============================================================================
-e. eqnarray *eqnarray*
->
- \begin{eqnarray}
- math formula 1 \\
- math formula 2 \\
- .
- .
- .
- \end{eqnarray}
-
-The |eqnarray| environment is used to display a sequence of equations or
-inequalities. It is very much like a three-column |array| environment, with
-consecutive rows separated by |\\| and consecutive items within a row separated
-by an |&|.
-
-\nonumber *\nonumber*
- An equation number is placed on every line unless that
- line has a |\nonumber| command.
-
-\lefteqn *\lefteqn*
- The command |\lefteqn| is used for splitting long
- formulas across lines. It typesets its argument in
- display style flush left in a box of zero width.
-
-==============================================================================
-f. equation *equation*
->
- \begin{equation}
- math formula
- \end{equation}
-
-The |equation| environment centres your equation on the page and places the
-equation number in the right margin.
-
-==============================================================================
-g. figure *figure*
->
- \begin{figure}[placement]
- body of the figure
- \caption{figure title}
- \end{figure}
-
-Figures are objects that are not part of the normal text, and are usually
-"floated" to a convenient place, like the top of a page. Figures will not be
-split between two pages.
-
-The optional argument [placement] determines where LaTeX will try to place
-your figure. There are four places where LaTeX can possibly put a float:
-
-h (Here) at the position in the text where the figure
- environment appears.
-t (Top) at the top of a text page.
-b (Bottom) at the bottom of a text page.
-p (Page of floats) on a separate float page, which is a page containing
- no text, only floats.
-
-The standard |report-class| and |article-class| use the default placement
-[tbp].
-
-The body of the |figure| is made up of whatever text, LaTeX commands, etc. you
-wish.
-
-The \caption command allows you to title your figure.
-
-==============================================================================
-h. flushleft *flushleft*
->
- \begin{flushleft}
- Text on line 1 \\
- Text on line 2 \\
- .
- .
- .
- \end{flushleft}
-
-The |flushleft| environment allows you to create a paragraph consisting of
-lines that are flushed left, to the left-hand margin. Each line must be
-terminated with the string |\\|.
-
-\raggedright *\raggedright*
- This declaration corresponds to the |flushleft| environment.
- This declaration can be used inside an environment such as
- |quote-l| or in a |\parbox|. Unlike the |flushleft|
- environment, the |\raggedright| command does not start a new
- paragraph; it simply changes how LaTeX formats paragraph
- units. To affect a paragraph unit's format, the scope of the
- declaration must contain the blank line or |\end| command (of
- an environment like |quote-l|) that ends the paragraph unit.
-
-==============================================================================
-i. flushright *flushright*
->
- \begin{flushright}
- Text on line 1 \\
- Text on line 2 \\
- .
- .
- .
- \end{flushright}
-
-The |flushright| environment allows you to create a paragraph consisting of
-lines that are flushed right, to the right-hand margin. Each line must be
-terminated with the string |\\|.
-
-\raggedleft *\raggedleft*
- This declaration corresponds to the |flushright| environment.
- This declaration can be used inside an environment such as
- |quote-l| or in a |\parbox|. Unlike the |flushright|
- environment, the |\raggedleft| command does not start a new
- paragraph; it simply changes how LaTeX formats paragraph
- units. To affect a paragraph unit's format, the scope of the
- declaration must contain the blank line or |\end| command (of
- an environment like |quote-l|) that ends the paragraph unit.
-
-==============================================================================
-j. itemize *itemize*
->
- \begin{itemize}
- \item First item
- \item Second item
- .
- .
- .
- \end{itemize}
-
-The |itemize| environment produces a "bulleted" list. Itemizations can be
-nested within one another, up to four levels deep. They can also be nested
-within other paragraph-making environments.
-
-\item *\item*
- Each item of an itemized list begins with an |\item| command.
- There must be at least one |\item| command within the
- environment.
-
-The itemize environment uses the |\itemi| through |\itemiv| counters (see
-section |latex-counters|). The type of numbering can be changed by redefining
-\theitemi etc.
-
-==============================================================================
-k. letter *\letter*
-
-This environment is used for creating letters. See section |latex-letters|.
-
-==============================================================================
-l. list *list*
-
-The |list| environment is a generic environment which is used for defining many
-of the more specific environments. It is seldom used in documents, but often
-in macros.
->
- \begin{list}{label}{spacing}
- \item First item
- \item Second item
- .
- .
- .
- \end{list}
-
-'label' The {label} argument specifies how items should be labelled.
- This argument is a piece of text that is inserted in a box to
- form the {label}. This argument can and usually does contain
- other LaTeX commands.
-
-'spacing' The {spacing} argument contains commands to change the spacing
- parameters for the |list|. This argument will most often be
- null, i.e., {}. This will select all default spacing which
- should suffice for most cases.
-
-==============================================================================
-m. minipage *minipage*
->
- \begin{minipage}[position]{width}
- text
- \end{minipage}
-
-The |minipage| environment is similar to a |\parbox| command. It takes the
-same optional [position] argument and mandatory {width} argument. You may use
-other paragraph-making environments inside a |minipage|. Footnotes in a
-minipage environment are handled in a way that is particularly useful for
-putting footnotes in figures or tables. A |\footnote| or |\footnotetext|
-command puts the footnote at the bottom of the minipage instead of at the
-bottom of the page, and it uses the |\mpfootnote| counter instead of the
-ordinary footnote counter. See sections |latex-counters| and
-|latex-footnotes|.
-
-NOTE: Don't put one |minipage| inside another if you are using footnotes; they
-may wind up at the bottom of the wrong minipage.
-
-==============================================================================
-n. picture *picture*
->
- size position
- \begin{picture}(width,height)(x offset,y offset)
- .
- .
- picture commands
- .
- .
- \end{picture}
-
-The |picture| environment allows you to create just about any kind of picture
-you want containing text, lines, arrows and circles. You tell LaTeX where to
-put things in the picture by specifying their coordinates. A coordinate is a
-number that may have a decimal point and a minus sign -- a number like 5, 2.3
-or -3.1416. A coordinate specifies a length in multiples of the unit length
-|\unitlength|, so if |\unitlength| has been set to 1cm, then the coordinate
-2.54 specifies a length of 2.54 centimetres. You can change the value of
-|\unitlength| anywhere you want, using the |\setlength| command, but strange
-things will happen if you try changing it inside the |picture| environment.
-
-A position is a pair of coordinates, such as (2.4,-5), specifying the point
-with x-coordinate 2.4 and y-coordinate -5. Coordinates are specified in the
-usual way with respect to an origin, which is normally at the lower-left
-corner of the |picture|.
-Note that when a position appears as an argument, it is not enclosed in
-braces; the parentheses serve to delimit the argument.
-
-The |picture| environment has one mandatory argument, which is a position. It
-specifies the size of the picture. The environment produces a rectangular box
-with width and height determined by this argument's x- and y-coordinates.
-
-The |picture| environment also has an optional position argument, following
-the size argument, that can change the origin. (Unlike ordinary optional
-arguments, this argument is not contained in square brackets.) The optional
-argument gives the coordinates of the point at the lower-left corner of the
-picture (thereby determining the origin). For example, if |\unitlength| has
-been set to 1mm, the command: >
- \begin{picture}(100,200)(10,20)
->
-produces a picture of width 100 millimetres and height 200 millimetres, whose
-lower-left corner is the point (10,20) and whose upper-right corner is
-therefore the point (110,220). When you first draw a picture, you will omit
-the optional argument, leaving the origin at the lower-left corner. If you
-then want to modify your picture by shifting everything, you just add the
-appropriate optional argument.
-
-The environment's mandatory argument determines the nominal size of the
-picture. This need bear no relation to how large the picture really is; LaTeX
-will happily allow you to put things outside the picture, or even off the
-page. The picture's nominal size is used by LaTeX in determining how much room
-to leave for it.
-
-Everything that appears in a picture is drawn by the |\put| command. The
-command: >
- \put (11.3,-.3){...}
-
-puts the object specified by ... in the picture, with its
-reference point at coordinates (11.3,-.3). The reference points for various
-objects will be described below.
-
-The |\put| creates an LR box (|lrbox|). You can put anything in the text
-argument of the |\put| that you'd put into the argument of an |\mbox| and
-related commands. When you do this, the reference point will be the lower left
-corner of the box.
-
-Picture commands:
-|\circle| Draw a circle
-|\dashbox| Draw a dashed box
-|\frame| Draw a frame around an object
-|\framebox(picture)| Draw a box with a frame around it
-|\line| Draw a straight line
-|\linethickness| Set the line thickness
-|\makebox(picture)| Draw a box of the specified size
-|\multiput| Draw multiple instances of an object
-|\oval| Draw an ellipse
-|\put| Place an object at a specified place
-|\shortstack| Make a pile of objects
-|\vector| Draw a line with an arrow
-
-\circle[*]{diameter} *\circle*
- Command produces a circle with a {diameter} as close to the
- specified one as possible. If the *-form of the command is
- used, LaTeX draws a solid circle.
- Note: only circles up to 40 pt can be drawn.
-
-
-\dashbox{dashlength}(width,height){...} *\dashbox*
- Draws a box with a dashed line. The |\dashbox| has an extra
- argument which specifies the width of each dash. A dashed box
- looks best when the width and height are multiples of the
- {dashlength}.
-
-\frame{...} *\frame*
- Puts a rectangular frame around the object specified in the
- argument. The reference point is the bottom left corner of the
- frame. No extra space is put between the frame and the object.
-
-\framebox(width,height)[position]{...} *\picture-framebox*
- The |\framebox| command is exactly the same as the
- |picture-makebox| command, except that it puts a frame around
- the outside of the box that it creates. The |\framebox|
- command produces a rule of thickness |\fboxrule|, and leaves a
- space |\fboxsep| between the rule and the contents of the box.
-
-\line(x slope,y slope){length} *\line*
- Draws a line of the specified length and slope.
- Note: LaTeX can only draw lines with slope = x/y, where x and
- y have integer values from -6 through 6.
-
-\linethickness{dimension} *\linethickness*
- Declares the thickness of horizontal and vertical lines in a
- |picture| environment to be dimension, which must be a
- positive length. It does not affect the thickness of slanted
- lines (|\line|) and circles (|circle|), or the quarter circles
- drawn by |\oval| to form the corners of an oval.
-
-\makebox(width,height)[position]{...} *picture-makebox*
- The makebox command for the |picture| environment is similar
- to the normal |\makebox| command except that you must specify
- a width and height in multiples of |\unitlength|.
- The optional argument, [position], specifies the quadrant that
- your text appears in. You may select up to two of the
- following:
- t - Moves the item to the top of the rectangle
- b - Moves the item to the bottom
- l - Moves the item to the left
- r - Moves the item to the right
-
- *\multiput*
-\multiput(x coord,y coord)(delta x,delta y){no of copies}{object}
- This command can be used when you are putting the same
- object in a regular pattern across a picture.
-
-\oval(width,height)[portion] *\oval*
- Produces a rectangle with rounded corners. The optional
- argument, [portion], allows you to select part of the oval.
- t - top portion
- b - bottom portion
- r - right portion
- l - left portion
- Note: the "corners" of the oval are made with quarter circles
- with a maximum radius of 20 pt, so large "ovals" will look
- more like boxes with rounded corners.
-
-\put(x coord,y coord){ ... } *\put*
- Places the item specified by the mandatory argument at the
- given coordinates.
-
-\shortstack[position]{... \\ ... \\ ...} *\shortstack*
- The |\shortstack| command produces a stack of objects.
- The valid positions are:
- r - right of the stack
- l - left of the stack
- c - centre of the stack (default)
-
-\vector(x slope,y slope){length} *\vector*
- Draws a line with an arrow of the specified length and slope.
- The x and y values must lie between -4 and +4, inclusive.
-
-==============================================================================
-o. quotation *quotation*
- >
- \begin{quotation}
- text
- \end{quotation}
-
-The margins of the |quotation| environment are indented on the left and the
-right. The text is justified at both margins and there is paragraph
-indentation. Leaving a blank line between text produces a new paragraph.
-
-==============================================================================
-p. quote *quote-l*
->
- \begin{quote}
- text
- \end{quote}
-
-The margins of the |quote-l| environment are indented on the left and the right.
-The text is justified at both margins. Leaving a blank line between text
-produces a new paragraph.
-
-==============================================================================
-q. tabbing *tabbing*
->
- \begin{tabbing}
- text \= more text \= still more text \= last text \\
- second row \> \> more \\
- .
- .
- .
- \end{tabbing}
-
-The |tabbing| environment provides a way to align text in columns. It works by
-setting tab stops and tabbing to them much the way you do with an ordinary
-typewriter.
-
-It is best suited for cases where the width of each column is constant and
-known in advance.
-
-This environment can be broken across pages, unlike the |tabular| environment.
-The following commands can be used inside a tabbing environment:
-
- *tab=*
-\= Sets a tab stop at the current position.
-
- *tab>*
-\> Advances to the next tab stop.
-
- *tab<*
-\< This command allows you to put something to the left of the
- local margin without changing the margin. Can only be used at
- the start of the line.
-
- *tab+*
-\+ Moves the left margin of the next and all the following
- commands one tab stop to the right.
-
- *tab-*
-\- Moves the left margin of the next and all the following
- commands one tab stop to the left.
-
- *tab'*
-\' Moves everything that you have typed so far in the current
- column, i.e. everything from the most recent \> (|tab>|), \<
- (|tab<|), \' (|tab'|), |\\|, or |\kill| command, to the right
- of the previous column, flush against the current column's tab
- stop.
-
- *tab`*
-\` Allows you to put text flush right against any tab stop,
- including tab stop 0. However, it can't move text to the right
- of the last column because there's no tab stop there. The \`
- (|tab`|) command moves all the text that follows it, up to the
- |\\| or \end{tabbing} command that ends the line, to the right
- margin of the tabbing environment. There must be no \>
- (|tab>|) or \' (|tab'|) command between the \` (|tab`|) and
- the command that ends the line.
-
- *\kill*
-\kill Sets tab stops without producing text. Works just like |\\|
- except that it throws away the current line instead of
- producing output for it. The effect of any \= (|tab=|), \+
- (|tab+|) or \- (|tab-|) commands in that line remain in
- effect.
-
- *\pushtabs*
-\pushtabs Saves all current tab stop positions. Useful for temporarily
- changing tab stop positions in the middle of a tabbing
- environment. Also restores the tab stop positions saved by the
- last |\pushtabs|.
-
- *taba*
-\a In a tabbing environment, the commands \= (|tab=|), \'
- (|tab'|) and \` (|tab`|) do not produce accents as normal.
- Instead, the commands \a=, \a' and \a` are used.
-
-This example typesets a Pascal function in a traditional format:
->
- \begin{tabbing}
- function \= fact(n : integer) : integer;\\
- \> begin \= \+ \\
- \> if \= n $>$ 1 then \+ \\
- fact := n * fact(n-1) \- \\
- else \+ \\
- fact := 1; \-\- \\
- end;\\
- \end{tabbing}
-
-==============================================================================
-r. table *\table*
->
- \begin{table}[placement]
- body of the table
- \caption{table title}
- \end{table}
-
-Tables are objects that are not part of the normal text, and are usually
-"floated" to a convenient place, like the top of a page. Tables will not be
-split between two pages.
-
-The optional argument [placement] determines where LaTeX will try to place
-your table. There are four places where LaTeX can possibly put a float:
-
- h (Here) at the position in the text where the table
- environment appears.
- t (Top) at the top of a text page.
- b (Bottom) at the bottom of a text page.
- p (Page of floats) on a separate float page, which is a page
- containing no text, only floats.
-
-The standard |report-class| and |article-class| use the default placement [tbp].
-
-The body of the table is made up of whatever text, LaTeX commands, etc., you
-wish.
-
-The \caption command allows you to title your table.
-
-==============================================================================
-s. tabular *tabular*
->
- \begin{tabular}[pos]{cols}
- column 1 entry & column 2 entry ... & column n entry \\
- .
- .
- .
- \end{tabular}
-
-or
->
- \begin{tabular*}{width}[pos]{cols}
- column 1 entry & column 2 entry ... & column n entry \\
- .
- .
- .
- \end{tabular*}
-
-These environments produce a box consisting of a sequence of rows of items,
-aligned vertically in columns. The mandatory and optional arguments consist
-of:
-
-{width} Specifies the width of the tabular* environment. There must be
- rubber space between columns that can stretch to fill out the
- specified width.
-
-[pos] Specifies the vertical position; default is alignment on the
- centre of the environment.
- t - align on top row
- b - align on bottom row
-
-{cols} Specifies the column formatting. It consists of a sequence of
- the following specifiers, corresponding to the sequence of
- columns and intercolumn material.
- l - A column of left-aligned items.
-
- r - A column of right-aligned items.
-
- c - A column of centred items.
-
- | - A vertical line the full height and depth of the
- environment.
-
- @{text} - This inserts text in every row. An @-expression
- suppresses the intercolumn space normally inserted
- between columns; any desired space between the
- inserted text and the adjacent items must be included
- in text. An \extracolsep{wd} command in an
- @-expression causes an extra space of width {wd} to
- appear to the left of all subsequent columns, until
- countermanded by another |\extracolsep| command. Unlike
- ordinary intercolumn space, this extra space is not
- suppressed by an @-expression. An |\extracolsep|
- command can be used only in an @-expression in the
- cols argument.
-
- p{wd} - Produces a column with each item typeset in a |\parbox|
- of width {wd}, as if it were the argument of a
- \parbox[t]{wd} command. However, a |\\| may not appear
- in the item, except in the following situations:
- 1. inside an environment like |minipage|, |array|, or
- |tabular|.
- 2. inside an explicit |\parbox|.
- 3. in the scope of a |\centering|, |\raggedright|, or
- |\raggedleft| declaration. The latter declarations must
- appear inside braces or an environment when used in a
- p-column element.
-
- {num}{cols} - Equivalent to num copies of cols, where num is any positive
- integer and cols is any list of column-specifiers,
- which may contain another -expression.
-
-These commands can be used inside a tabular environment:
-
-|\cline| Draw a horizontal line spanning some columns.
-|\hline| Draw a * horizontal line spanning all columns.
-|\multicolumn| Make an item spanning * several columns.
-|\vline| Draw a vertical line.
-
-
-\cline{i-j} *\cline*
- The |\cline| command draws horizontal lines across the columns
- specified, beginning in column i and ending in column j,
- which are identified in the mandatory argument.
-
-\hline *\hline*
- The |\hline| command will draw a horizontal line the width of
- the table. It's most commonly used to draw a line at the top,
- bottom, and between the rows of the table.
-
-\multicolumn{cols}{pos}{text} *\multicolumn*
- The |\multicolumn| is used to make an entry that spans several
- columns. The first mandatory argument, {cols}, specifies the
- number of columns to span. The second mandatory argument,
- {pos}, specifies the formatting of the entry:
- c - centered
- l - flushleft
- r - flushright.
- The third mandatory argument, {text}, specifies what text is
- to make up the entry.
-
-\vline *\vline*
- The |\vline| command will draw a vertical line extending the
- full height and depth of its row. An |\hfill| command can be
- used to move the line to the edge of the column. It can also
- be used in an @-expression.
-
-==============================================================================
-t. thebibliography *\thebibliography*
->
- \begin{thebibliography}{widestlabel}
- \bibitem[label]{cite_key}
- .
- .
- .
- \end{thebibliography}
-
-The |\thebibliography| environment produces a bibliography or reference list.
-
-In the |article-class|, this reference list is labelled "References"; in the
-|report-class|, it is labelled "Bibliography".
-
-{widestlabel} Text that, when printed, is approximately as wide as the
- widest item label produces by the |\bibitem| commands.
-
-|\bibitem| Specify a bibliography item.
-|\cite| Refer to a bibliography item.
-|\nocite| Include an item in the bibliography.
-|BibTeX| Automatic generation of bibliographies.
-
-\bibitem *\bibitem*
-\bibitem[label]{citekey}
- The |\bibitem| command generates an entry labelled by [label].
- If the [label] argument is missing, a number is generated as
- the label, using the |\enumi| counter. The {citekey} is any
- sequence of letters, numbers, and punctuation symbols not
- containing a comma. This command writes an entry on the `.aux'
- file containing {citekey} and the item's label. When this
- `.aux' file is read by the \begin{document} command, the
- item's label is associated with {citekey}, causing the
- reference to {citekey} by a |\cite| command to produce the
- associated label.
-
-\cite *\cite*
-\cite[text]{keylist}
- The {keylist} argument is a list of citation keys. This
- command generates an in-text citation to the references
- associated with the keys in {keylist} by entries on the `.aux'
- file read by the \begin{document} command.
- The optional text argument will appear after the
- citation, i.e.: >
- \cite[p.2]{knuth}
-< might produce `[Knuth, p. 2]'.
-
-\nocite *\nocite*
-\nocite{keylist}
- The |\nocite| command produces no text, but writes
- {keylist}, which is a list of one or more citation
- keys, on the `.aux' file.
-
-BibTeX *BibTeX* *bibtex*
- *\bibliographystyle*
-If you use the BibTeX program by Oren Patashnik (highly recommended if you
-need a bibliography of more than a couple of titles) to maintain your
-bibliography, you don't use the |thebibliography| environment. Instead, you
-include the lines:
->
- \bibliographystyle{style}
- \bibliography{bibfile}
-
-where {style} refers to a file style.bst, which defines how your citations
-will look. The standard styles distributed with BibTeX are:
-
-{alpha} Sorted alphabetically. Labels are formed from name of author and year
- of publication.
-{plain} Sorted alphabetically. Labels are numeric.
-{unsrt} Like plain, but entries are in order of citation.
-{abbrv} Like plain, but more compact labels.
-
-In addition, numerous other BibTeX style files exist tailored to the demands
-of various publications.
-
- *\bibliography*
-The argument to |\bibliography| refers to the file bibfile.bib, which should
-contain your database in BibTeX format. Only the entries referred to via
-|\cite| and |\nocite| will be listed in the bibliography.
-
-==============================================================================
-u. theorem *theorem*
->
- \begin{theorem}
- theorem text
- \end{theorem}
-
-The |theorem| environment produces "Theorem x" in boldface followed by your
-theorem text.
-
-==============================================================================
-v. titlepage *titlepage*
->
- \begin{titlepage}
- text
- \end{titlepage}
-
-The |titlepage| environment creates a title page, i.e. a page with no printed
-page number or heading. It also causes the following page to be numbered page
-one. Formatting the title page is left to you. The |\today| command comes in
-handy for title pages.
-
-Note that you can use the |\maketitle| to produce a standard title page.
-
-==============================================================================
-x. verbatim *verbatim*
->
- \begin{verbatim}
- text
- \end{verbatim}
-
-The |verbatim| environment is a paragraph-making environment that gets LaTeX
-to print exactly what you type in. It turns LaTeX into a typewriter with
-carriage returns and blanks having the same effect that they would on a
-typewriter.
-
-\verb *\verb*
-\verb char literal_text char
-\verb*char literal_text char
- Typesets literal_text exactly as typed, including
- special characters and spaces, using a typewriter |\tt|
- type style. There may be no space between |\verb| or
- |\verb|* and char (space is shown here only for
- clarity). The *-form differs only in that spaces are
- printed as `\verb*| |\'.
-
-==============================================================================
-y. verse *verse*
->
- \begin{verse}
- text
- \end{verse}
-
-The |verse| environment is designed for poetry, though you may find other uses
-for it.
-
-The margins are indented on the left and the right. Separate the lines of each
-stanza with |\\|, and use one or more blank lines to separate the stanzas.
-
-==============================================================================
-8. Footnotes *latex-footnotes*
-
-Footnotes can be produced in one of two ways. They can be produced with one
-command, the |\footnote| command. They can also be produced with two commands,
-the |\footnotemark| and the |\footnotetext| commands. See the specific command for
-information on why you would use one over the other.
-
-|\footnote| Insert a footnote
-|\footnotemark| Insert footnote mark only
-|\footnotetext| Insert footnote text only
-
-\footnote[number]{text} *\footnote*
- Command places the numbered footnote text at the bottom of the
- current page. The optional argument, number, is used to change
- the default footnote number. This command can only be used in
- outer paragraph mode; i.e., you cannot use it in sectioning
- commands like |\chapter|, in |\figure|, |\table| or in a
- |\tabular| environment.
-
-\footnotemark *\footnotemark*
- Command puts the footnote number in the text. This command can
- be used in inner paragraph mode. The text of the footnote is
- supplied by the |\footnotetext| command.
- This command can be used to produce several consecutive
- footnote markers referring to the same footnote by using
->
- \footnotemark[\value{footnote}]
-<
- after the first |\footnote| command.
-
-\footnotetext[number]{text} *\footnotetext*
- Command produces the text to be placed at the bottom of the
- page. This command can come anywhere after the |\footnotemark|
- command. The |\footnotetext| command must appear in outer
- paragraph mode. The optional argument, number, is used to
- change the default footnote number.
-
-==============================================================================
-9. Lengths *latex-lengths*
-
-A length is a measure of distance. Many LaTeX commands take a length as an
-argument.
-
-|\newlength| Define a new length.
-|\setlength| Set the value of a length.
-|\addtolength| Add a quantity to a length.
-|\settodepth| Set a length to the depth of something.
-|\settoheight| Set a length to the height of something.
-|\settowidth| Set a length to the width of something.
-|pre-lengths| Lengths that are, like, predefined.
-
-\newlength{\gnat} *\newlength*
- The |\newlength| command defines the mandatory argument, \gnat,
- as a length command with a value of 0in. An error occurs if a
- \gnat command already exists.
-
-\setlength{\gnat}{length} *\setlength*
- The |\setlength| command is used to set the value of a \gnat
- command. The {length} argument can be expressed in any terms
- of length LaTeX understands, i.e., inches (in), millimetres
- (mm), points (pt), etc.
-
-\addtolength{\gnat}{length} *\addtolength*
- The |\addtolength| command increments a \gnat by the amount
- specified in the {length} argument. It can be a negative
- amount.
-
-\settodepth{\gnat}{text} *\settodepth*
- The |\settodepth| command sets the value of a \gnat command
- equal to the depth of the {text} argument.
-
-\settoheight{\gnat}{text} *\settoheight*
- The |\settoheight| command sets the value of a \gnat command
- equal to the height of the {text} argument.
-
-\settowidth{\gnat}{text} *\settowidth*
- The |\settowidth| command sets the value of a \gnat command
- equal to the width of the {text} argument.
-
-Predefined lengths *pre-lengths*
-
-\width *\width*
-\height *\height*
-\depth *\depth*
-\totalheight *\totalheight*
- These length parameters can be used in the arguments of the
- box-making commands See section Spaces & Boxes. They specify
- the natural width etc. of the text in the box.
- \totalheight equals \height + \depth.
- To make a box with the text stretched to double the natural
- size, e.g., say: >
- \makebox[2\width]{Get a stretcher}
-
-==============================================================================
-10. Letters *latex-letters*
-
-You can use LaTeX to typeset letters, both personal and business. The letter
-document class is designed to make a number of letters at once, although you
-can make just one if you so desire.
-
-Your `.tex' source file has the same minimum commands as the other document
-classes, i.e., you must have the following commands as a minimum: >
- \documentclass{letter}
- \begin{document}
- ...
- letters
- ...
- \end{document}
-
-Each letter is a letter environment, whose argument is the name and address of
-the recipient. For example, you might have: >
- \begin{letter}
- {Mr. Joe Smith\\
- 2345 Princess St. \\
- Edinburgh, EH1 1AA}
- ...
- \end{letter}
-
-The letter itself begins with the |\opening| command. The text of the letter
-follows. It is typed as ordinary LaTeX input. Commands that make no sense in
-a letter, like |\chapter|, do not work. The letter closes with a |\closing|
-command.
-
-After the closing, you can have additional material. The |\cc| command produces
-the usual "cc: ...". There's also a similar |\encl| command for a list of
-enclosures. With both these commands, use|\\| to separate the items.
-
-These commands are used with the letter class:
-|\address| Your return address.
-|\cc| Cc list. closing Saying goodbye.
-|\encl| List of enclosed material.
-|\location| Your organisation's address.
-|\makelabels| Making address labels.
-|\name| Your name, for the return address.
-|\opening| Saying hello.
-|\ps| Adding a postscript.
-|\signature| Your signature.
-|\startbreaks| Allow page breaks.
-|\stopbreaks| Disallow page breaks.
-|\telephone| Your phone number.
-
-\address{Return address} *\address*
- The return address, as it should appear on the letter and the
- envelope. Separate lines of the address should be separated
- by |\\| commands. If you do not make an |\address| declaration,
- then the letter will be formatted for copying onto your
- organisation's standard letterhead. (See section Overview of
- LaTeX and Local Guide, for details on your local
- implementation). If you give an |\address| declaration, then
- the letter will be formatted as a personal letter.
-
-\cc{Kate Schechter\\Rob McKenna} *\cc*
- Generate a list of other persons the letter was sent to. Each
- name is printed on a separate line.
-
-\closing{text} *\closing*
- The letter closes with a |\closing| command, i.e., >
- \closing{Best Regards,} \encl{CV\\Certificates}
-< Generate a list of enclosed material.
-
-\location{address} *\location*
- This modifies your organisation's standard address. This only
- appears if the firstpage pagestyle is selected.
-
-\makelabels{number} *\makelabels*
- If you issue this command in the preamble, LaTeX will create a
- sheet of address labels. This sheet will be output before the
- letters.
-
-\name{June Davenport} *\name*
- Your name, used for printing on the envelope together with the
- return address.
-
-\opening{text} *\opening*
- The letter begins with the |\opening| command. The mandatory
- argument, text, is whatever text you wish to start your
- letter, i.e., >
- \opening{Dear Joe,}
-
-\ps *\ps*
- Use this command before a postscript.
-
-\signature{Harvey Swick} *\signature*
- Your name, as it should appear at the end of the letter
- underneath the space for your signature. Items that should go
- on separate lines should be separated by |\\| commands.
-
-\startbreaks *\startbreaks*
- Used after a |\stopbreaks| command to allow page breaks again.
-
-\stopbreaks *\stopbreaks*
- Inhibit page breaks until a |\startbreaks| command occurs.
-
-\telephone{number} *\telephone*
- This is your telephone number. This only appears if the
- firstpage pagestyle is selected.
-
-==============================================================================
-11. Line & Page Breaking *latex-breaking*
-
-The first thing LaTeX does when processing ordinary text is to translate your
-input file into a string of glyphs and spaces. To produce a printed document,
-this string must be broken into lines, and these lines must be broken into
-pages. In some environments, you do the line breaking yourself with the |\\|
-command, but LaTeX usually does it for you.
-
-|\\| Start a new line
-|hyph-| Insert explicit hyphenation
-|\cleardoublepage| Start a new right-hand page
-|\clearpage| Start a new page
-|\enlargethispage| Enlarge the current page a bit
-|\fussy| Be fussy about line breaking
-|\hyphenation| Tell LaTeX how to hyphenate a word
-|\linebreak| Break the line
-|\newline| Break the line prematurely
-|\newpage| Start a new page
-|\nolinebreak| Don't break the current line
-|\nopagebreak| Don't make a page break here
-|\pagebreak| Please make a page break here
-|\sloppy| Be sloppy about line breaking
-
-\\[*][extraspace] *\\* *\\\\*
- The |\\| command tells LaTeX to start a new line. It has an
- optional argument, [extraspace], that specifies how much extra
- vertical space is to be inserted before the next line. This
- can be a negative amount.
- The \\* command is the same as the ordinary |\\| command
- except that it tells LaTeX not to start a new page after the
- line.
-
-\- *hyph-*
- The \- command tells LaTeX that it may hyphenate the word at
- that point. LaTeX is very good at hyphenating, and it will
- usually find all correct hyphenation points. The \- command is
- used for the exceptional cases.
- Note: when you insert \- commands in a word, the word will
- only be hyphenated at those points and not at any of the
- hyphenation points that LaTeX might otherwise have chosen.
-
-\cleardoublepage *\cleardoublepage*
- The |\cleardoublepage| command ends the current page and causes
- all figures and tables that have so far appeared in the input
- to be printed. In a two-sided printing style (|twoside|), it
- also makes the next page a right-hand (odd-numbered) page,
- producing a blank page if necessary.
-
-\clearpage *\clearpage*
- The |\clearpage| command ends the current page and causes all
- figures and tables that have so far appeared in the input to
- be printed.
-
-\enlargethispage{size} *\enlargethispage*
-\enlargethispage*{size}
- Enlarge the textheight for the current page by the
- specified amount; e.g.: >
-
- \enlargethispage{\baselineskip}
-<
- will allow one additional line. The starred form
- tries to squeeze the material together on the page as
- much as possible. This is normally used together with
- an explicit |\pagebreak|.
-
-\fussy *\fussy*
- This declaration (which is the default) makes TeX more fussy
- about line breaking. This can avoids too much space between
- words, but may produce overfull boxes. This command cancels
- the effect of a previous |\sloppy| command.
-
-\hyphenation{words} *\hyphenation*
- The |\hyphenation| command declares allowed hyphenation points,
- where words is a list of words, separated by spaces, in which
- each hyphenation point is indicated by a - character.
-
-\linebreak[number] *\linebreak*
- The |\linebreak| command tells LaTeX to break the current line
- at the point of the command. With the optional argument,
- number, you can convert the |\linebreak| command from a demand
- to a request. The [number] must be a number from 0 to 4. The
- higher the number, the more insistent the request is. The
- |\linebreak| command causes LaTeX to stretch the line so it
- extends to the right margin.
-
-\newline *\newline*
- The |\newline| command breaks the line right where it is. It
- can only be used in paragraph mode.
-
-\newpage *\newpage*
- The |\newpage| command ends the current page.
-
-\nolinebreak[number] *\nolinebreak*
- The |\nolinebreak| command prevents LaTeX from breaking the
- current line at the point of the command. With the optional
- argument, [number], you can convert the |\nolinebreak| command
- from a demand to a request. The [number] must be a number from 0
- to 4. The higher the number, the more insistent the request
- is.
-
-\nopagebreak[number] *\nopagebreak*
- The |\nopagebreak| command prevents LaTeX from breaking the
- current page at the point of the command. With the optional
- argument, [number], you can convert the |\nopagebreak| command
- from a demand to a request. The [number] must be a number from
- 0 to 4. The higher the number, the more insistent the request
- is.
-
-\pagebreak[number] *\pagebreak*
- The |\pagebreak| command tells LaTeX to break the current page
- at the point of the command. With the optional argument,
- [number], you can convert the |\pagebreak| command from a
- demand to a request. The [number] must be a number from 0 to
- 4. The higher the number, the more insistent the request is.
-
-\sloppy *\sloppy*
- This declaration makes TeX less fussy about line breaking.
- This can prevent overfull boxes, but may leave too much space
- between words.
- Lasts until a |\fussy| command is issued.
-
-==============================================================================
-12. Making Paragraphs *latex-paragraphs*
-
-A paragraph is ended by one or more completely blank lines -- lines not
-containing even a |\%|. A blank line should not appear where a new paragraph
-cannot be started, such as in math mode or in the argument of a sectioning
-command.
-
-|\indent| Indent this paragraph.
-|\noindent| Do not indent this paragraph.
-|\par| Another way of writing a blank line.
-
-\indent *\indent*
- This produces a horizontal space whose width equals the width
- of the paragraph indentation. It is used to add paragraph
- indentation where it would otherwise be suppressed.
-
-\noindent *\noindent*
- When used at the beginning of the paragraph, it suppresses the
- paragraph indentation. It has no effect when used in the
- middle of a paragraph.
-
-\par *\par*
- Equivalent to a blank line; often used to make command or
- environment definitions easier to read.
-
-==============================================================================
-13. Margin Notes *latex-margin-notes*
-
-\marginpar[left]{right} *\marginpar*
- This command creates a note in the margin. The first line will
- be at the same height as the line in the text where the
- |\marginpar| occurs.
-
- When you only specify the mandatory argument {right}, the text
- will be placed:
- * in the right margin for one-sided layout
- * in the outside margin for two-sided layout (|twoside|)
- * in the nearest margin for two-column layout (|twocolumn|)
-
-\reversemarginpar *\reversemarginpar*
- By issuing the command |\reversemarginpar|, you can force the
- marginal notes to go into the opposite (inside) margin.
-
-When you specify both arguments, left is used for the left margin, and right
-is used for the right margin.
-
-The first word will normally not be hyphenated; you can enable hyphenation by
-prefixing the first word with a \hspace{0pt} command (|hspace|).
-
-==============================================================================
-14. Math Formulae *latex-math*
- *displaymath*
-There are three environments (|latex-environments|) that put LaTeX in math
-mode:
-|math| For Formulae that appear right in the text.
-|displaymath| For Formulae that appear on their own line.
-|equation| The same as the displaymath environment except that it adds an
- equation number in the right margin.
-
-The |math| environment can be used in both paragraph and LR mode, but the
-|displaymath| and |equation| environments can be used only in paragraph mode. The
-|math| and |displaymath| environments are used so often that they have the
-following short forms:
- \(...\) instead of \begin{math}...\end{math}
- \[...\] instead of \begin{displaymath}...\end{displaymath}
-
-In fact, the math environment is so common that it has an even shorter form:
- $ ... $ instead of \(...\)
-
-|sub-sup| Also known as exponent or index.
-|math-symbols| Various mathematical squiggles.
-|math-spacing| Thick, medium, thin and negative spaces.
-|math-misc| Stuff that doesn't fit anywhere else.
-
-==========
-Subscripts & Superscripts *sub-sup*
- *subscripts* *superscripts*
-
-To get an expression exp to appear as a subscript, you just type _{exp}. To
-get exp to appear as a superscript, you type ^{exp}. LaTeX handles
-superscripted superscripts and all of that stuff in the natural way. It even
-does the right thing when something has both a subscript and a superscript.
-
-==========
-Math Symbols *math-symbols*
-
-LaTeX provides almost any mathematical symbol you're likely to need. The
-commands for generating them can be used only in math mode. For example, if
-you include >
- $\pi$
-in your source, you will get the symbol in your output.
-
-==========
-Spacing in Math Mode *math-spacing*
-
-In a math environment, LaTeX ignores the spaces you type and puts in the
-spacing that it thinks is best. LaTeX formats mathematics the way it's done in
-mathematics texts. If you want different spacing, LaTeX provides the following
-four commands for use in math mode:
- \; - a thick space *math;*
- \: - a medium space *math:*
- \, - a thin space *math,*
- \! - a negative thin space *matn!*
-
-==========
-Math Miscellany *math-misc*
-
-\cdots *\cdots*
- Produces a horizontal ellipsis where the dots are raised to
- the centre of the line.
-\ddots *\ddots*
- Produces a diagonal ellipsis.
-\frac{num}{den} *\frac*
- Produces the fraction num divided by den.
-\ldots *\ldots*
- Produces an ellipsis. This command works in any mode, not just
- math mode.
-\overbrace{text} *\overbrace*
- Generates a brace over text.
-\overline{text} *\overline*
- Causes the argument text to be overlined.
-\sqrt[root]{arg} *\sqrt*
- Produces the square root of its argument. The optional
- argument, [root], determines what root to produce, i.e., the
- cube root of x+y would be typed as: >
- $\sqrt[3]{x+y}$.
-\underbrace{text} *\underbrace*
- Generates text with a brace underneath.
-\underline{text} *\underline*
- Causes the argument text to be underlined. This command can
- also be used in paragraph and LR mode.
-\vdots *\vdots*
- Produces a vertical ellipsis.
-
-==============================================================================
-15. Modes *latex-modes*
-
-When LaTeX is processing your input text, it is always in one of three modes:
- Paragraph mode *paragraph-mode*
- Math mode *math-mode*
- Left-to-right mode, called LR mode for short. *lr-mode*
-
-LaTeX changes mode only when it goes up or down a staircase to a different
-level, though not all level changes produce mode changes. Mode changes occur
-only when entering or leaving an environment, or when LaTeX is processing the
-argument of certain text-producing commands.
-
-|paragraph-mode| is the most common; it's the one LaTeX is in when processing
-ordinary text. In that mode, LaTeX breaks your text into lines and breaks the
-lines into pages. LaTeX is in |math-mode| when it's generating a mathematical
-formula. In |lr-mode|, as in |paragraph-mode|, LaTeX considers the output that
-it produces to be a string of words with spaces between them. However, unlike
-|paragraph-mode|, LaTeX keeps going from left to right; it never starts a new
-line in |lr-mode|. Even if you put a hundred words into an |\mbox|, LaTeX would
-keep typesetting them from left to right inside a single box, and then
-complain because the resulting box was too wide to fit on the line.
-
-LaTeX is in |lr-mode| when it starts making a box with an |\mbox| command. You
-can get it to enter a different mode inside the box - for example, you can
-make it enter |math-mode| to put a formula in the box. There are also several
-text-producing commands and environments for making a box that put LaTeX in
-|paragraph-mode|. The box make by one of these commands or environments will be
-called a |\parbox|. When LaTeX is in |paragraph-mode| while making a box, it is
-said to be in "inner paragraph mode". Its normal |paragraph-mode|, which it
-starts out in, is called "outer paragraph mode".
-
-==============================================================================
-16. Page Styles *latex-page-styles*
-
-The |\documentclass| command determines the size and position of the page's head
-and foot. The page style determines what goes in them.
-
-|\maketitle| Generate a title page.
-|\pagenumbering| Set the style used for page numbers.
-|\pagestyle| Change the headings/footings style.
-|\thispagestyle| Change the headings/footings style for this page.
-
-\maketitle *\maketitle*
- The |\maketitle| command generates a title on a separate title
- page - except in the |\article| class, where the title normally
- goes at the top of the first page. Information used to
- produce the title is obtained from the following declarations:
-
- |\author| Who wrote this stuff?
- |\date| The date the document was created.
- |\thanks| A special form of footnote.
- |\title| How to set the document title.
-
- \author{names} *\author* *\and*
- The |\author| command declares the author(s), where
- names is a list of authors separated by \and commands.
- Use |\\| to separate lines within a single author's
- entry -- for example, to give the author's institution
- or address.
-
- \date{text} *\date*
- The |\date| command declares text to be the document's
- date. With no |\date| command, the current date is
- used.
-
- \thanks{text} *\thanks*
- The |\thanks| command produces a |\footnote| to the
- title.
-
- \title{text} *\title*
- The |\title| command declares text to be the title. Use
- |\\| to tell LaTeX where to start a new line in a long
- title.
-
-\pagenumbering{numstyle} *\pagenumbering*
- Specifies the style of page numbers. Possible values of
- 'numstyle' are:
- arabic - Arabic numerals *arabic*
- roman - Lowercase Roman numerals *roman*
- Roman - Uppercase Roman numerals *Roman*
- alph - Lowercase letters *alph*
- Alph - Uppercase letters *Alph*
-
-\pagestyle{option} *\pagestyle*
- *plain* *empty* *headings*
- The |\pagestyle| command changes the style from the current
- page on throughout the remainder of your document.
- The valid options are:
- plain - Just a plain page number.
- empty - Produces empty heads and feet no page numbers.
- headings - Puts running headings on each page. The document
- style specifies what goes in the headings.
- myheadings - You specify what is to go in the heading with the
- |\markboth| or the |\markright| commands.
-
- |\markboth| Set left and right headings.
- |\markright| Set right heading only.
-
- \markboth{left head}{right head} *\markboth*
- The |\markboth| command is used in conjunction with the
- page style myheadings for setting both the left and
- the right heading.
- Note that a "left-hand heading" is generated by the
- last |\markboth| command before the end of the page,
- while a "right-hand heading" is generated by the first
- |\markboth| or |\markright| that comes on the page if
- there is one, otherwise by the last one before the
- page.
-
-
- \markright{right head} *\markright*
- The |\markright| command is used in conjunction with
- the page style |\myheadings| for setting the right
- heading, leaving the left heading unchanged.
- Note that a "left-hand heading" is generated by the
- last |\markboth| command before the end of the page,
- while a "right-hand heading" is generated by the first
- |\markboth| or |\markright| that comes on the page if
- there is one, otherwise by the last one before the
- page.
-
-\thispagestyle{option} *\thispagestyle*
- The |\thispagestyle| command works in the same manner as the
- |\pagestyle| command except that it changes the style for the
- current page only.
-
-==============================================================================
-17. Sectioning *latex-sectioning*
-
-Sectioning commands provide the means to structure your text into units.
-|\part|
-|\chapter| (report and book class only)
-|\section|
-|\subsection|
-|\subsubsection|
-|\paragraph|
-|\subparagraph|
-
-All sectioning commands take the same general form, i.e.,
-
- *\part*
- *\chapter* (report and book class only)
- *\section* *\subsection* *\subsubsection*
- *\paragraph* *\subparagraph*
-\chapter[optional]{title}
- In addition to providing the heading in the text, the
- mandatory argument of the sectioning command can appear in two
- other places:
- 1. The table of contents
- 2. The running head at the top of the page. You may not want
- the same thing to appear in these other two places as
- appears in the text heading. To handle this situation, the
- sectioning commands have an optional argument that provides
- the text for these other two purposes.
-
-All sectioning commands have *\-forms that print a title, but do not include a
-number and do not make an entry in the table of contents.
-
-\appendix *\appendix*
- The |\appendix| command changes the way sectional units are
- numbered. The |\appendix| command generates no text and does
- not affect the numbering of parts. The normal use of this
- command is something like: >
- \chapter{The First Chapter}
- ...
- \appendix \chapter{The First Appendix}
-
-
-==============================================================================
-18. Spaces & Boxes *latex-spaces-boxes*
-
-All the predefined length parameters See section Predefined lengths can be
-used in the arguments of the box-making commands.
-
- Horizontal space:
-
-|\dotfill| Stretchable horizontal dots.
-|\hfill| Stretchable horizontal space.
-|\hrulefill| Stretchable horizontal rule.
-|\hspace| Fixed horizontal space.
-
- Vertical space:
-
-|\addvspace| Fixed vertical space.
-|\bigskip| Fixed vertical space.
-|\medskip| Fixed vertical space.
-|\smallskip| Fixed vertical space.
-|\vfill| Stretchable vertical space.
-|\vspace| Fixed vertical space.
-
- Boxes:
-
-|\fbox| Framebox.
-|\framebox| Framebox, adjustable position.
-|\lrbox| An environment like |\sbox|.
-|\makebox| Box, adjustable position.
-|\mbox| Box.
-|\newsavebox| Declare a name for saving a box.
-|\parbox| Box with text in paragraph mode.
-|\raisebox| Raise or lower text.
-|\rule| Lines and squares.
-|\savebox| Like |\makebox|, but save the text for later use.
-|\sbox| Like |\mbox|, but save the text for later use.
-|\usebox| Print saved text.
-
-Horizontal space: *latex-hor-space*
-
-LaTeX removes horizontal space that comes at the end of a line. If you don't
-want LaTeX to remove this space, include the optional * argument. Then the
-space is never removed.
-
-\dotfill *\dotfill*
- The |\dotfill| command produces a "rubber length" that produces
- dots instead of just spaces.
-
-\hfill *\hfill*
- The |\hfill| fill command produces a "rubber length" which can
- stretch or shrink horizontally. It will be filled with spaces.
-
-\hrulefill *\hrulefill*
- The |\hrulefill| fill command produces a "rubber length" which
- can stretch or shrink horizontally. It will be filled with a
- horizontal rule.
-
-\hspace[*]{length} *\hspace*
- The |\hspace| command adds horizontal space. The length of the
- space can be expressed in any terms that LaTeX understands,
- i.e., points, inches, etc. You can add negative as well as
- positive space with an |\hspace| command. Adding negative space
- is like backspacing.
-
-
-Vertical space: *latex-ver-space*
-
-LaTeX removes vertical space that comes at the end of a page. If you don't
-want LaTeX to remove this space, include the optional * argument. Then the
-space is never removed.
-
-\addvspace{length} *\addvspace*
- The |\addvspace| command normally adds a vertical space of
- height length. However, if vertical space has already been
- added to the same point in the output by a previous
- |\addvspace| command, then this command will not add more space
- than needed to make the natural length of the total vertical
- space equal to length.
-
-\bigskip *\bigskip*
- The |\bigskip| command is equivalent to \vspace{bigskipamount}
- where bigskipamount is determined by the document class.
-
-\medskip *\medskip*
- The |\medskip| command is equivalent to \vspace{medskipamount}
- where medskipamount is determined by the document class.
-
-\smallskip *\smallskip*
- The |\smallskip| command is equivalent to
- \vspace{smallskipamount} where smallskipamount is determined
- by the document class.
-
-\vfill *\vfill*
- The |\vfill| fill command produces a rubber length which can
- stretch or shrink vertically.
-
-\vspace[*]{length} *\vspace*
- The |\vspace| command adds vertical space. The length of the
- space can be expressed in any terms that LaTeX understands,
- i.e., points, inches, etc. You can add negative as well as
- positive space with an |\vspace| command.
-
-
-Boxes: *latex-boxes*
-
-\fbox{text} *\fbox*
- The |\fbox| command is exactly the same as the |\mbox| command,
- except that it puts a frame around the outside of the box that
- it creates.
-
-\framebox[width][position]{text} *\framebox*
- The |\framebox| command is exactly the same as the |\makebox|
- command, except that it puts a frame around the outside of the
- box that it creates.
- The |\framebox| command produces a rule of thickness
- |\fboxrule|, and leaves a space |\fboxsep| between the rule and
- the contents of the box.
-
-lrbox *\lrbox*
-\begin{lrbox}{cmd} text \end{lrbox}
- This is the environment form of |\sbox|.
- The text inside the environment is saved in the box cmd, which
- must have been declared with |\newsavebox|.
-
-\makebox[width][position]{text} *\makebox*
- The |\makebox| command creates a box just wide enough to
- contain the text specified. The width of the box is specified
- by the optional [width] argument. The position of the text
- within the box is determined by the optional [position]
- argument.
- c -- centred (default)
- l -- flushleft
- r -- flushright
- s -- stretch from left to right margin. The text must
- contain stretchable space for this to work.
- See section |\picture-makebox|.
-
-\mbox{text} *\mbox*
- The |\mbox| command creates a box just wide enough to hold the
- text created by its argument.
- Use this command to prevent text from being split across
- lines.
-
-\newsavebox{cmd} *\newsavebox*
- Declares {cmd}, which must be a command name that is not
- already defined, to be a bin for saving boxes.
-
-
-\parbox[position][height][innerpos]{width}{text} *\parbox*
- A parbox is a box whose contents are created in
- |\paragraph-mode|. The |\parbox| has two
-
- Mandatory arguments:
-'width' specifies the width of the parbox
-'text' the text that goes inside the parbox.
-
- Optional arguments:
-'position' LaTeX will position a parbox so its centre lines up with the
- centre of the text line. The optional position argument allows
- you to line up either the top or bottom line in the parbox
- (default is top).
-
-'height' If the height argument is not given, the box will have the
- natural height of the text.
-
-'innerpos' The inner-pos argument controls the placement of the text
- inside the box. If it is not specified, position is used.
- t -- text is placed at the top of the box
- c -- text is centred in the box
- b -- text is placed at the bottom of the box
- s -- stretch vertically. The text must contain
- vertically stretchable space for this to work.
-
- A |\parbox| command is used for a parbox containing a small
- piece of text, with nothing fancy inside. In particular, you
- shouldn't use any of the paragraph-making environments inside
- a |\parbox| argument. For larger pieces of text, including ones
- containing a paragraph-making environment, you should use a
- |\minipage| environment.
-
-\raisebox{distance}[extendabove][extendbelow]{text} *\raisebox*
- The |\raisebox| command is used to raise or lower text. The
- first mandatory argument specifies how high the text is to be
- raised (or lowered if it is a negative amount). The text
- itself is processed in LR mode.
- Sometimes it's useful to make LaTeX think something has a
- different size than it really does - or a different size than
- LaTeX would normally think it has. The |\raisebox| command
- lets you tell LaTeX how tall it is.
- The first optional argument, extend-above, makes LaTeX think
- that the text extends above the line by the amount specified.
- The second optional argument, extend-below, makes LaTeX think
- that the text extends below the line by the amount specified.
-
-\rule[raiseheight]{width}{thickness} *\rule*
- The |\rule| command is used to produce horizontal lines. The
- arguments are defined as follows:
-'raiseheight' specifies how high to raise the rule (optional)
-'width' specifies the length of the rule (mandatory)
-'thickness' specifies the thickness of the rule (mandatory)
-
-\savebox{cmd}[width][pos]{text} *\savebox*
- This command typeset text in a box just as for |\makebox|.
- However, instead of printing the resulting box, it saves it in
- bin cmd, which must have been declared with |\newsavebox|.
-
-\sbox{text} *\sbox*
- This commands typeset text in a box just as for |\mbox|.
- However, instead of printing the resulting box, it saves it in
- bin cmd, which must have been declared with |\newsavebox|.
-
-\usebox{cmd} *\usebox*
- Prints the box most recently saved in bin cmd by a |\savebox|
- command.
-
-==============================================================================
-19. Special Characters *latex-special*
-
-The following characters play a special role in LaTeX and are called "special
-printing characters", or simply "special characters". >
- # $ % & ~ _ ^ \ { }
-Whenever you put one of these special characters into your file, you are doing
-something special. If you simply want the character to be printed just as any
-other letter, include a \ in front of the character. For example, \$ will
-produce $ in your output.
-
-One exception to this rule is the \ itself because |\\| has its own special
-meaning. A \ is produced by typing $\backslash$ in your file.
-
-Also, \~ means `place a tilde accent over the following letter', so you will
-probably want to use |\verb| instead.
- *\symbol*
-In addition, you can access any character of a font once you know its number
-by using the |\symbol| command. For example, the character used for displaying
-spaces in the |\verb|* command has the code decimal 32, so it can be typed as
-\symbol{32}.
-
-You can also specify octal numbers with ' or hexadecimal numbers with ", so
-the previous example could also be written as \symbol{'40} or \symbol{"20}.
-
-==============================================================================
-20. Splitting the Input *latex-inputting*
-
-A large document requires a lot of input. Rather than putting the whole input
-in a single large file, it's more efficient to split it into several smaller
-ones. Regardless of how many separate files you use, there is one that is the
-root file; it is the one whose name you type when you run LaTeX.
-
-|\include| Conditionally include a file
-|\includeonly| Determine which files are included
-|\input| Unconditionally include a file
-
-\include{file} *\include*
- The \include command is used in conjunction with the
- |\includeonly| command for selective inclusion of
- files. The file argument is the first name of a file,
- denoting `file.tex' . If file is one the file names in
- the file list of the |\includeonly| command or if there
- is no |\includeonly| command, the \include command is
- equivalent to: >
- \clearpage \input{file} \clearpage
-<
- except that if the file `file.tex' does not exist,
- then a warning message rather than an error is
- produced. If the file is not in the file list, the
- \include command is equivalent to |\clearpage|.
-
- The |\include| command may not appear in the preamble or in a
- file read by another |\include| command.
-
-\includeonly{filelist} *\includeonly*
- The |\includeonly| command controls which files will be read in
- by an |\include| command. {filelist} should be a
- comma-separated list of filenames. Each filename must match
- exactly a filename specified in a |\include| command. This
- command can only appear in the preamble.
-
-\input{file} *\input*
- The |\input| command causes the indicated file to be read and
- processed, exactly as if its contents had been inserted in the
- current file at that point. The file name may be a complete
- file name with extension or just a first name, in which case
- the file `file.tex' is used.
-==============================================================================
-21. Starting & Ending *latex-start-end*
-
-Your input file must contain the following commands as a minimum:
-\documentclass{class} |\documentclass|
-\begin{document} |\begin|
-... your text goes here ...
-\end{document} |\end|
-
-where the class selected is one of the valid classes for LaTeX.
-See |\classes|for details of the various document classes.
-
-You may include other LaTeX commands between the |\documentclass| and the
-\begin{document} commands (i.e., in the `preamble').
-==============================================================================
-22. Table of Contents *latex-toc*
-
- *\tableofcontents*
-A table of contents is produced with the |\tableofcontents| command. You put
-the command right where you want the table of contents to go; LaTeX does the
-rest for you. It produces a heading, but it does not automatically start a new
-page. If you want a new page after the table of contents, include a |\newpage|
-command after the |\tableofcontents| command.
-
- *\listoffigures* *\listoftables*
-There are similar commands |\listoffigures| and |\listoftables| for producing a
-list of figures and a list of tables, respectively. Everything works exactly
-the same as for the table of contents.
-
- *\nofiles*
-NOTE: If you want any of these items to be generated, you cannot have the
-\nofiles command in your document.
-
-|\addcontentsline| Add an entry to table of contents etc.
-|\addtocontents| Add text directly to table of contents file etc.
-
-\addcontentsline{file}{secunit}{entry} *\addcontentsline*
- The |\addcontentsline| command adds an entry to the specified
- list or table where:
-{file} is the extension of the file on which information is to be
- written:
- toc (table of contents),
- lof (list of figures),
- lot (list of tables).
-{secunit} controls the formatting of the entry. It should be one of the
- following, depending upon the value of the file argument:
- toc -- the name of the sectional unit, such as part or
- subsection.
- lof -- figure
- lot -- table
-{entry} is the text of the entry.
-
-\addtocontents{file}{text} *\addtocontents*
- The |\addtocontents| command adds text (or formatting commands)
- directly to the file that generates the table of contents or
- list of figures or tables.
-{file} is the extension of the file on which information is to be written:
- toc (table of contents),
- lof (list of figures),
- lot (list of tables).
-{text} is the information to be written.
-
-==============================================================================
-23. Terminal Input/Output *latex-terminal*
-
-|\typein| Read text from the terminal.
-|\typeout| Write text to the terminal.
-
-\typein[cmd]{msg} *\typein*
- Prints {msg} on the terminal and causes LaTeX to stop and wait
- for you to type a line of input, ending with return. If the
- [cmd] argument is missing, the typed input is processed as if
- it had been included in the input file in place of the
- |\typein| command. If the [cmd] argument is present, it must be
- a command name. This command name is then defined or redefined
- to be the typed input.
-
-\typeout{msg} *\typeout*
- Prints {msg} on the terminal and in the `.log' file. Commands
- in {msg} that are defined with |\newcommand| or |\renewcommand|
- are replaced by their definitions before being printed.
-
- *\space*
-LaTeX's usual rules for treating multiple spaces as a single space and
-ignoring spaces after a command name apply to {msg}. A |\space| command in {msg}
-causes a single space to be printed. A ^^J in {msg} prints a newline.
-
-==============================================================================
-24. Typefaces *latex-typefaces*
-
-The typeface is specified by giving the "size" and "style". A typeface is also
-called a "font".
-|font-styles| Select roman, italics etc.
-|font-size| Select point size.
-|font-lowlevelcommands| Commands for wizards.
-
-Styles *font-styles*
-
-The following type style commands are supported by LaTeX.
-
-These commands are used like: >
- \textit{italics text}.
-The corresponding command in parenthesis is the "declaration form", which
-takes no arguments. The scope of the declaration form lasts until the next
-type style command or the end of the current group.
-
-The declaration forms are cumulative; i.e., you can say: >
- \sffamily\bfseries
-to get sans serif boldface.
-
-You can also use the environment form of the declaration forms; e.g.: >
- \begin{ttfamily}...\end{ttfamily}.
-<
-\textrm (\rmfamily) *\textrm* *\rmfamily*
- Roman
-
-\textit (\itshape) *\textit* *\itshape* *\emph*
- Emphasis (toggles between |\textit| and |\textrm|).
-
-\textmd (\mdseries) *\textmd* *\mdseries*
- Medium weight (default). The opposite of boldface.
-
-\textbf (\bfseries) *\textbf* *\bfseries*
- Boldface.
-
-\textup (\upshape) *\textup* *\upshape*
- Upright (default). The opposite of slanted.
-
-\textsl (\slshape) *\textsl* *\slshape*
- Slanted.
-
-\textsf (\sffamily) *\textsf* *\sffamily*
- Sans serif.
-
-\textsc (\scshape) *\textsc* *\scshape*
- Small caps.
-
-\texttt (\ttfamily) *\texttt* *\ttfamily*
- Typewriter.
-
-\textnormal (\normalfont) *\textnormal* *\normalfont*
- Main document font.
-
-\mathrm *\mathrm*
- Roman, for use in math mode.
-
-\mathbf *\mathbf*
- Boldface, for use in math mode.
-
-\mathsf *\mathsf*
- Sans serif, for use in math mode.
-
-\mathtt *\mathtt*
- Typewriter, for use in math mode.
-
-\mathit *\mathit*
- Italics, for use in math mode, e.g. variable names with
- several letters.
-
-\mathnormal *\mathnormal*
- For use in math mode, e.g. inside another type style
- declaration.
-
-\mathcal *\mathcal*
- `Calligraphic' letters, for use in math mode.
-
- *\mathversion*
-In addition, the command \mathversion{bold} can be used for switching to bold
-letters and symbols in formulas. \mathversion{normal} restores the default.
-
-==========
-Sizes *font-size*
-
-The following standard type size commands are supported by LaTeX.
-
-The commands as listed here are "declaration forms". The scope of the
-declaration form lasts until the next type style command or the end of the
-current group.
-
-You can also use the environment form of these commands; e.g. >
- \begin{tiny}...\end{tiny}
-
-\tiny *\tiny*
-\scriptsize *\scriptsize*
-\footnotesize *\footnotesize*
-\small *\small*
-\normalsize(default) *\normalsize*
-\large *\large*
-\Large *\Large*
-\LARGE *\LARGE*
-\huge *\huge*
-\Huge *\Huge*
-
-==========
-Low-level font commands *font-lowlevelcommands*
-
-These commands are primarily intended for writers of macros and packages. The
-commands listed here are only a subset of the available ones. For full
-details, you should consult Chapter 7 of The LaTeX Companion.
-
-\fontencoding{enc} *\fontencoding*
- Select font encoding. Valid encodings include OT1 and T1.
-
-\fontfamily{family} *\fontfamily*
- Select font family. Valid families include:
- cmr for Computer Modern Roman
- cmss for Computer Modern Sans Serif
- cmtt for Computer Modern Typewriter
- and numerous others.
-
-\fontseries{series} *\fontseries*
- Select font series. Valid series include:
- m Medium (normal)
- b Bold
- c Condensed
- bc Bold condensed
- bx Bold extended
- and various other combinations.
-
-\fontshape{shape} *\fontshape*
- Select font shape. Valid shapes are:
- n Upright (normal)
- it Italic
- sl Slanted (oblique)
- sc Small caps
- ui Upright italics
- ol Outline
- The two last shapes are not available for most font families.
-
-\fontsize{size}{skip} *\fontsize*
- Set font size. The first parameter is the font size to switch
- to; the second is the \baselineskip to use. The unit of both
- parameters defaults to pt. A rule of thumb is that the
- baselineskip should be 1.2 times the font size.
-
-\selectfont *\selectfont*
- The changes made by calling the four font commands described
- above do not come into effect until |\selectfont| is called.
-
-\usefont{enc}{family}{series}{shape} *\usefont*
- Equivalent to calling |\fontencoding|, |\fontfamily|,
- |\fontseries| and |\fontshape| with the given parameters,
- followed by |\selectfont|.
-
-==============================================================================
-25. Parameters *latex-parameters*
-
-The input file specification indicates the file to be formatted; TeX uses
-`.tex' as a default file extension. If you omit the input file entirely, TeX
-accepts input from the terminal. You specify command options by supplying a
-string as a parameter to the command; e.g. >
-
- latex "\scrollmode\input foo.tex"
-
-will process `foo.tex' without pausing after every error.
-
-Output files are always created in the current directory. When you fail to
-specify an input file name, TeX bases the output names on the file
-specification associated with the logical name TEX_OUTPUT, typically
-texput.log.
-
- vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl:
diff --git a/dot_vim/doc/ps_color.txt b/dot_vim/doc/ps_color.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index caf6a4a..0000000
--- a/dot_vim/doc/ps_color.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,585 +0,0 @@
-*ps_color.txt* PSC For Vim version 6.3 Last change: 17 November 2004
-
-
-PERSONAL COLOUR SWITCHER *ps_colour* *pscolor*
-
-
-Author: Pan, Shizhu. <dicpan> at <hotmail o com> >
- (prepend '[VIM]' in the title or your mail may be silently removed.)
-<
-==============================================================================
-CONTENTS *psc* *psc-contents*
-
- 1. Contents.....................|psc-contents|
- 2. PSC Overview.................|psc-overview|
- 3. PSC Installation.............|psc-usage|
- 4. PSC Options..................|psc-options|
- 5. PSC under color term ........|psc-cterm|
- 6. PSC FAQ and Tips ............|psc-faq|
- 7. PSC Release notes............|psc-release-notes|
- 8. PSC Todo List................|psc-todo|
-
-For release notes, please see the header of ps_color.vim
-
-==============================================================================
-PSC FEATURES OVERVIEW *psc-features* *psc-overview*
-
- Features ~
-
- . PSC is firstly a color scheme which have both dark and light
- background styles.
- . It can have the same appearance in [cterm] as in [gui].
- . It is designed with gentle color to minimize fatigue of eye.
- . It also works with other color schemes.
- . Default foreground and background can easily be changed, it is more
- configurable than most other color schemes
- . Works with the optional tool reloaded.vim, can change the whole
- color scheme in Hue,Saturation,Luminance color space.
-
- Design Concern ~
-
- At the first glance this color scheme may look pretty 'dull', don't be
- afraid, this is quite normal. Bear in mind that a text editor is not
- a photo album, if a text editor looks exciting you may not be able to
- stare at it for a long time.
-
- Predefined Vim Syntax highlighting can be too colorful or contrasty so
- that many programmers prefer to switch off the syntax highlighting at
- work. That is not a good idea because you will lost the advantages of
- syntax high-lighting. It is often the case that we have to work for
- 300+ minutes, then I decide to do-it-myself.
-
- Many user-defined color schemes in vim.sf.net tend to achieve low
- contrast by having a strong color-cast, i.e. looks blueish or
- yellowish or reddish. This does look comfortable at first, however,
- any type of color-cast will cause the eyes less sensitive for
- particular color after a long-time work session, and that's no good to
- health.
-
- Efforts had been made to ensure no color-cast for this scheme, all
- elementary colors like RGB and CYMK are evenly used. Like TeX,
- 'consistency' is the principle this color scheme based on. Default
- values which hurt consistency are amended according to the vim script
- syntax/hitest.vim
-
- There are 3 parameters to describe a color: Hue, Saturation and
- Brightness. In this color scheme, the saturation is low and the
- brightness are designed to be very close to each other in order not to
- fatigue our eyes after a whole day's programming work.
-
- Portability ~
-
- Different monitor settings led to different look. In this color
- scheme, it is assumed that the monitor adjust at 6500k color
- temperature with a good gamma curve. If you have a 9300k monitor or
- if the gamma curve is not optimal, the appearance may be less
- comfortable, use adobe gamma loader or similar tools to adjust
- your monitor if your monitor do not have the option to change color
- temperature and/or gamma curve.
-
- Needless to say, VI is an editor originally designed to do edit tasks
- in a text terminal, and VIM is an improved version of VI. Its a shame
- that a color scheme cannot have a satisfactory appearance in cterm.
- The cterm compatibility should be considered high priority when
- designing ViM color scheme.
-
- I had made much attempt to make support for 8-color terminals,
- however, 8 colors is not enough to represent a color scheme. Finally
- I end up making the cterm support for 16-color terminal. Have to say
- sorry if the color scheme sucks in your 8-color terminal, I had tried
- my best. More details about cterm please see |psc-cterm|.
-
- *psc-about-background*
- About the Background ~
-
- We have talked about off-white backgrounds, any background which is
- not black, grey or white should be changed constantly in order not to
- make the eyes less sensitive to particular color. i.e. you can use
- blue background on Monday, red background on Tuesday, green background
- on Wednesday, but if you use blue background everyday, that's no good
- to your health.
-
- Now we talk about the brightness of the background. Why dark
- background is preferred over others? There are many reasons, such as,
- the monitor emits lower radiation for black background. You may have
- lots of similar reasons...
-
- But I'll talk about something you may not know:
->
- It is easier to distinguish foreground colors on a dark background
- than on a light background.
-
- At the same time, it is easier to distinguish background colors on
- a light background than on a dark background.
-
- We will mainly change foreground colors for syntax highlighting.
-<
- Hence, we can reduce the contrast and saturation of the color in
- a dark-background scheme, while retain the readability. Schemes with
- white background usually comes with higher contrast and saturation.
- This is probably the most important reason that the color scheme is
- designed to be dark-background instead of light one.
-
- Now we came to know, that change the foreground color is enough to
- emphasis text in a dark background, while for a white background, we
- need to change the font shape (bold or italic, etc.), or change the
- background color to effectively emphasis the text. This is probably
- the reason Vim default scheme has bold properties for highlighting
- groups, because the default scheme is a light background one.
-
- No one knows what color scheme is best for you, except yourself. Try!
-
-==============================================================================
-PSC INSTALLATION *psc-usage*
-
- Step 1, Enable the color scheme ~
-
- To use PSC is simple, just put ps_color.vim into your
- [runtimepath]/colors and append the line >
-
- colorscheme ps_color
-<
- to your |.vimrc|. The [runtimepath] can be any directory listed in
- |vimfiles|, normally your $HOME/.vim in Unix or $HOME/vimfiles in
- Windows.
-
- Step 2, Install the help document ~
-
- The help document will be automatically installed when the colorscheme
- be sourced the first time. If it is not, type :colo ps_color now.
-
- After successfully installed the help document, you can use >
-
- :help psc-options
-<
- to go to the following section.
-
-==============================================================================
-PSC OPTIONS *psc-options*
-
- You can let these options in your ~/.vimrc, most options works for
- both GUI and cterm, only some of them do not work for both.
-
- Options set using the 'let' command must present [BEFORE] the color
- scheme been sourced.
-
- *psc_style*
- Style ~
->
- let psc_style='cool'
- let psc_style='warm'
- let psc_style='default'
- let psc_style='defdark'
-<
- This selects between styles of colors,
- The 'cool' is the default, dark background.
- The 'warm' is the experimental, light background scheme.
-
- See |psc-about-background| for more knowledge about the background,
- and the differences of two style.
-
- The 'default' and 'defdark' refers to Vim system default color scheme.
- Which are provided only for reference.
-
- Let psc_style to any string other than the above 4 will switch to the
- specified color scheme. For example, let psc_style='desert' and then
- activate the ps_color, the color scheme will be chosen according to
- desert.vim color scheme.
-
- *psc_cterm_style*
- Color Term Style ~
->
- let psc_cterm_style='cool'
-<
- This is exactly the same to psc_style, except that it only affects the
- console version of vim in a color terminal, the 'warm' is not
- available for cterm.
- By default, it will be set to the same value as 'psc_style'. You can
- change it if you want different style in cterm from gui.
-
-
- *psc_fontface*
- Font face ~
->
- let psc_fontface='plain'
- let psc_fontface='mixed'
-<
- The Vim default behavior is the 'mixed', however, the mixed font style
- in a dark colorscheme is not optimal. This color uses 'plain' for
- 'cool' style, i.e. No texts are bolded font. For 'warm', the default
- is still 'mixed', If you want the mixed style in which the highlighted
- statements are bolded font, choose this. If you want all texts be
- bolded, choose 'plain' and specify a bolded guifont or terminal font.
-
- In GUI, this option also works for other color schemes. You can
- disable the bold font and use your favorite color scheme. See
- |psc-faq-ffothers| for detail.
-
- *psc_inversed_todo*
- Inversed Todo ~
->
- let psc_inversed_todo=1
-<
- When set to 1, the TODO group will be dark background with light font,
- Otherwise, the TODO group have light background with dark foreground.
- Default is 0.
-
- *psc_use_default_for_cterm*
- Use default for cterm (obsoleted)~
-
- This option is Obsoleted, retained only for backward compatibility,
- see |psc_cterm_style| for alternative.
-
- *psc_statement_different_from_type*
- Statement different from type ~
->
- let psc_statement_different_from_type=1
-<
- The Statement-group and Type-group are easy to distinguish, different
- color for them are not necessary, I use similar color for S-group
- & T-group in order not to make the screen too 'colorful', also this
- saves a color name for cterm. But if you do want the Statement & Type
- to be different color, try 'let statement_different_from_type=1' in
- your .vimrc file, which is available only for GUI. Since the color
- names in cterm is limited to 16 we cannot have too many different
- colors in cterm.
- Default is 0, i.e. they have very similar color.
-
- *psc-change-background*
- Changing the Background color ~
-
- You may prefer a dark background over pure black one, and it is
- possible to change the background, this may make life more interesting.
- To do this is quite straight forward for GUI, just define the Normal
- highlight in your .gvimrc, [AFTER] the color scheme has been sourced.
-
- For example:
->
- highlight Normal guibg=#103040
-<
- The #103040 will give a taste similar to oceandeep, #152535 for
- hhazure, #303030 for desert, #404040 for zenburn... Replace #103040
- with any color you like. You can do the same to guifg foreground if
- you are careful enough, remember this is only possible with ps_color
- version 2.7 or above, and only possible for GUI.
-
- You can do this to the NonText group also, for example.
->
- highlight NonText guibg=#202020
-<
- will give you a taste similar to most color schemes on vim.sf.net, in
- which the NonText has a different background than Normal text.
- However, this is only useful in GUI, in cterm, there are only
- 8 background colors, so it is wise not to have a different color.
-
- If you want more variations, please try the optional utility
- reloaded.vim, this optional utility provides an amazing level of
- customization.
-
- Quick switching between warm and cold styles ~
-
- Here is an example to define hot key of different style switching,
- note that I had only given this example without actually define it.
- You can choose to define it in .vimrc or anyway you prefer.
->
- nnoremap <Leader>pc :let psc_style='cool'<CR>:colo ps_color<CR>
- nnoremap <Leader>pw :let psc_style='warm'<CR>:colo ps_color<CR>
-<
- Alternatively, you can use the capitalized :Colo command, like
- :Colo cool or :Colo warm
-
-==============================================================================
-PSC WITH CTERM *psc-cterm*
-
- Colour Term ~
-
- The cterm color is designed mainly in these terminals:
->
- 1. Cygwin bash shell in NT command prompt box
- 2. XTERM and RXVT
- 3. Other color terminals which have at least 16 colors
-<
- *psc-cterm-nt*
- In Windows NT Prompt console you can change the exact value of each
- color, so you can have the same color with your GUI version of Vim,
- for 'cool' color style you just change the color according to the
- |psc-cterm-color-table|, for how to redefine the color of Windows NT
- prompt console please see Windows Help.
-
- NT Cygwin bash shell console supports 16 foreground colors by add bold
- attribute to 8 color, the cterm=bold specifies which should be bright
- color, so totally the 16 color foreground is available, but color
- name DarkXXX and LightXXX are the same.
-
- The pre-configured Cygwin.lnk is available for download on my web page
- for Vim, but the site seems down, if my site would be on again, it
- should be at the following URL: >
- http://poet.tomud.com/pub/Cygwin.lnk.gz
-<
- Cygwin is highly recommended for Vim user if you are using Windows NT
- based systems (e.g. NT 4.0, Win2k, WinXP, Win2003, etc). But Cygwin is
- not that versatile under Windows 95/98/ME. I'm not sure whether this
- works for DOS DJGPP or Windows 95 console version of Vim because
- I don't have the system, in case you encountered problem please
- contact me, if you like.
-
- *psc-cterm-xterm*
- XTERM is a much more feature-rich terminal than Windows Console so the
- support is much better, add the following recommend line into your
- .Xdefaults and you can achieve the same color as in GUI version.
-
- Add the following into your .Xdefaults:
- This works for XTERM and RXVT.
->
- XTerm*color0: #000000
- XTerm*color1: #800000
- XTerm*color2: #008000
- XTerm*color3: #d0d090
- XTerm*color4: #000080
- XTerm*color5: #800080
- XTerm*color6: #a6caf0
- XTerm*color7: #d0d0d0
- XTerm*color8: #b0b0b0
- XTerm*color9: #f08060
- XTerm*color10: #60f080
- XTerm*color11: #e0c060
- XTerm*color12: #80c0e0
- XTerm*color13: #f0c0f0
- XTerm*color14: #c0d8f8
- XTerm*color15: #e0e0e0
- XTerm*cursorColor: #00f000
-
- ! The following are recommended but optional
- XTerm*reverseVideo: False
- XTerm*background: #000000
- XTerm*foreground: #d0d0d0
- XTerm*boldMode: False
-<
- There is an assumption that your RXVT or XTERM supports 16 colors,
- most RXVTs and XTERMs support this, if yours do not, get a source of
- RXVT and recompile it.
-
- Sometimes the color mode are not recognized well, or you do not want
- bright foreground be bolded. If this is the case, add the following in
- your .vimrc (before the color scheme been sourced)
->
- if &term=='xterm' " Change 'xterm' to your term name if necessary
- set t_Co=16
- endif
-<
- If the t_Co=16 have problem, set t_Co=8 and :colo ps_color again.
- vice versa.
-
- My rxvt works well with t_Co=16: >
- Rxvt v2.7.10 - released: 26 MARCH 2003
- Options:
- XPM,transparent,utmp,menubar,frills,linespace,multichar_languages,
- scrollbars=rxvt+NeXT+xterm,.Xdefaults
-< But I've know that my rxvt v2.6.4 in another machine has problem with
- t_Co=16, if that is the case, set t_Co=8 instead.
-
- *psc-cterm-others*
- For other terminals, you can manually set the color according to the
- following table
-
- Hints for Manually set the color (for 'cool' style only):
- *psc-cterm-color-table*
- Color name Hex value Decimal value ~
- 0 Black = #000000 0,0,0
- 4 DarkBlue = #000080 0,0,128
- 2 DarkGreen = #008000 0,128,0
- 6 DarkCyan = #a6caf0 166,202,240
- 1 DarkRed = #800000 128,0,0
- 5 DarkMagenta = #800080 128,0,128
- 3 DarkYellow = #d0d090 208,208,144
- 7 Grey = #d0d0d0 208,208,208
- 8 DarkGrey = #b0b0b0 176,176,176
- 12 Blue = #80c0e0 128,192,224
- 10 Green = #60f080 96,240,128
- 14 Cyan = #c0d8f8 192,216,248
- 9 Red = #f08060 240,128,96
- 13 LMag. = #f0c0f0 240,192,240
- 11 Yellow = #e0c060 224,192,96
- 15 White = #e0e0e0 224,224,224
-
- *psc-cterm-incompatible*
- If your color terminal does only have 8 colors and cannot achieve 16
- colors with cterm=bold, you may want to switch to other color schemes
- to gain more readability. Anyway, you can specify in your .vimrc to
- use different color scheme under different consoles and GUI.
- For example:
->
- let psc_cterm_style = 'foobarcolor'
- let psc_style = 'cool'
- colo ps_color
-<
- The 'foobarcolor' means the color scheme you want to choose, such as
- 'desert', I recommend to try vim default schemes 'default' and
- 'defdark' before experience others.
-
-==============================================================================
-PSC FAQ AND TIPS *psc-faq* *psc-tips*
->
- Q: What is meant by `PS' ?
-<
- A: PS means: PostScript, PhotoShop, PerSonal, ... or anything you can
- imagine and anything you want it do be.
->
- Q: How to obtain the same appreance as gui in color term?
-<
- A: This need some work around, see |psc-cterm| for details.
- Generally speaking, you should ensure your color term has support
- for 16 foreground colors, and each color is customizable.
-
- *psc-faq-ffothers* >
- Q: How to use psc_fontface with other colorschemes?
-<
- A: Make sure you had sourced :colo ps_color in your .vimrc, then you
- can use the Capitalized :Colo instead of :colo
- e.g. you want to use 'murphy', just type :Colo murphy after you
- sourced the ps_color, the 'defdark', 'cool', 'warm' can also be
- used here.
->
- Q: I updated from v2.0 to v2.3 or above, why the cterm color scheme
- for Comment is different?
-<
- A: The color map of DarkYellow and Yellow have been exchanged,
- You need to reconfigure your terminal to meet the change,
- see |psc-cterm-color-table| for guide, or if you are using xterm
- compatible terminal, just update the .XDefaults according to
- |psc-cterm-xterm|.
->
- Q: What do you mean by 'Vanilla Windows'?
-<
- A: People often argue that Windows is not a REAL operating system.
- Well, I agree this, but only for vanilla windows. i.e. with no
- plug-ins installed. Vanilla windows is a very limited platform,
- since it is not POSIX compliant.
-
- There are currently many working around to make Windows POSIX
- Compliant, do you still mind which OS to use when it is POSIX
- Compliant? I don't. If you installed Cygwin kernel in your
- NT-based Windows, the Windows will be more or less POSIX compliant
- and you can use it in the same way as you use any Unix, BSD,
- Solaris, Linux, XWindow, etc... What is more, Cygwin is not the
- only kernel which makes Windows POSIX Compliant, make a google
- search and you will find many alternatives.
->
- Q: How to change the Normal background color? Why don't you use
- different background for NonText group?
-<
- A: This is for compatibility, since we have to use only 8 colors as
- background in a color terminal. For GUI you can change this, see
- |psc-change-background| for details.
-
-==============================================================================
-PSC RELEASE NOTES *psc-release-notes*
-
- 2.82 Release Note: ~
-
- Fixed bug with the reversed group for the Vim default, or other
- schemes.
-
- Fixed bug with the Diff mode fg mistaken as fg.
-
- Shrink the script a lot to improve load performance, moved the release
- notes into document.
-
- Change the default gui background color to #202020 (Dark Grey)
-
-
- 2.81 Release Note: ~
-
- Provided a separate utility reloaded.vim to fine tune the GUI color
- scheme based on Hue, Saturation and Brightness(Luminance).
-
- Added some groups to meet the need of reloaded.vim, no essential
- change.
-
- 2.8 Release Note: ~
-
- Bugfix : when psc_style=='mixed', the visual got reversed wrong.
-
- 'mixed' is now the default for 'warm' style.
-
- changed the function name to lower case.
-
- removed pre-2.0 compatibility, (the non-psc version of s-d-f-t).
-
- Added variable psc_cterm_style, see |psc_cterm_style|
-
- Added group Underline
-
- Tuned the function call.
-
- 2.7 Release Note: ~
-
- Now it is possible to change the Background,
- see :h psc-change-background for details.
-
- Linked the Tag group to Identifier.
-
- NonText as Notice is not good for 'warm', changed to Constant.
-
- Added links for the most popular plugins: taglist, calendar
-
- Tuned the 'Statement' color when different from Type (gui only).
-
- Re-adjusted cterm scheme according to syntax/hitest.vim
-
- The 'defdark' style for cterm is not functioning, fixed.
-
- Many 'cosmetic' changes, makes no difference for functionality.
-
- Use of DrChip's help extractor to auto-install help document.
-
- Added command define, :Colo
-
- 2.6 Release Note: ~
-
- As stated in the v2.3, the only 'todo' thing seems to be the 'warm'
- style, now in this version I had been working on it.
-
- There also are some minor fixes for the document, to be more friendly
- for new readers.
-
- The 'StatusLine' of 'cold' style is modified by mistake in the v2.3,
- this time the bug is fixed.
-
- The 'Directory' in GUI 'cold' style is different from 'cterm' one,
- now fixed.
-
- 2.3 Release Note: ~
-
- This is an incompatible update, main changes are in 'cterm'.
- A new group 'SignColumn' had been added, new links added for engspchk
- v52, hundreds of typos fixed in the document, thanks to the engspchk.
-
- The support for 8-color cterm is slightly better now, but the mappings
- of the DarkYellow and Yellow are exchanged, you need to update the
- .Xdefaults or your terminal configuration before apply this update if
- you are using v2.0. Guide for redefinition the color value is
- available in the document, make sure you had updated the ps_color.txt,
- then see |psc-cterm-color-table|
-
- 2.0 Release Note: ~
-
- There've been great enhancement since this version, so I'd choose to
- bump the version number to 2. This version comes with Vim online help,
- if you had installed ps_color.txt, you can see for details in
- |pscolor|
-
- n/a Release: ~
-
- Initial upload, can be called as v1.8
-
-
-==============================================================================
-PSC TODO LIST *psc-todo*
-
- . Fix the remain bugs.
- . Follow the new Vim versions for new added highlighting group
-
-==============================================================================
-
-vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:fo+=t:norl:noet:
diff --git a/dot_vim/doc/taglist.txt b/dot_vim/doc/taglist.txt
deleted file mode 100755
index 6a62b39..0000000
--- a/dot_vim/doc/taglist.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1501 +0,0 @@
-*taglist.txt* Plugin for browsing source code
-
-Author: Yegappan Lakshmanan (yegappan AT yahoo DOT com)
-For Vim version 6.0 and above
-Last change: 2007 May 24
-
-1. Overview |taglist-intro|
-2. Taglist on the internet |taglist-internet|
-3. Requirements |taglist-requirements|
-4. Installation |taglist-install|
-5. Usage |taglist-using|
-6. Options |taglist-options|
-7. Commands |taglist-commands|
-8. Global functions |taglist-functions|
-9. Extending |taglist-extend|
-10. FAQ |taglist-faq|
-11. License |taglist-license|
-12. Todo |taglist-todo|
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-intro*
-1. Overview~
-
-The "Tag List" plugin is a source code browser plugin for Vim. This plugin
-allows you to efficiently browse through source code files for different
-programming languages. The "Tag List" plugin provides the following features:
-
- * Displays the tags (functions, classes, structures, variables, etc.)
- defined in a file in a vertically or horizontally split Vim window.
- * In GUI Vim, optionally displays the tags in the Tags drop-down menu and
- in the popup menu.
- * Automatically updates the taglist window as you switch between
- files/buffers. As you open new files, the tags defined in the new files
- are added to the existing file list and the tags defined in all the
- files are displayed grouped by the filename.
- * When a tag name is selected from the taglist window, positions the
- cursor at the definition of the tag in the source file.
- * Automatically highlights the current tag name.
- * Groups the tags by their type and displays them in a foldable tree.
- * Can display the prototype and scope of a tag.
- * Can optionally display the tag prototype instead of the tag name in the
- taglist window.
- * The tag list can be sorted either by name or by chronological order.
- * Supports the following language files: Assembly, ASP, Awk, Beta, C,
- C++, C#, Cobol, Eiffel, Erlang, Fortran, HTML, Java, Javascript, Lisp,
- Lua, Make, Pascal, Perl, PHP, Python, Rexx, Ruby, Scheme, Shell, Slang,
- SML, Sql, TCL, Verilog, Vim and Yacc.
- * Can be easily extended to support new languages. Support for
- existing languages can be modified easily.
- * Provides functions to display the current tag name in the Vim status
- line or the window title bar.
- * The list of tags and files in the taglist can be saved and
- restored across Vim sessions.
- * Provides commands to get the name and prototype of the current tag.
- * Runs in both console/terminal and GUI versions of Vim.
- * Works with the winmanager plugin. Using the winmanager plugin, you
- can use Vim plugins like the file explorer, buffer explorer and the
- taglist plugin at the same time like an IDE.
- * Can be used in both Unix and MS-Windows systems.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-internet*
-2. Taglist on the internet~
-
-The home page of the taglist plugin is at:
->
- http://vim-taglist.sourceforge.net/
-<
-You can subscribe to the taglist mailing list to post your questions or
-suggestions for improvement or to send bug reports. Visit the following page
-for subscribing to the mailing list:
->
- http://groups.yahoo.com/group/taglist
-<
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-requirements*
-3. Requirements~
-
-The taglist plugin requires the following:
-
- * Vim version 6.0 and above
- * Exuberant ctags 5.0 and above
-
-The taglist plugin will work on all the platforms where the exuberant ctags
-utility and Vim are supported (this includes MS-Windows and Unix based
-systems).
-
-The taglist plugin relies on the exuberant ctags utility to dynamically
-generate the tag listing. The exuberant ctags utility must be installed in
-your system to use this plugin. The exuberant ctags utility is shipped with
-most of the Linux distributions. You can download the exuberant ctags utility
-from
->
- http://ctags.sourceforge.net
-<
-The taglist plugin doesn't use or create a tags file and there is no need to
-create a tags file to use this plugin. The taglist plugin will not work with
-the GNU ctags or the Unix ctags utility.
-
-This plugin relies on the Vim "filetype" detection mechanism to determine the
-type of the current file. You have to turn on the Vim filetype detection by
-adding the following line to your .vimrc file:
->
- filetype on
-<
-The taglist plugin will not work if you run Vim in the restricted mode (using
-the -Z command-line argument).
-
-The taglist plugin uses the Vim system() function to invoke the exuberant
-ctags utility. If Vim is compiled without the system() function then you
-cannot use the taglist plugin. Some of the Linux distributions (Suse) compile
-Vim without the system() function for security reasons.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-install*
-4. Installation~
-
-1. Download the taglist.zip file and unzip the files to the $HOME/.vim or the
- $HOME/vimfiles or the $VIM/vimfiles directory. After this step, you should
- have the following two files (the directory structure should be preserved):
-
- plugin/taglist.vim - main taglist plugin file
- doc/taglist.txt - documentation (help) file
-
- Refer to the |add-plugin|and |'runtimepath'| Vim help pages for more
- details about installing Vim plugins.
-2. Change to the $HOME/.vim/doc or $HOME/vimfiles/doc or $VIM/vimfiles/doc
- directory, start Vim and run the ":helptags ." command to process the
- taglist help file. Without this step, you cannot jump to the taglist help
- topics.
-3. If the exuberant ctags utility is not present in one of the directories in
- the PATH environment variable, then set the 'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd' variable to
- point to the location of the exuberant ctags utility (not to the directory)
- in the .vimrc file.
-4. If you are running a terminal/console version of Vim and the terminal
- doesn't support changing the window width then set the
- 'Tlist_Inc_Winwidth' variable to 0 in the .vimrc file.
-5. Restart Vim.
-6. You can now use the ":TlistToggle" command to open/close the taglist
- window. You can use the ":help taglist" command to get more information
- about using the taglist plugin.
-
-To uninstall the taglist plugin, remove the plugin/taglist.vim and
-doc/taglist.txt files from the $HOME/.vim or $HOME/vimfiles directory.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-using*
-5. Usage~
-
-The taglist plugin can be used in several different ways.
-
-1. You can keep the taglist window open during the entire editing session. On
- opening the taglist window, the tags defined in all the files in the Vim
- buffer list will be displayed in the taglist window. As you edit files, the
- tags defined in them will be added to the taglist window. You can select a
- tag from the taglist window and jump to it. The current tag will be
- highlighted in the taglist window. You can close the taglist window when
- you no longer need the window.
-2. You can configure the taglist plugin to process the tags defined in all the
- edited files always. In this configuration, even if the taglist window is
- closed and the taglist menu is not displayed, the taglist plugin will
- processes the tags defined in newly edited files. You can then open the
- taglist window only when you need to select a tag and then automatically
- close the taglist window after selecting the tag.
-3. You can configure the taglist plugin to display only the tags defined in
- the current file in the taglist window. By default, the taglist plugin
- displays the tags defined in all the files in the Vim buffer list. As you
- switch between files, the taglist window will be refreshed to display only
- the tags defined in the current file.
-4. In GUI Vim, you can use the Tags pull-down and popup menu created by the
- taglist plugin to display the tags defined in the current file and select a
- tag to jump to it. You can use the menu without opening the taglist window.
- By default, the Tags menu is disabled.
-5. You can configure the taglist plugin to display the name of the current tag
- in the Vim window status line or in the Vim window title bar. For this to
- work without the taglist window or menu, you need to configure the taglist
- plugin to process the tags defined in a file always.
-6. You can save the tags defined in multiple files to a taglist session file
- and load it when needed. You can also configure the taglist plugin to not
- update the taglist window when editing new files. You can then manually add
- files to the taglist window.
-
-Opening the taglist window~
-You can open the taglist window using the ":TlistOpen" or the ":TlistToggle"
-commands. The ":TlistOpen" command opens the taglist window and jumps to it.
-The ":TlistToggle" command opens or closes (toggle) the taglist window and the
-cursor remains in the current window. If the 'Tlist_GainFocus_On_ToggleOpen'
-variable is set to 1, then the ":TlistToggle" command opens the taglist window
-and moves the cursor to the taglist window.
-
-You can map a key to invoke these commands. For example, the following command
-creates a normal mode mapping for the <F8> key to toggle the taglist window.
->
- nnoremap <silent> <F8> :TlistToggle<CR>
-<
-Add the above mapping to your ~/.vimrc or $HOME/_vimrc file.
-
-To automatically open the taglist window on Vim startup, set the
-'Tlist_Auto_Open' variable to 1.
-
-You can also open the taglist window on startup using the following command
-line:
->
- $ vim +TlistOpen
-<
-Closing the taglist window~
-You can close the taglist window from the taglist window by pressing 'q' or
-using the Vim ":q" command. You can also use any of the Vim window commands to
-close the taglist window. Invoking the ":TlistToggle" command when the taglist
-window is opened, closes the taglist window. You can also use the
-":TlistClose" command to close the taglist window.
-
-To automatically close the taglist window when a tag or file is selected, you
-can set the 'Tlist_Close_On_Select' variable to 1. To exit Vim when only the
-taglist window is present, set the 'Tlist_Exit_OnlyWindow' variable to 1.
-
-Jumping to a tag or a file~
-You can select a tag in the taglist window either by pressing the <Enter> key
-or by double clicking the tag name using the mouse. To jump to a tag on a
-single mouse click set the 'Tlist_Use_SingleClick' variable to 1.
-
-If the selected file is already opened in a window, then the cursor is moved
-to that window. If the file is not currently opened in a window then the file
-is opened in the window used by the taglist plugin to show the previously
-selected file. If there are no usable windows, then the file is opened in a
-new window. The file is not opened in special windows like the quickfix
-window, preview window and windows containing buffer with the 'buftype' option
-set.
-
-To jump to the tag in a new window, press the 'o' key. To open the file in the
-previous window (Ctrl-W_p) use the 'P' key. You can press the 'p' key to jump
-to the tag but still keep the cursor in the taglist window (preview).
-
-To open the selected file in a tab, use the 't' key. If the file is already
-present in a tab then the cursor is moved to that tab otherwise the file is
-opened in a new tab. To jump to a tag in a new tab press Ctrl-t. The taglist
-window is automatically opened in the newly created tab.
-
-Instead of jumping to a tag, you can open a file by pressing the <Enter> key
-or by double clicking the file name using the mouse.
-
-In the taglist window, you can use the [[ or <Backspace> key to jump to the
-beginning of the previous file. You can use the ]] or <Tab> key to jump to the
-beginning of the next file. When you reach the first or last file, the search
-wraps around and the jumps to the next/previous file.
-
-Highlighting the current tag~
-The taglist plugin automatically highlights the name of the current tag in the
-taglist window. The Vim |CursorHold| autocmd event is used for this. If the
-current tag name is not visible in the taglist window, then the taglist window
-contents are scrolled to make that tag name visible. You can also use the
-":TlistHighlightTag" command to force the highlighting of the current tag.
-
-The tag name is highlighted if no activity is performed for |'updatetime'|
-milliseconds. The default value for this Vim option is 4 seconds. To avoid
-unexpected problems, you should not set the |'updatetime'| option to a very
-low value.
-
-To disable the automatic highlighting of the current tag name in the taglist
-window, set the 'Tlist_Auto_Highlight_Tag' variable to zero.
-
-When entering a Vim buffer/window, the taglist plugin automatically highlights
-the current tag in that buffer/window. If you like to disable the automatic
-highlighting of the current tag when entering a buffer, set the
-'Tlist_Highlight_Tag_On_BufEnter' variable to zero.
-
-Adding files to the taglist~
-When the taglist window is opened, all the files in the Vim buffer list are
-processed and the supported files are added to the taglist. When you edit a
-file in Vim, the taglist plugin automatically processes this file and adds it
-to the taglist. If you close the taglist window, the tag information in the
-taglist is retained.
-
-To process files even when the taglist window is not open, set the
-'Tlist_Process_File_Always' variable to 1.
-
-You can manually add multiple files to the taglist without opening them using
-the ":TlistAddFiles" and the ":TlistAddFilesRecursive" commands.
-
-For example, to add all the C files in the /my/project/dir directory to the
-taglist, you can use the following command:
->
- :TlistAddFiles /my/project/dir/*.c
-<
-Note that when adding several files with a large number of tags or a large
-number of files, it will take several seconds to several minutes for the
-taglist plugin to process all the files. You should not interrupt the taglist
-plugin by pressing <CTRL-C>.
-
-You can recursively add multiple files from a directory tree using the
-":TlistAddFilesRecursive" command:
->
- :TlistAddFilesRecursive /my/project/dir *.c
-<
-This command takes two arguments. The first argument specifies the directory
-from which to recursively add the files. The second optional argument
-specifies the wildcard matching pattern for selecting the files to add. The
-default pattern is * and all the files are added.
-
-Displaying tags for only one file~
-The taglist window displays the tags for all the files in the Vim buffer list
-and all the manually added files. To display the tags for only the current
-active buffer, set the 'Tlist_Show_One_File' variable to 1.
-
-Removing files from the taglist~
-You can remove a file from the taglist window, by pressing the 'd' key when the
-cursor is on one of the tags listed for the file in the taglist window. The
-removed file will no longer be displayed in the taglist window in the current
-Vim session. To again display the tags for the file, open the file in a Vim
-window and then use the ":TlistUpdate" command or use ":TlistAddFiles" command
-to add the file to the taglist.
-
-When a buffer is removed from the Vim buffer list using the ":bdelete" or the
-":bwipeout" command, the taglist is updated to remove the stored information
-for this buffer.
-
-Updating the tags displayed for a file~
-The taglist plugin keeps track of the modification time of a file. When the
-modification time changes (the file is modified), the taglist plugin
-automatically updates the tags listed for that file. The modification time of
-a file is checked when you enter a window containing that file or when you
-load that file.
-
-You can also update or refresh the tags displayed for a file by pressing the
-"u" key in the taglist window. If an existing file is modified, after the file
-is saved, the taglist plugin automatically updates the tags displayed for the
-file.
-
-You can also use the ":TlistUpdate" command to update the tags for the current
-buffer after you made some changes to it. You should save the modified buffer
-before you update the taglist window. Otherwise the listed tags will not
-include the new tags created in the buffer.
-
-If you have deleted the tags displayed for a file in the taglist window using
-the 'd' key, you can again display the tags for that file using the
-":TlistUpdate" command.
-
-Controlling the taglist updates~
-To disable the automatic processing of new files or modified files, you can
-set the 'Tlist_Auto_Update' variable to zero. When this variable is set to
-zero, the taglist is updated only when you use the ":TlistUpdate" command or
-the ":TlistAddFiles" or the ":TlistAddFilesRecursive" commands. You can use
-this option to control which files are added to the taglist.
-
-You can use the ":TlistLock" command to lock the taglist contents. After this
-command is executed, new files are not automatically added to the taglist.
-When the taglist is locked, you can use the ":TlistUpdate" command to add the
-current file or the ":TlistAddFiles" or ":TlistAddFilesRecursive" commands to
-add new files to the taglist. To unlock the taglist, use the ":TlistUnlock"
-command.
-
-Displaying the tag prototype~
-To display the prototype of the tag under the cursor in the taglist window,
-press the space bar. If you place the cursor on a tag name in the taglist
-window, then the tag prototype is displayed at the Vim status line after
-|'updatetime'| milliseconds. The default value for the |'updatetime'| Vim
-option is 4 seconds.
-
-You can get the name and prototype of a tag without opening the taglist window
-and the taglist menu using the ":TlistShowTag" and the ":TlistShowPrototype"
-commands. These commands will work only if the current file is already present
-in the taglist. To use these commands without opening the taglist window, set
-the 'Tlist_Process_File_Always' variable to 1.
-
-You can use the ":TlistShowTag" command to display the name of the tag at or
-before the specified line number in the specified file. If the file name and
-line number are not supplied, then this command will display the name of the
-current tag. For example,
->
- :TlistShowTag
- :TlistShowTag myfile.java 100
-<
-You can use the ":TlistShowPrototype" command to display the prototype of the
-tag at or before the specified line number in the specified file. If the file
-name and the line number are not supplied, then this command will display the
-prototype of the current tag. For example,
->
- :TlistShowPrototype
- :TlistShowPrototype myfile.c 50
-<
-In the taglist window, when the mouse is moved over a tag name, the tag
-prototype is displayed in a balloon. This works only in GUI versions where
-balloon evaluation is supported.
-
-Taglist window contents~
-The taglist window contains the tags defined in various files in the taglist
-grouped by the filename and by the tag type (variable, function, class, etc.).
-For tags with scope information (like class members, structures inside
-structures, etc.), the scope information is displayed in square brackets "[]"
-after the tag name.
-
-The contents of the taglist buffer/window are managed by the taglist plugin.
-The |'filetype'| for the taglist buffer is set to 'taglist'. The Vim
-|'modifiable'| option is turned off for the taglist buffer. You should not
-manually edit the taglist buffer, by setting the |'modifiable'| flag. If you
-manually edit the taglist buffer contents, then the taglist plugin will be out
-of sync with the taglist buffer contents and the plugin will no longer work
-correctly. To redisplay the taglist buffer contents again, close the taglist
-window and reopen it.
-
-Opening and closing the tag and file tree~
-In the taglist window, the tag names are displayed as a foldable tree using
-the Vim folding support. You can collapse the tree using the '-' key or using
-the Vim |zc| fold command. You can open the tree using the '+' key or using
-the Vim |zo| fold command. You can open all the folds using the '*' key or
-using the Vim |zR| fold command. You can also use the mouse to open/close the
-folds. You can close all the folds using the '=' key. You should not manually
-create or delete the folds in the taglist window.
-
-To automatically close the fold for the inactive files/buffers and open only
-the fold for the current buffer in the taglist window, set the
-'Tlist_File_Fold_Auto_Close' variable to 1.
-
-Sorting the tags for a file~
-The tags displayed in the taglist window can be sorted either by their name or
-by their chronological order. The default sorting method is by the order in
-which the tags appear in a file. You can change the default sort method by
-setting the 'Tlist_Sort_Type' variable to either "name" or "order". You can
-sort the tags by their name by pressing the "s" key in the taglist window. You
-can again sort the tags by their chronological order using the "s" key. Each
-file in the taglist window can be sorted using different order.
-
-Zooming in and out of the taglist window~
-You can press the 'x' key in the taglist window to maximize the taglist
-window width/height. The window will be maximized to the maximum possible
-width/height without closing the other existing windows. You can again press
-'x' to restore the taglist window to the default width/height.
-
- *taglist-session*
-Taglist Session~
-A taglist session refers to the group of files and their tags stored in the
-taglist in a Vim session.
-
-You can save and restore a taglist session (and all the displayed tags) using
-the ":TlistSessionSave" and ":TlistSessionLoad" commands.
-
-To save the information about the tags and files in the taglist to a file, use
-the ":TlistSessionSave" command and specify the filename:
->
- :TlistSessionSave <file name>
-<
-To load a saved taglist session, use the ":TlistSessionLoad" command: >
-
- :TlistSessionLoad <file name>
-<
-When you load a taglist session file, the tags stored in the file will be
-added to the tags already stored in the taglist.
-
-The taglist session feature can be used to save the tags for large files or a
-group of frequently used files (like a project). By using the taglist session
-file, you can minimize the amount to time it takes to load/refresh the taglist
-for multiple files.
-
-You can create more than one taglist session file for multiple groups of
-files.
-
-Displaying the tag name in the Vim status line or the window title bar~
-You can use the Tlist_Get_Tagname_By_Line() function provided by the taglist
-plugin to display the current tag name in the Vim status line or the window
-title bar. Similarly, you can use the Tlist_Get_Tag_Prototype_By_Line()
-function to display the current tag prototype in the Vim status line or the
-window title bar.
-
-For example, the following command can be used to display the current tag name
-in the status line:
->
- :set statusline=%<%f%=%([%{Tlist_Get_Tagname_By_Line()}]%)
-<
-The following command can be used to display the current tag name in the
-window title bar:
->
- :set title titlestring=%<%f\ %([%{Tlist_Get_Tagname_By_Line()}]%)
-<
-Note that the current tag name can be displayed only after the file is
-processed by the taglist plugin. For this, you have to either set the
-'Tlist_Process_File_Always' variable to 1 or open the taglist window or use
-the taglist menu. For more information about configuring the Vim status line,
-refer to the documentation for the Vim |'statusline'| option.
-
-Changing the taglist window highlighting~
-The following Vim highlight groups are defined and used to highlight the
-various entities in the taglist window:
-
- TagListTagName - Used for tag names
- TagListTagScope - Used for tag scope
- TagListTitle - Used for tag titles
- TagListComment - Used for comments
- TagListFileName - Used for filenames
-
-By default, these highlight groups are linked to the standard Vim highlight
-groups. If you want to change the colors used for these highlight groups,
-prefix the highlight group name with 'My' and define it in your .vimrc or
-.gvimrc file: MyTagListTagName, MyTagListTagScope, MyTagListTitle,
-MyTagListComment and MyTagListFileName. For example, to change the colors
-used for tag names, you can use the following command:
->
- :highlight MyTagListTagName guifg=blue ctermfg=blue
-<
-Controlling the taglist window~
-To use a horizontally split taglist window, instead of a vertically split
-window, set the 'Tlist_Use_Horiz_Window' variable to 1.
-
-To use a vertically split taglist window on the rightmost side of the Vim
-window, set the 'Tlist_Use_Right_Window' variable to 1.
-
-You can specify the width of the vertically split taglist window, by setting
-the 'Tlist_WinWidth' variable. You can specify the height of the horizontally
-split taglist window, by setting the 'Tlist_WinHeight' variable.
-
-When opening a vertically split taglist window, the Vim window width is
-increased to accommodate the new taglist window. When the taglist window is
-closed, the Vim window is reduced. To disable this, set the
-'Tlist_Inc_Winwidth' variable to zero.
-
-To reduce the number of empty lines in the taglist window, set the
-'Tlist_Compact_Format' variable to 1.
-
-To not display the Vim fold column in the taglist window, set the
-'Tlist_Enable_Fold_Column' variable to zero.
-
-To display the tag prototypes instead of the tag names in the taglist window,
-set the 'Tlist_Display_Prototype' variable to 1.
-
-To not display the scope of the tags next to the tag names, set the
-'Tlist_Display_Tag_Scope' variable to zero.
-
- *taglist-keys*
-Taglist window key list~
-The following table lists the description of the keys that can be used
-in the taglist window.
-
- Key Description~
-
- <CR> Jump to the location where the tag under cursor is
- defined.
- o Jump to the location where the tag under cursor is
- defined in a new window.
- P Jump to the tag in the previous (Ctrl-W_p) window.
- p Display the tag definition in the file window and
- keep the cursor in the taglist window itself.
- t Jump to the tag in a new tab. If the file is already
- opened in a tab, move to that tab.
- Ctrl-t Jump to the tag in a new tab.
- <Space> Display the prototype of the tag under the cursor.
- For file names, display the full path to the file,
- file type and the number of tags. For tag types, display the
- tag type and the number of tags.
- u Update the tags listed in the taglist window
- s Change the sort order of the tags (by name or by order)
- d Remove the tags for the file under the cursor
- x Zoom-in or Zoom-out the taglist window
- + Open a fold
- - Close a fold
- * Open all folds
- = Close all folds
- [[ Jump to the beginning of the previous file
- <Backspace> Jump to the beginning of the previous file
- ]] Jump to the beginning of the next file
- <Tab> Jump to the beginning of the next file
- q Close the taglist window
- <F1> Display help
-
-The above keys will work in both the normal mode and the insert mode.
-
- *taglist-menu*
-Taglist menu~
-When using GUI Vim, the taglist plugin can display the tags defined in the
-current file in the drop-down menu and the popup menu. By default, this
-feature is turned off. To turn on this feature, set the 'Tlist_Show_Menu'
-variable to 1.
-
-You can jump to a tag by selecting the tag name from the menu. You can use the
-taglist menu independent of the taglist window i.e. you don't need to open the
-taglist window to get the taglist menu.
-
-When you switch between files/buffers, the taglist menu is automatically
-updated to display the tags defined in the current file/buffer.
-
-The tags are grouped by their type (variables, functions, classes, methods,
-etc.) and displayed as a separate sub-menu for each type. If all the tags
-defined in a file are of the same type (e.g. functions), then the sub-menu is
-not used.
-
-If the number of items in a tag type submenu exceeds the value specified by
-the 'Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items' variable, then the submenu will be split into
-multiple submenus. The default setting for 'Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items' is 25.
-The first and last tag names in the submenu are used to form the submenu name.
-The menu items are prefixed by alpha-numeric characters for easy selection by
-keyboard.
-
-If the popup menu support is enabled (the |'mousemodel'| option contains
-"popup"), then the tags menu is added to the popup menu. You can access
-the popup menu by right clicking on the GUI window.
-
-You can regenerate the tags menu by selecting the 'Tags->Refresh menu' entry.
-You can sort the tags listed in the menu either by name or by order by
-selecting the 'Tags->Sort menu by->Name/Order' menu entry.
-
-You can tear-off the Tags menu and keep it on the side of the Vim window
-for quickly locating the tags.
-
-Using the taglist plugin with the winmanager plugin~
-You can use the taglist plugin with the winmanager plugin. This will allow you
-to use the file explorer, buffer explorer and the taglist plugin at the same
-time in different windows. To use the taglist plugin with the winmanager
-plugin, set 'TagList' in the 'winManagerWindowLayout' variable. For example,
-to use the file explorer plugin and the taglist plugin at the same time, use
-the following setting: >
-
- let winManagerWindowLayout = 'FileExplorer|TagList'
-<
-Getting help~
-If you have installed the taglist help file (this file), then you can use the
-Vim ":help taglist-<keyword>" command to get help on the various taglist
-topics.
-
-You can press the <F1> key in the taglist window to display the help
-information about using the taglist window. If you again press the <F1> key,
-the help information is removed from the taglist window.
-
- *taglist-debug*
-Debugging the taglist plugin~
-You can use the ":TlistDebug" command to enable logging of the debug messages
-from the taglist plugin. To display the logged debug messages, you can use the
-":TlistMessages" command. To disable the logging of the debug messages, use
-the ":TlistUndebug" command.
-
-You can specify a file name to the ":TlistDebug" command to log the debug
-messages to a file. Otherwise, the debug messages are stored in a script-local
-variable. In the later case, to minimize memory usage, only the last 3000
-characters from the debug messages are stored.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-options*
-6. Options~
-
-A number of Vim variables control the behavior of the taglist plugin. These
-variables are initialized to a default value. By changing these variables you
-can change the behavior of the taglist plugin. You need to change these
-settings only if you want to change the behavior of the taglist plugin. You
-should use the |:let| command in your .vimrc file to change the setting of any
-of these variables.
-
-The configurable taglist variables are listed below. For a detailed
-description of these variables refer to the text below this table.
-
-|'Tlist_Auto_Highlight_Tag'| Automatically highlight the current tag in the
- taglist.
-|'Tlist_Auto_Open'| Open the taglist window when Vim starts.
-|'Tlist_Auto_Update'| Automatically update the taglist to include
- newly edited files.
-|'Tlist_Close_On_Select'| Close the taglist window when a file or tag is
- selected.
-|'Tlist_Compact_Format'| Remove extra information and blank lines from
- the taglist window.
-|'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd'| Specifies the path to the ctags utility.
-|'Tlist_Display_Prototype'| Show prototypes and not tags in the taglist
- window.
-|'Tlist_Display_Tag_Scope'| Show tag scope next to the tag name.
-|'Tlist_Enable_Fold_Column'| Show the fold indicator column in the taglist
- window.
-|'Tlist_Exit_OnlyWindow'| Close Vim if the taglist is the only window.
-|'Tlist_File_Fold_Auto_Close'| Close tag folds for inactive buffers.
-|'Tlist_GainFocus_On_ToggleOpen'|
- Jump to taglist window on open.
-|'Tlist_Highlight_Tag_On_BufEnter'|
- On entering a buffer, automatically highlight
- the current tag.
-|'Tlist_Inc_Winwidth'| Increase the Vim window width to accommodate
- the taglist window.
-|'Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items'| Maximum number of items in a tags sub-menu.
-|'Tlist_Max_Tag_Length'| Maximum tag length used in a tag menu entry.
-|'Tlist_Process_File_Always'| Process files even when the taglist window is
- closed.
-|'Tlist_Show_Menu'| Display the tags menu.
-|'Tlist_Show_One_File'| Show tags for the current buffer only.
-|'Tlist_Sort_Type'| Sort method used for arranging the tags.
-|'Tlist_Use_Horiz_Window'| Use a horizontally split window for the
- taglist window.
-|'Tlist_Use_Right_Window'| Place the taglist window on the right side.
-|'Tlist_Use_SingleClick'| Single click on a tag jumps to it.
-|'Tlist_WinHeight'| Horizontally split taglist window height.
-|'Tlist_WinWidth'| Vertically split taglist window width.
-
- *'Tlist_Auto_Highlight_Tag'*
-Tlist_Auto_Highlight_Tag~
-The taglist plugin will automatically highlight the current tag in the taglist
-window. If you want to disable this, then you can set the
-'Tlist_Auto_Highlight_Tag' variable to zero. Note that even though the current
-tag highlighting is disabled, the tags for a new file will still be added to
-the taglist window.
->
- let Tlist_Auto_Highlight_Tag = 0
-<
-With the above variable set to 1, you can use the ":TlistHighlightTag" command
-to highlight the current tag.
-
- *'Tlist_Auto_Open'*
-Tlist_Auto_Open~
-To automatically open the taglist window, when you start Vim, you can set the
-'Tlist_Auto_Open' variable to 1. By default, this variable is set to zero and
-the taglist window will not be opened automatically on Vim startup.
->
- let Tlist_Auto_Open = 1
-<
-The taglist window is opened only when a supported type of file is opened on
-Vim startup. For example, if you open text files, then the taglist window will
-not be opened.
-
- *'Tlist_Auto_Update'*
-Tlist_Auto_Update~
-When a new file is edited, the tags defined in the file are automatically
-processed and added to the taglist. To stop adding new files to the taglist,
-set the 'Tlist_Auto_Update' variable to zero. By default, this variable is set
-to 1.
->
- let Tlist_Auto_Update = 0
-<
-With the above variable set to 1, you can use the ":TlistUpdate" command to
-add the tags defined in the current file to the taglist.
-
- *'Tlist_Close_On_Select'*
-Tlist_Close_On_Select~
-If you want to close the taglist window when a file or tag is selected, then
-set the 'Tlist_Close_On_Select' variable to 1. By default, this variable is
-set zero and when you select a tag or file from the taglist window, the window
-is not closed.
->
- let Tlist_Close_On_Select = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_Compact_Format'*
-Tlist_Compact_Format~
-By default, empty lines are used to separate different tag types displayed for
-a file and the tags displayed for different files in the taglist window. If
-you want to display as many tags as possible in the taglist window, you can
-set the 'Tlist_Compact_Format' variable to 1 to get a compact display.
->
- let Tlist_Compact_Format = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd'*
-Tlist_Ctags_Cmd~
-The 'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd' variable specifies the location (path) of the exuberant
-ctags utility. If exuberant ctags is present in any one of the directories in
-the PATH environment variable, then there is no need to set this variable.
-
-The exuberant ctags tool can be installed under different names. When the
-taglist plugin starts up, if the 'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd' variable is not set, it
-checks for the names exuberant-ctags, exctags, ctags, ctags.exe and tags in
-the PATH environment variable. If any one of the named executable is found,
-then the Tlist_Ctags_Cmd variable is set to that name.
-
-If exuberant ctags is not present in one of the directories specified in the
-PATH environment variable, then set this variable to point to the location of
-the ctags utility in your system. Note that this variable should point to the
-fully qualified exuberant ctags location and NOT to the directory in which
-exuberant ctags is installed. If the exuberant ctags tool is not found in
-either PATH or in the specified location, then the taglist plugin will not be
-loaded. Examples:
->
- let Tlist_Ctags_Cmd = 'd:\tools\ctags.exe'
- let Tlist_Ctags_Cmd = '/usr/local/bin/ctags'
-<
- *'Tlist_Display_Prototype'*
-Tlist_Display_Prototype~
-By default, only the tag name will be displayed in the taglist window. If you
-like to see tag prototypes instead of names, set the 'Tlist_Display_Prototype'
-variable to 1. By default, this variable is set to zero and only tag names
-will be displayed.
->
- let Tlist_Display_Prototype = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_Display_Tag_Scope'*
-Tlist_Display_Tag_Scope~
-By default, the scope of a tag (like a C++ class) will be displayed in
-square brackets next to the tag name. If you don't want the tag scopes
-to be displayed, then set the 'Tlist_Display_Tag_Scope' to zero. By default,
-this variable is set to 1 and the tag scopes will be displayed.
->
- let Tlist_Display_Tag_Scope = 0
-<
- *'Tlist_Enable_Fold_Column'*
-Tlist_Enable_Fold_Column~
-By default, the Vim fold column is enabled and displayed in the taglist
-window. If you wish to disable this (for example, when you are working with a
-narrow Vim window or terminal), you can set the 'Tlist_Enable_Fold_Column'
-variable to zero.
->
- let Tlist_Enable_Fold_Column = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_Exit_OnlyWindow'*
-Tlist_Exit_OnlyWindow~
-If you want to exit Vim if only the taglist window is currently opened, then
-set the 'Tlist_Exit_OnlyWindow' variable to 1. By default, this variable is
-set to zero and the Vim instance will not be closed if only the taglist window
-is present.
->
- let Tlist_Exit_OnlyWindow = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_File_Fold_Auto_Close'*
-Tlist_File_Fold_Auto_Close~
-By default, the tags tree displayed in the taglist window for all the files is
-opened. You can close/fold the tags tree for the files manually. To
-automatically close the tags tree for inactive files, you can set the
-'Tlist_File_Fold_Auto_Close' variable to 1. When this variable is set to 1,
-the tags tree for the current buffer is automatically opened and for all the
-other buffers is closed.
->
- let Tlist_File_Fold_Auto_Close = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_GainFocus_On_ToggleOpen'*
-Tlist_GainFocus_On_ToggleOpen~
-When the taglist window is opened using the ':TlistToggle' command, this
-option controls whether the cursor is moved to the taglist window or remains
-in the current window. By default, this option is set to 0 and the cursor
-remains in the current window. When this variable is set to 1, the cursor
-moves to the taglist window after opening the taglist window.
->
- let Tlist_GainFocus_On_ToggleOpen = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_Highlight_Tag_On_BufEnter'*
-Tlist_Highlight_Tag_On_BufEnter~
-When you enter a Vim buffer/window, the current tag in that buffer/window is
-automatically highlighted in the taglist window. If the current tag name is
-not visible in the taglist window, then the taglist window contents are
-scrolled to make that tag name visible. If you like to disable the automatic
-highlighting of the current tag when entering a buffer, you can set the
-'Tlist_Highlight_Tag_On_BufEnter' variable to zero. The default setting for
-this variable is 1.
->
- let Tlist_Highlight_Tag_On_BufEnter = 0
-<
- *'Tlist_Inc_Winwidth'*
-Tlist_Inc_Winwidth~
-By default, when the width of the window is less than 100 and a new taglist
-window is opened vertically, then the window width is increased by the value
-set in the 'Tlist_WinWidth' variable to accommodate the new window. The value
-of this variable is used only if you are using a vertically split taglist
-window.
-
-If your terminal doesn't support changing the window width from Vim (older
-version of xterm running in a Unix system) or if you see any weird problems in
-the screen due to the change in the window width or if you prefer not to
-adjust the window width then set the 'Tlist_Inc_Winwidth' variable to zero.
-CAUTION: If you are using the MS-Windows version of Vim in a MS-DOS command
-window then you must set this variable to zero, otherwise the system may hang
-due to a Vim limitation (explained in :help win32-problems)
->
- let Tlist_Inc_Winwidth = 0
-<
- *'Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items'*
-Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items~
-If a file contains too many tags of a particular type (function, variable,
-class, etc.), greater than that specified by the 'Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items'
-variable, then the menu for that tag type will be split into multiple
-sub-menus. The default setting for the 'Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items' variable is
-25. This can be changed by setting the 'Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items' variable:
->
- let Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items = 20
-<
-The name of the submenu is formed using the names of the first and the last
-tag entries in that submenu.
-
- *'Tlist_Max_Tag_Length'*
-Tlist_Max_Tag_Length~
-Only the first 'Tlist_Max_Tag_Length' characters from the tag names will be
-used to form the tag type submenu name. The default value for this variable is
-10. Change the 'Tlist_Max_Tag_Length' setting if you want to include more or
-less characters:
->
- let Tlist_Max_Tag_Length = 10
-<
- *'Tlist_Process_File_Always'*
-Tlist_Process_File_Always~
-By default, the taglist plugin will generate and process the tags defined in
-the newly opened files only when the taglist window is opened or when the
-taglist menu is enabled. When the taglist window is closed, the taglist plugin
-will stop processing the tags for newly opened files.
-
-You can set the 'Tlist_Process_File_Always' variable to 1 to generate the list
-of tags for new files even when the taglist window is closed and the taglist
-menu is disabled.
->
- let Tlist_Process_File_Always = 1
-<
-To use the ":TlistShowTag" and the ":TlistShowPrototype" commands without the
-taglist window and the taglist menu, you should set this variable to 1.
-
- *'Tlist_Show_Menu'*
-Tlist_Show_Menu~
-When using GUI Vim, you can display the tags defined in the current file in a
-menu named "Tags". By default, this feature is turned off. To turn on this
-feature, set the 'Tlist_Show_Menu' variable to 1:
->
- let Tlist_Show_Menu = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_Show_One_File'*
-Tlist_Show_One_File~
-By default, the taglist plugin will display the tags defined in all the loaded
-buffers in the taglist window. If you prefer to display the tags defined only
-in the current buffer, then you can set the 'Tlist_Show_One_File' to 1. When
-this variable is set to 1, as you switch between buffers, the taglist window
-will be refreshed to display the tags for the current buffer and the tags for
-the previous buffer will be removed.
->
- let Tlist_Show_One_File = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_Sort_Type'*
-Tlist_Sort_Type~
-The 'Tlist_Sort_Type' variable specifies the sort order for the tags in the
-taglist window. The tags can be sorted either alphabetically by their name or
-by the order of their appearance in the file (chronological order). By
-default, the tag names will be listed by the order in which they are defined
-in the file. You can change the sort type (from name to order or from order to
-name) by pressing the "s" key in the taglist window. You can also change the
-default sort order by setting 'Tlist_Sort_Type' to "name" or "order":
->
- let Tlist_Sort_Type = "name"
-<
- *'Tlist_Use_Horiz_Window'*
-Tlist_Use_Horiz_Window~
-Be default, the tag names are displayed in a vertically split window. If you
-prefer a horizontally split window, then set the 'Tlist_Use_Horiz_Window'
-variable to 1. If you are running MS-Windows version of Vim in a MS-DOS
-command window, then you should use a horizontally split window instead of a
-vertically split window. Also, if you are using an older version of xterm in a
-Unix system that doesn't support changing the xterm window width, you should
-use a horizontally split window.
->
- let Tlist_Use_Horiz_Window = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_Use_Right_Window'*
-Tlist_Use_Right_Window~
-By default, the vertically split taglist window will appear on the left hand
-side. If you prefer to open the window on the right hand side, you can set the
-'Tlist_Use_Right_Window' variable to 1:
->
- let Tlist_Use_Right_Window = 1
-<
- *'Tlist_Use_SingleClick'*
-Tlist_Use_SingleClick~
-By default, when you double click on the tag name using the left mouse
-button, the cursor will be positioned at the definition of the tag. You
-can set the 'Tlist_Use_SingleClick' variable to 1 to jump to a tag when
-you single click on the tag name using the mouse. By default this variable
-is set to zero.
->
- let Tlist_Use_SingleClick = 1
-<
-Due to a bug in Vim, if you set 'Tlist_Use_SingleClick' to 1 and try to resize
-the taglist window using the mouse, then Vim will crash. This problem is fixed
-in Vim 6.3 and above. In the meantime, instead of resizing the taglist window
-using the mouse, you can use normal Vim window resizing commands to resize the
-taglist window.
-
- *'Tlist_WinHeight'*
-Tlist_WinHeight~
-The default height of the horizontally split taglist window is 10. This can be
-changed by modifying the 'Tlist_WinHeight' variable:
->
- let Tlist_WinHeight = 20
-<
-The |'winfixheight'| option is set for the taglist window, to maintain the
-height of the taglist window, when new Vim windows are opened and existing
-windows are closed.
-
- *'Tlist_WinWidth'*
-Tlist_WinWidth~
-The default width of the vertically split taglist window is 30. This can be
-changed by modifying the 'Tlist_WinWidth' variable:
->
- let Tlist_WinWidth = 20
-<
-Note that the value of the |'winwidth'| option setting determines the minimum
-width of the current window. If you set the 'Tlist_WinWidth' variable to a
-value less than that of the |'winwidth'| option setting, then Vim will use the
-value of the |'winwidth'| option.
-
-When new Vim windows are opened and existing windows are closed, the taglist
-plugin will try to maintain the width of the taglist window to the size
-specified by the 'Tlist_WinWidth' variable.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-commands*
-7. Commands~
-
-The taglist plugin provides the following ex-mode commands:
-
-|:TlistAddFiles| Add multiple files to the taglist.
-|:TlistAddFilesRecursive|
- Add files recursively to the taglist.
-|:TlistClose| Close the taglist window.
-|:TlistDebug| Start logging of taglist debug messages.
-|:TlistLock| Stop adding new files to the taglist.
-|:TlistMessages| Display the logged taglist plugin debug messages.
-|:TlistOpen| Open and jump to the taglist window.
-|:TlistSessionSave| Save the information about files and tags in the
- taglist to a session file.
-|:TlistSessionLoad| Load the information about files and tags stored
- in a session file to taglist.
-|:TlistShowPrototype| Display the prototype of the tag at or before the
- specified line number.
-|:TlistShowTag| Display the name of the tag defined at or before the
- specified line number.
-|:TlistHighlightTag| Highlight the current tag in the taglist window.
-|:TlistToggle| Open or close (toggle) the taglist window.
-|:TlistUndebug| Stop logging of taglist debug messages.
-|:TlistUnlock| Start adding new files to the taglist.
-|:TlistUpdate| Update the tags for the current buffer.
-
- *:TlistAddFiles*
-:TlistAddFiles {file(s)} [file(s) ...]
- Add one or more specified files to the taglist. You can
- specify multiple filenames using wildcards. To specify a
- file name with space character, you should escape the space
- character with a backslash.
- Examples:
->
- :TlistAddFiles *.c *.cpp
- :TlistAddFiles file1.html file2.html
-<
- If you specify a large number of files, then it will take some
- time for the taglist plugin to process all of them. The
- specified files will not be edited in a Vim window and will
- not be added to the Vim buffer list.
-
- *:TlistAddFilesRecursive*
-:TlistAddFilesRecursive {directory} [ {pattern} ]
- Add files matching {pattern} recursively from the specified
- {directory} to the taglist. If {pattern} is not specified,
- then '*' is assumed. To specify the current directory, use "."
- for {directory}. To specify a directory name with space
- character, you should escape the space character with a
- backslash.
- Examples:
->
- :TlistAddFilesRecursive myproject *.java
- :TlistAddFilesRecursive smallproject
-<
- If large number of files are present in the specified
- directory tree, then it will take some time for the taglist
- plugin to process all of them.
-
- *:TlistClose*
-:TlistClose Close the taglist window. This command can be used from any
- one of the Vim windows.
-
- *:TlistDebug*
-:TlistDebug [filename]
- Start logging of debug messages from the taglist plugin.
- If {filename} is specified, then the debug messages are stored
- in the specified file. Otherwise, the debug messages are
- stored in a script local variable. If the file {filename} is
- already present, then it is overwritten.
-
- *:TlistLock*
-:TlistLock
- Lock the taglist and don't process new files. After this
- command is executed, newly edited files will not be added to
- the taglist.
-
- *:TlistMessages*
-:TlistMessages
- Display the logged debug messages from the taglist plugin
- in a window. This command works only when logging to a
- script-local variable.
-
- *:TlistOpen*
-:TlistOpen Open and jump to the taglist window. Creates the taglist
- window, if the window is not opened currently. After executing
- this command, the cursor is moved to the taglist window. When
- the taglist window is opened for the first time, all the files
- in the buffer list are processed and the tags defined in them
- are displayed in the taglist window.
-
- *:TlistSessionSave*
-:TlistSessionSave {filename}
- Saves the information about files and tags in the taglist to
- the specified file. This command can be used to save and
- restore the taglist contents across Vim sessions.
-
- *:TlistSessionLoad*
-:TlistSessionLoad {filename}
- Load the information about files and tags stored in the
- specified session file to the taglist.
-
- *:TlistShowPrototype*
-:TlistShowPrototype [filename] [linenumber]
- Display the prototype of the tag at or before the specified
- line number. If the file name and the line number are not
- specified, then the current file name and line number are
- used. A tag spans multiple lines starting from the line where
- it is defined to the line before the next tag. This command
- displays the prototype for the tag for any line number in this
- range.
-
- *:TlistShowTag*
-:TlistShowTag [filename] [linenumber]
- Display the name of the tag defined at or before the specified
- line number. If the file name and the line number are not
- specified, then the current file name and line number are
- used. A tag spans multiple lines starting from the line where
- it is defined to the line before the next tag. This command
- displays the tag name for any line number in this range.
-
- *:TlistHighlightTag*
-:TlistHighlightTag
- Highlight the current tag in the taglist window. By default,
- the taglist plugin periodically updates the taglist window to
- highlight the current tag. This command can be used to force
- the taglist plugin to highlight the current tag.
-
- *:TlistToggle*
-:TlistToggle Open or close (toggle) the taglist window. Opens the taglist
- window, if the window is not opened currently. Closes the
- taglist window, if the taglist window is already opened. When
- the taglist window is opened for the first time, all the files
- in the buffer list are processed and the tags are displayed in
- the taglist window. After executing this command, the cursor
- is not moved from the current window to the taglist window.
-
- *:TlistUndebug*
-:TlistUndebug
- Stop logging of debug messages from the taglist plugin.
-
- *:TlistUnlock*
-:TlistUnlock
- Unlock the taglist and start processing newly edited files.
-
- *:TlistUpdate*
-:TlistUpdate Update the tags information for the current buffer. This
- command can be used to re-process the current file/buffer and
- get the tags information. As the taglist plugin uses the file
- saved in the disk (instead of the file displayed in a Vim
- buffer), you should save a modified buffer before you update
- the taglist. Otherwise the listed tags will not include the
- new tags created in the buffer. You can use this command even
- when the taglist window is not opened.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-functions*
-8. Global functions~
-
-The taglist plugin provides several global functions that can be used from
-other Vim plugins to interact with the taglist plugin. These functions are
-described below.
-
-|Tlist_Update_File_Tags()| Update the tags for the specified file
-|Tlist_Get_Tag_Prototype_By_Line()| Return the prototype of the tag at or
- before the specified line number in the
- specified file.
-|Tlist_Get_Tagname_By_Line()| Return the name of the tag at or
- before the specified line number in
- the specified file.
-|Tlist_Set_App()| Set the name of the application
- controlling the taglist window.
-
- *Tlist_Update_File_Tags()*
-Tlist_Update_File_Tags({filename}, {filetype})
- Update the tags for the file {filename}. The second argument
- specifies the Vim filetype for the file. If the taglist plugin
- has not processed the file previously, then the exuberant
- ctags tool is invoked to generate the tags for the file.
-
- *Tlist_Get_Tag_Prototype_By_Line()*
-Tlist_Get_Tag_Prototype_By_Line([{filename}, {linenumber}])
- Return the prototype of the tag at or before the specified
- line number in the specified file. If the filename and line
- number are not specified, then the current buffer name and the
- current line number are used.
-
- *Tlist_Get_Tagname_By_Line()*
-Tlist_Get_Tagname_By_Line([{filename}, {linenumber}])
- Return the name of the tag at or before the specified line
- number in the specified file. If the filename and line number
- are not specified, then the current buffer name and the
- current line number are used.
-
- *Tlist_Set_App()*
-Tlist_Set_App({appname})
- Set the name of the plugin that controls the taglist plugin
- window and buffer. This can be used to integrate the taglist
- plugin with other Vim plugins.
-
- For example, the winmanager plugin and the Cream package use
- this function and specify the appname as "winmanager" and
- "cream" respectively.
-
- By default, the taglist plugin is a stand-alone plugin and
- controls the taglist window and buffer. If the taglist window
- is controlled by an external plugin, then the appname should
- be set appropriately.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-extend*
-9. Extending~
-
-The taglist plugin supports all the languages supported by the exuberant ctags
-tool, which includes the following languages: Assembly, ASP, Awk, Beta, C,
-C++, C#, Cobol, Eiffel, Erlang, Fortran, HTML, Java, Javascript, Lisp, Lua,
-Make, Pascal, Perl, PHP, Python, Rexx, Ruby, Scheme, Shell, Slang, SML, Sql,
-TCL, Verilog, Vim and Yacc.
-
-You can extend the taglist plugin to add support for new languages and also
-modify the support for the above listed languages.
-
-You should NOT make modifications to the taglist plugin script file to add
-support for new languages. You will lose these changes when you upgrade to the
-next version of the taglist plugin. Instead you should follow the below
-described instructions to extend the taglist plugin.
-
-You can extend the taglist plugin by setting variables in the .vimrc or _vimrc
-file. The name of these variables depends on the language name and is
-described below.
-
-Modifying support for an existing language~
-To modify the support for an already supported language, you have to set the
-tlist_xxx_settings variable in the ~/.vimrc or $HOME/_vimrc file. Replace xxx
-with the Vim filetype name for the language file. For example, to modify the
-support for the perl language files, you have to set the tlist_perl_settings
-variable. To modify the support for java files, you have to set the
-tlist_java_settings variable.
-
-To determine the filetype name used by Vim for a file, use the following
-command in the buffer containing the file:
-
- :set filetype
-
-The above command will display the Vim filetype for the current buffer.
-
-The format of the value set in the tlist_xxx_settings variable is
-
- <language_name>;flag1:name1;flag2:name2;flag3:name3
-
-The different fields in the value are separated by the ';' character.
-
-The first field 'language_name' is the name used by exuberant ctags to refer
-to this language file. This name can be different from the file type name used
-by Vim. For example, for C++, the language name used by ctags is 'c++' but the
-filetype name used by Vim is 'cpp'. To get the list of language names
-supported by exuberant ctags, use the following command:
-
- $ ctags --list-maps=all
-
-The remaining fields follow the format "flag:name". The sub-field 'flag' is
-the language specific flag used by exuberant ctags to generate the
-corresponding tags. For example, for the C language, to list only the
-functions, the 'f' flag is used. To get the list of flags supported by
-exuberant ctags for the various languages use the following command:
-
- $ ctags --list-kinds=all
-
-The sub-field 'name' specifies the title text to use for displaying the tags
-of a particular type. For example, 'name' can be set to 'functions'. This
-field can be set to any text string name.
-
-For example, to list only the classes and functions defined in a C++ language
-file, add the following line to your .vimrc file:
-
- let tlist_cpp_settings = 'c++;c:class;f:function'
-
-In the above setting, 'cpp' is the Vim filetype name and 'c++' is the name
-used by the exuberant ctags tool. 'c' and 'f' are the flags passed to
-exuberant ctags to list C++ classes and functions and 'class' is the title
-used for the class tags and 'function' is the title used for the function tags
-in the taglist window.
-
-For example, to display only functions defined in a C file and to use "My
-Functions" as the title for the function tags, use
-
- let tlist_c_settings = 'c;f:My Functions'
-
-When you set the tlist_xxx_settings variable, you will override the default
-setting used by the taglist plugin for the 'xxx' language. You cannot add to
-the default options used by the taglist plugin for a particular file type. To
-add to the options used by the taglist plugin for a language, copy the option
-values from the taglist plugin file to your .vimrc file and modify it.
-
-Adding support for a new language~
-If you want to add support for a new language to the taglist plugin, you need
-to first extend the exuberant ctags tool. For more information about extending
-exuberant ctags, visit the following page:
-
- http://ctags.sourceforge.net/EXTENDING.html
-
-To add support for a new language, set the tlist_xxx_settings variable in the
-~/.vimrc file appropriately as described above. Replace 'xxx' in the variable
-name with the Vim filetype name for the new language.
-
-For example, to extend the taglist plugin to support the latex language, you
-can use the following line (assuming, you have already extended exuberant
-ctags to support the latex language):
-
- let tlist_tex_settings='latex;b:bibitem;c:command;l:label'
-
-With the above line, when you edit files of filetype "tex" in Vim, the taglist
-plugin will invoke the exuberant ctags tool passing the "latex" filetype and
-the flags b, c and l to generate the tags. The text heading 'bibitem',
-'command' and 'label' will be used in the taglist window for the tags which
-are generated for the flags b, c and l respectively.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-faq*
-10. Frequently Asked Questions~
-
-Q. The taglist plugin doesn't work. The taglist window is empty and the tags
- defined in a file are not displayed.
-A. Are you using Vim version 6.0 and above? The taglist plugin relies on the
- features supported by Vim version 6.0 and above. You can use the following
- command to get the Vim version:
->
- $ vim --version
-<
- Are you using exuberant ctags version 5.0 and above? The taglist plugin
- relies on the features supported by exuberant ctags and will not work with
- GNU ctags or the Unix ctags utility. You can use the following command to
- determine whether the ctags installed in your system is exuberant ctags:
->
- $ ctags --version
-<
- Is exuberant ctags present in one of the directories in your PATH? If not,
- you need to set the Tlist_Ctags_Cmd variable to point to the location of
- exuberant ctags. Use the following Vim command to verify that this is setup
- correctly:
->
- :echo system(Tlist_Ctags_Cmd . ' --version')
-<
- The above command should display the version information for exuberant
- ctags.
-
- Did you turn on the Vim filetype detection? The taglist plugin relies on
- the filetype detected by Vim and passes the filetype to the exuberant ctags
- utility to parse the tags. Check the output of the following Vim command:
->
- :filetype
-<
- The output of the above command should contain "filetype detection:ON".
- To turn on the filetype detection, add the following line to the .vimrc or
- _vimrc file:
->
- filetype on
-<
- Is your version of Vim compiled with the support for the system() function?
- The following Vim command should display 1:
->
- :echo exists('*system')
-<
- In some Linux distributions (particularly Suse Linux), the default Vim
- installation is built without the support for the system() function. The
- taglist plugin uses the system() function to invoke the exuberant ctags
- utility. You need to rebuild Vim after enabling the support for the
- system() function. If you use the default build options, the system()
- function will be supported.
-
- Do you have the |'shellslash'| option set? You can try disabling the
- |'shellslash'| option. When the taglist plugin invokes the exuberant ctags
- utility with the path to the file, if the incorrect slashes are used, then
- you will see errors.
-
- Check the shell related Vim options values using the following command:
->
- :set shell? shellcmdflag? shellpipe?
- :set shellquote? shellredir? shellxquote?
-<
- If these options are set in your .vimrc or _vimrc file, try removing those
- lines.
-
- Are you using a Unix shell in a MS-Windows environment? For example,
- the Unix shell from the MKS-toolkit. Do you have the SHELL environment
- set to point to this shell? You can try resetting the SHELL environment
- variable.
-
- If you are using a Unix shell on MS-Windows, you should try to use
- exuberant ctags that is compiled for Unix-like environments so that
- exuberant ctags will understand path names with forward slash characters.
-
- Is your filetype supported by the exuberant ctags utility? The file types
- supported by the exuberant ctags utility are listed in the ctags help. If a
- file type is not supported, you have to extend exuberant ctags. You can use
- the following command to list the filetypes supported by exuberant ctags:
->
- ctags --list-languages
-<
- Run the following command from the shell prompt and check whether the tags
- defined in your file are listed in the output from exuberant ctags:
->
- ctags -f - --format=2 --excmd=pattern --fields=nks <filename>
-<
- If you see your tags in the output from the above command, then the
- exuberant ctags utility is properly parsing your file.
-
- Do you have the .ctags or _ctags or the ctags.cnf file in your home
- directory for specifying default options or for extending exuberant ctags?
- If you do have this file, check the options in this file and make sure
- these options are not interfering with the operation of the taglist plugin.
-
- If you are using MS-Windows, check the value of the TEMP and TMP
- environment variables. If these environment variables are set to a path
- with space characters in the name, then try using the DOS 8.3 short name
- for the path or set them to a path without the space characters in the
- name. For example, if the temporary directory name is "C:\Documents and
- Settings\xyz\Local Settings\Temp", then try setting the TEMP variable to
- the following:
->
- set TEMP=C:\DOCUMEN~1\xyz\LOCALS~1\Temp
-<
- If exuberant ctags is installed in a directory with space characters in the
- name, then try adding the directory to the PATH environment variable or try
- setting the 'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd' variable to the shortest path name to ctags
- or try copying the exuberant ctags to a path without space characters in
- the name. For example, if exuberant ctags is installed in the directory
- "C:\Program Files\Ctags", then try setting the 'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd' variable
- as below:
->
- let Tlist_Ctags_Cmd='C:\Progra~1\Ctags\ctags.exe'
-<
- If you are using a cygwin compiled version of exuberant ctags on MS-Windows,
- make sure that either you have the cygwin compiled sort utility installed
- and available in your PATH or compile exuberant ctags with internal sort
- support. Otherwise, when exuberant ctags sorts the tags output by invoking
- the sort utility, it may end up invoking the MS-Windows version of
- sort.exe, thereby resulting in failure.
-
-Q. When I try to open the taglist window, I am seeing the following error
- message. How do I fix this problem?
-
- Taglist: Failed to generate tags for /my/path/to/file
- ctags: illegal option -- -^@usage: ctags [-BFadtuwvx] [-f tagsfile] file ...
-
-A. The taglist plugin will work only with the exuberant ctags tool. You
- cannot use the GNU ctags or the Unix ctags program with the taglist plugin.
- You will see an error message similar to the one shown above, if you try
- use a non-exuberant ctags program with Vim. To fix this problem, either add
- the exuberant ctags tool location to the PATH environment variable or set
- the 'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd' variable.
-
-Q. A file has more than one tag with the same name. When I select a tag name
- from the taglist window, the cursor is positioned at the incorrect tag
- location.
-A. The taglist plugin uses the search pattern generated by the exuberant ctags
- utility to position the cursor at the location of a tag definition. If a
- file has more than one tag with the same name and same prototype, then the
- search pattern will be the same. In this case, when searching for the tag
- pattern, the cursor may be positioned at the incorrect location.
-
-Q. I have made some modifications to my file and introduced new
- functions/classes/variables. I have not yet saved my file. The taglist
- plugin is not displaying the new tags when I update the taglist window.
-A. The exuberant ctags utility will process only files that are present in the
- disk. To list the tags defined in a file, you have to save the file and
- then update the taglist window.
-
-Q. I have created a ctags file using the exuberant ctags utility for my source
- tree. How do I configure the taglist plugin to use this tags file?
-A. The taglist plugin doesn't use a tags file stored in disk. For every opened
- file, the taglist plugin invokes the exuberant ctags utility to get the
- list of tags dynamically. The Vim system() function is used to invoke
- exuberant ctags and get the ctags output. This function internally uses a
- temporary file to store the output. This file is deleted after the output
- from the command is read. So you will never see the file that contains the
- output of exuberant ctags.
-
-Q. When I set the |'updatetime'| option to a low value (less than 1000) and if
- I keep pressing a key with the taglist window open, the current buffer
- contents are changed. Why is this?
-A. The taglist plugin uses the |CursorHold| autocmd to highlight the current
- tag. The CursorHold autocmd triggers for every |'updatetime'| milliseconds.
- If the |'updatetime'| option is set to a low value, then the CursorHold
- autocmd will be triggered frequently. As the taglist plugin changes
- the focus to the taglist window to highlight the current tag, this could
- interfere with the key movement resulting in changing the contents of
- the current buffer. The workaround for this problem is to not set the
- |'updatetime'| option to a low value.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-license*
-11. License~
-Permission is hereby granted to use and distribute the taglist plugin, with or
-without modifications, provided that this copyright notice is copied with it.
-Like anything else that's free, taglist.vim is provided *as is* and comes with
-no warranty of any kind, either expressed or implied. In no event will the
-copyright holder be liable for any damamges resulting from the use of this
-software.
-
-==============================================================================
- *taglist-todo*
-12. Todo~
-
-1. Group tags according to the scope and display them. For example,
- group all the tags belonging to a C++/Java class
-2. Support for displaying tags in a modified (not-yet-saved) file.
-3. Automatically open the taglist window only for selected filetypes.
- For other filetypes, close the taglist window.
-4. When using the shell from the MKS toolkit, the taglist plugin
- doesn't work.
-5. The taglist plugin doesn't work with files edited remotely using the
- netrw plugin. The exuberant ctags utility cannot process files over
- scp/rcp/ftp, etc.
-
-==============================================================================
-
-vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:
diff --git a/dot_vim/doc/tags b/dot_vim/doc/tags
deleted file mode 100644
index 9049f74..0000000
--- a/dot_vim/doc/tags
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1138 +0,0 @@
-'Tlist_Auto_Highlight_Tag' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Auto_Highlight_Tag'*
-'Tlist_Auto_Open' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Auto_Open'*
-'Tlist_Auto_Update' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Auto_Update'*
-'Tlist_Close_On_Select' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Close_On_Select'*
-'Tlist_Compact_Format' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Compact_Format'*
-'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Ctags_Cmd'*
-'Tlist_Display_Prototype' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Display_Prototype'*
-'Tlist_Display_Tag_Scope' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Display_Tag_Scope'*
-'Tlist_Enable_Fold_Column' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Enable_Fold_Column'*
-'Tlist_Exit_OnlyWindow' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Exit_OnlyWindow'*
-'Tlist_File_Fold_Auto_Close' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_File_Fold_Auto_Close'*
-'Tlist_GainFocus_On_ToggleOpen' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_GainFocus_On_ToggleOpen'*
-'Tlist_Highlight_Tag_On_BufEnter' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Highlight_Tag_On_BufEnter'*
-'Tlist_Inc_Winwidth' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Inc_Winwidth'*
-'Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Max_Submenu_Items'*
-'Tlist_Max_Tag_Length' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Max_Tag_Length'*
-'Tlist_Process_File_Always' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Process_File_Always'*
-'Tlist_Show_Menu' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Show_Menu'*
-'Tlist_Show_One_File' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Show_One_File'*
-'Tlist_Sort_Type' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Sort_Type'*
-'Tlist_Use_Horiz_Window' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Use_Horiz_Window'*
-'Tlist_Use_Right_Window' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Use_Right_Window'*
-'Tlist_Use_SingleClick' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_Use_SingleClick'*
-'Tlist_WinHeight' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_WinHeight'*
-'Tlist_WinWidth' taglist.txt /*'Tlist_WinWidth'*
-:DocIndex haskellmode.txt /*:DocIndex*
-:DocSettings haskellmode.txt /*:DocSettings*
-:ExportDocIndex haskellmode.txt /*:ExportDocIndex*
-:FlagReference haskellmode.txt /*:FlagReference*
-:GHCReload haskellmode.txt /*:GHCReload*
-:GHCStaticOptions haskellmode.txt /*:GHCStaticOptions*
-:GHCi haskellmode.txt /*:GHCi*
-:HpasteIndex haskellmode.txt /*:HpasteIndex*
-:HpastePostNew haskellmode.txt /*:HpastePostNew*
-:IDoc haskellmode.txt /*:IDoc*
-:MDoc haskellmode.txt /*:MDoc*
-:TlistAddFiles taglist.txt /*:TlistAddFiles*
-:TlistAddFilesRecursive taglist.txt /*:TlistAddFilesRecursive*
-:TlistClose taglist.txt /*:TlistClose*
-:TlistDebug taglist.txt /*:TlistDebug*
-:TlistHighlightTag taglist.txt /*:TlistHighlightTag*
-:TlistLock taglist.txt /*:TlistLock*
-:TlistMessages taglist.txt /*:TlistMessages*
-:TlistOpen taglist.txt /*:TlistOpen*
-:TlistSessionLoad taglist.txt /*:TlistSessionLoad*
-:TlistSessionSave taglist.txt /*:TlistSessionSave*
-:TlistShowPrototype taglist.txt /*:TlistShowPrototype*
-:TlistShowTag taglist.txt /*:TlistShowTag*
-:TlistToggle taglist.txt /*:TlistToggle*
-:TlistUndebug taglist.txt /*:TlistUndebug*
-:TlistUnlock taglist.txt /*:TlistUnlock*
-:TlistUpdate taglist.txt /*:TlistUpdate*
-Alph latexhelp.txt /*Alph*
-Alt-B latex-suite.txt /*Alt-B*
-Alt-C latex-suite.txt /*Alt-C*
-Alt-I latex-suite.txt /*Alt-I*
-Alt-L latex-suite.txt /*Alt-L*
-BibTeX latexhelp.txt /*BibTeX*
-IMAP_PutTextWithMovement latex-suite.txt /*IMAP_PutTextWithMovement*
-Imap_DeleteEmptyPlaceHolders latex-suite.txt /*Imap_DeleteEmptyPlaceHolders*
-Imap_FreezeImap latex-suite.txt /*Imap_FreezeImap*
-Imap_PlaceHolderEnd latex-suite.txt /*Imap_PlaceHolderEnd*
-Imap_PlaceHolderStart latex-suite.txt /*Imap_PlaceHolderStart*
-Imap_StickyPlaceHolders latex-suite.txt /*Imap_StickyPlaceHolders*
-Imap_UsePlaceHolders latex-suite.txt /*Imap_UsePlaceHolders*
-LaTeX latexhelp.txt /*LaTeX*
-Plug_IMAP_DeleteAndJumBack latex-suite.txt /*Plug_IMAP_DeleteAndJumBack*
-Plug_IMAP_DeleteAndJumpForward latex-suite.txt /*Plug_IMAP_DeleteAndJumpForward*
-Plug_IMAP_JumpBack latex-suite.txt /*Plug_IMAP_JumpBack*
-Plug_IMAP_JumpForward latex-suite.txt /*Plug_IMAP_JumpForward*
-Plug_Tex_InsertItem latex-suite.txt /*Plug_Tex_InsertItem*
-Plug_Tex_LeftRight latex-suite.txt /*Plug_Tex_LeftRight*
-Plug_Tex_MathBF latex-suite.txt /*Plug_Tex_MathBF*
-Plug_Tex_MathCal latex-suite.txt /*Plug_Tex_MathCal*
-Roman latexhelp.txt /*Roman*
-TClearCiteHist latex-suite.txt /*TClearCiteHist*
-TLook latex-suite.txt /*TLook*
-TLookAll latex-suite.txt /*TLookAll*
-TLookBib latex-suite.txt /*TLookBib*
-TMacro latex-suite.txt /*TMacro*
-TMacroDelete latex-suite.txt /*TMacroDelete*
-TMacroEdit latex-suite.txt /*TMacroEdit*
-TMacroNew latex-suite.txt /*TMacroNew*
-TPackage latex-suite.txt /*TPackage*
-TPackageUpdate latex-suite.txt /*TPackageUpdate*
-TPackageUpdateAll latex-suite.txt /*TPackageUpdateAll*
-TPartComp latex-suite.txt /*TPartComp*
-TPartView latex-suite.txt /*TPartView*
-TSection latex-suite.txt /*TSection*
-TSectionAdvanced latex-suite.txt /*TSectionAdvanced*
-TTemplate latex-suite.txt /*TTemplate*
-Tex_AutoFolding latex-suite.txt /*Tex_AutoFolding*
-Tex_BIBINPUTS latex-suite.txt /*Tex_BIBINPUTS*
-Tex_CatchVisMapErrors latex-suite.txt /*Tex_CatchVisMapErrors*
-Tex_Com_name latex-suite.txt /*Tex_Com_name*
-Tex_CompileRule_format latex-suite.txt /*Tex_CompileRule_format*
-Tex_Debug latex-suite.txt /*Tex_Debug*
-Tex_DefaultTargetFormat latex-suite.txt /*Tex_DefaultTargetFormat*
-Tex_Diacritics latex-suite.txt /*Tex_Diacritics*
-Tex_Env_name latex-suite.txt /*Tex_Env_name*
-Tex_EnvironmentMaps latex-suite.txt /*Tex_EnvironmentMaps*
-Tex_EnvironmentMenus latex-suite.txt /*Tex_EnvironmentMenus*
-Tex_ExplorerHeight latex-suite.txt /*Tex_ExplorerHeight*
-Tex_FoldedCommands latex-suite.txt /*Tex_FoldedCommands*
-Tex_FoldedEnvironments latex-suite.txt /*Tex_FoldedEnvironments*
-Tex_FoldedMisc latex-suite.txt /*Tex_FoldedMisc*
-Tex_FoldedSections latex-suite.txt /*Tex_FoldedSections*
-Tex_Folding latex-suite.txt /*Tex_Folding*
-Tex_FontMaps latex-suite.txt /*Tex_FontMaps*
-Tex_FontMenus latex-suite.txt /*Tex_FontMenus*
-Tex_GotoError latex-suite.txt /*Tex_GotoError*
-Tex_HotKeyMappings latex-suite.txt /*Tex_HotKeyMappings*
-Tex_IgnoreLevel latex-suite.txt /*Tex_IgnoreLevel*
-Tex_IgnoredWarnings latex-suite.txt /*Tex_IgnoredWarnings*
-Tex_ImageDir latex-suite.txt /*Tex_ImageDir*
-Tex_ItemStyle_environment latex-suite.txt /*Tex_ItemStyle_environment*
-Tex_Leader latex-suite.txt /*Tex_Leader*
-Tex_Leader2 latex-suite.txt /*Tex_Leader2*
-Tex_MainFileExpression latex-suite.txt /*Tex_MainFileExpression*
-Tex_MainMenuLocation latex-suite.txt /*Tex_MainMenuLocation*
-Tex_MathMenus latex-suite.txt /*Tex_MathMenus*
-Tex_Menus latex-suite.txt /*Tex_Menus*
-Tex_MultipleCompileFormats latex-suite.txt /*Tex_MultipleCompileFormats*
-Tex_NestElementMenus latex-suite.txt /*Tex_NestElementMenus*
-Tex_NestPackagesMenu latex-suite.txt /*Tex_NestPackagesMenu*
-Tex_PackagesMenu latex-suite.txt /*Tex_PackagesMenu*
-Tex_ProjectSourceFiles latex-suite.txt /*Tex_ProjectSourceFiles*
-Tex_PromptedCommands latex-suite.txt /*Tex_PromptedCommands*
-Tex_PromptedEnvironments latex-suite.txt /*Tex_PromptedEnvironments*
-Tex_RememberCiteSearch latex-suite.txt /*Tex_RememberCiteSearch*
-Tex_SectionMaps latex-suite.txt /*Tex_SectionMaps*
-Tex_SectionMenus latex-suite.txt /*Tex_SectionMenus*
-Tex_SmartKeyBS latex-suite.txt /*Tex_SmartKeyBS*
-Tex_SmartKeyQuote latex-suite.txt /*Tex_SmartKeyQuote*
-Tex_TEXINPUTS latex-suite.txt /*Tex_TEXINPUTS*
-Tex_UseMakefile latex-suite.txt /*Tex_UseMakefile*
-Tex_UseMenuWizard latex-suite.txt /*Tex_UseMenuWizard*
-Tex_UsePython latex-suite.txt /*Tex_UsePython*
-Tex_UseSimpleLabelSearch latex-suite.txt /*Tex_UseSimpleLabelSearch*
-Tex_UseUtfMenus latex-suite.txt /*Tex_UseUtfMenus*
-Tex_ViewRuleComplete_format latex-suite.txt /*Tex_ViewRuleComplete_format*
-Tex_ViewRule_format latex-suite.txt /*Tex_ViewRule_format*
-Tex_ViewerCwindowHeight latex-suite.txt /*Tex_ViewerCwindowHeight*
-Tex_ViewerPreviewHeight latex-suite.txt /*Tex_ViewerPreviewHeight*
-Tlist_Get_Tag_Prototype_By_Line() taglist.txt /*Tlist_Get_Tag_Prototype_By_Line()*
-Tlist_Get_Tagname_By_Line() taglist.txt /*Tlist_Get_Tagname_By_Line()*
-Tlist_Set_App() taglist.txt /*Tlist_Set_App()*
-Tlist_Update_File_Tags() taglist.txt /*Tlist_Update_File_Tags()*
-Tshortcuts latex-suite.txt /*Tshortcuts*
-\Alph latexhelp.txt /*\\Alph*
-\Huge latexhelp.txt /*\\Huge*
-\LARGE latexhelp.txt /*\\LARGE*
-\Large latexhelp.txt /*\\Large*
-\Roman latexhelp.txt /*\\Roman*
-\\ latexhelp.txt /*\\\\*
-\\\\ latexhelp.txt /*\\\\\\\\*
-\addcontentsline latexhelp.txt /*\\addcontentsline*
-\address latexhelp.txt /*\\address*
-\addtocontents latexhelp.txt /*\\addtocontents*
-\addtocounter latexhelp.txt /*\\addtocounter*
-\addtolength latexhelp.txt /*\\addtolength*
-\addvspace latexhelp.txt /*\\addvspace*
-\alph latexhelp.txt /*\\alph*
-\and latexhelp.txt /*\\and*
-\appendix latexhelp.txt /*\\appendix*
-\arabic latexhelp.txt /*\\arabic*
-\author latexhelp.txt /*\\author*
-\begin latexhelp.txt /*\\begin*
-\bfseries latexhelp.txt /*\\bfseries*
-\bibitem latexhelp.txt /*\\bibitem*
-\bibliography latexhelp.txt /*\\bibliography*
-\bibliographystyle latexhelp.txt /*\\bibliographystyle*
-\bigskip latexhelp.txt /*\\bigskip*
-\cc latexhelp.txt /*\\cc*
-\cdots latexhelp.txt /*\\cdots*
-\centering latexhelp.txt /*\\centering*
-\chapter latexhelp.txt /*\\chapter*
-\circle latexhelp.txt /*\\circle*
-\cite latexhelp.txt /*\\cite*
-\cleardoublepage latexhelp.txt /*\\cleardoublepage*
-\clearpage latexhelp.txt /*\\clearpage*
-\cline latexhelp.txt /*\\cline*
-\closing latexhelp.txt /*\\closing*
-\dashbox latexhelp.txt /*\\dashbox*
-\date latexhelp.txt /*\\date*
-\ddots latexhelp.txt /*\\ddots*
-\depth latexhelp.txt /*\\depth*
-\documentclass latexhelp.txt /*\\documentclass*
-\dotfill latexhelp.txt /*\\dotfill*
-\emph latexhelp.txt /*\\emph*
-\end latexhelp.txt /*\\end*
-\enlargethispage latexhelp.txt /*\\enlargethispage*
-\fbox latexhelp.txt /*\\fbox*
-\flushbottom latexhelp.txt /*\\flushbottom*
-\fnsymbol latexhelp.txt /*\\fnsymbol*
-\fontencoding latexhelp.txt /*\\fontencoding*
-\fontfamily latexhelp.txt /*\\fontfamily*
-\fontseries latexhelp.txt /*\\fontseries*
-\fontshape latexhelp.txt /*\\fontshape*
-\fontsize latexhelp.txt /*\\fontsize*
-\footnote latexhelp.txt /*\\footnote*
-\footnotemark latexhelp.txt /*\\footnotemark*
-\footnotesize latexhelp.txt /*\\footnotesize*
-\footnotetext latexhelp.txt /*\\footnotetext*
-\frac latexhelp.txt /*\\frac*
-\frame latexhelp.txt /*\\frame*
-\framebox latexhelp.txt /*\\framebox*
-\fussy latexhelp.txt /*\\fussy*
-\height latexhelp.txt /*\\height*
-\hfill latexhelp.txt /*\\hfill*
-\hline latexhelp.txt /*\\hline*
-\hrulefill latexhelp.txt /*\\hrulefill*
-\hspace latexhelp.txt /*\\hspace*
-\huge latexhelp.txt /*\\huge*
-\hyphenation latexhelp.txt /*\\hyphenation*
-\include latexhelp.txt /*\\include*
-\includeonly latexhelp.txt /*\\includeonly*
-\indent latexhelp.txt /*\\indent*
-\input latexhelp.txt /*\\input*
-\item latexhelp.txt /*\\item*
-\itshape latexhelp.txt /*\\itshape*
-\kill latexhelp.txt /*\\kill*
-\label latexhelp.txt /*\\label*
-\large latexhelp.txt /*\\large*
-\ldots latexhelp.txt /*\\ldots*
-\lefteqn latexhelp.txt /*\\lefteqn*
-\letter latexhelp.txt /*\\letter*
-\line latexhelp.txt /*\\line*
-\linebreak latexhelp.txt /*\\linebreak*
-\linethickness latexhelp.txt /*\\linethickness*
-\listoffigures latexhelp.txt /*\\listoffigures*
-\listoftables latexhelp.txt /*\\listoftables*
-\location latexhelp.txt /*\\location*
-\lrbox latexhelp.txt /*\\lrbox*
-\makebox latexhelp.txt /*\\makebox*
-\makelabels latexhelp.txt /*\\makelabels*
-\maketitle latexhelp.txt /*\\maketitle*
-\marginpar latexhelp.txt /*\\marginpar*
-\markboth latexhelp.txt /*\\markboth*
-\markright latexhelp.txt /*\\markright*
-\mathbf latexhelp.txt /*\\mathbf*
-\mathcal latexhelp.txt /*\\mathcal*
-\mathit latexhelp.txt /*\\mathit*
-\mathnormal latexhelp.txt /*\\mathnormal*
-\mathrm latexhelp.txt /*\\mathrm*
-\mathsf latexhelp.txt /*\\mathsf*
-\mathtt latexhelp.txt /*\\mathtt*
-\mathversion latexhelp.txt /*\\mathversion*
-\mbox latexhelp.txt /*\\mbox*
-\mdseries latexhelp.txt /*\\mdseries*
-\medskip latexhelp.txt /*\\medskip*
-\multicolumn latexhelp.txt /*\\multicolumn*
-\multiput latexhelp.txt /*\\multiput*
-\name latexhelp.txt /*\\name*
-\newcommand latexhelp.txt /*\\newcommand*
-\newcounter latexhelp.txt /*\\newcounter*
-\newenvironment latexhelp.txt /*\\newenvironment*
-\newfont latexhelp.txt /*\\newfont*
-\newlength latexhelp.txt /*\\newlength*
-\newline latexhelp.txt /*\\newline*
-\newpage latexhelp.txt /*\\newpage*
-\newsavebox latexhelp.txt /*\\newsavebox*
-\newtheorem latexhelp.txt /*\\newtheorem*
-\nocite latexhelp.txt /*\\nocite*
-\nofiles latexhelp.txt /*\\nofiles*
-\noindent latexhelp.txt /*\\noindent*
-\nolinebreak latexhelp.txt /*\\nolinebreak*
-\nonumber latexhelp.txt /*\\nonumber*
-\nopagebreak latexhelp.txt /*\\nopagebreak*
-\normalfont latexhelp.txt /*\\normalfont*
-\normalsize latexhelp.txt /*\\normalsize*
-\onecolumn latexhelp.txt /*\\onecolumn*
-\opening latexhelp.txt /*\\opening*
-\oval latexhelp.txt /*\\oval*
-\overbrace latexhelp.txt /*\\overbrace*
-\overline latexhelp.txt /*\\overline*
-\pagebreak latexhelp.txt /*\\pagebreak*
-\pagenumbering latexhelp.txt /*\\pagenumbering*
-\pageref latexhelp.txt /*\\pageref*
-\pagestyle latexhelp.txt /*\\pagestyle*
-\par latexhelp.txt /*\\par*
-\paragraph latexhelp.txt /*\\paragraph*
-\parbox latexhelp.txt /*\\parbox*
-\part latexhelp.txt /*\\part*
-\picture-framebox latexhelp.txt /*\\picture-framebox*
-\ps latexhelp.txt /*\\ps*
-\pushtabs latexhelp.txt /*\\pushtabs*
-\put latexhelp.txt /*\\put*
-\raggedbottom latexhelp.txt /*\\raggedbottom*
-\raggedleft latexhelp.txt /*\\raggedleft*
-\raggedright latexhelp.txt /*\\raggedright*
-\raisebox latexhelp.txt /*\\raisebox*
-\ref latexhelp.txt /*\\ref*
-\refstepcounter latexhelp.txt /*\\refstepcounter*
-\renewcommand latexhelp.txt /*\\renewcommand*
-\renewenvironment latexhelp.txt /*\\renewenvironment*
-\reversemarginpar latexhelp.txt /*\\reversemarginpar*
-\rmfamily latexhelp.txt /*\\rmfamily*
-\roman latexhelp.txt /*\\roman*
-\rule latexhelp.txt /*\\rule*
-\savebox latexhelp.txt /*\\savebox*
-\sbox latexhelp.txt /*\\sbox*
-\scriptsize latexhelp.txt /*\\scriptsize*
-\scshape latexhelp.txt /*\\scshape*
-\section latexhelp.txt /*\\section*
-\selectfont latexhelp.txt /*\\selectfont*
-\setcounter latexhelp.txt /*\\setcounter*
-\setlength latexhelp.txt /*\\setlength*
-\settodepth latexhelp.txt /*\\settodepth*
-\settoheight latexhelp.txt /*\\settoheight*
-\settowidth latexhelp.txt /*\\settowidth*
-\sffamily latexhelp.txt /*\\sffamily*
-\shortstack latexhelp.txt /*\\shortstack*
-\signature latexhelp.txt /*\\signature*
-\sloppy latexhelp.txt /*\\sloppy*
-\slshape latexhelp.txt /*\\slshape*
-\small latexhelp.txt /*\\small*
-\smallskip latexhelp.txt /*\\smallskip*
-\space latexhelp.txt /*\\space*
-\sqrt latexhelp.txt /*\\sqrt*
-\startbreaks latexhelp.txt /*\\startbreaks*
-\stepcounter latexhelp.txt /*\\stepcounter*
-\stopbreaks latexhelp.txt /*\\stopbreaks*
-\subparagraph latexhelp.txt /*\\subparagraph*
-\subsection latexhelp.txt /*\\subsection*
-\subsubsection latexhelp.txt /*\\subsubsection*
-\symbol latexhelp.txt /*\\symbol*
-\table latexhelp.txt /*\\table*
-\tableofcontents latexhelp.txt /*\\tableofcontents*
-\telephone latexhelp.txt /*\\telephone*
-\textbf latexhelp.txt /*\\textbf*
-\textit latexhelp.txt /*\\textit*
-\textmd latexhelp.txt /*\\textmd*
-\textnormal latexhelp.txt /*\\textnormal*
-\textrm latexhelp.txt /*\\textrm*
-\textsc latexhelp.txt /*\\textsc*
-\textsf latexhelp.txt /*\\textsf*
-\textsl latexhelp.txt /*\\textsl*
-\texttt latexhelp.txt /*\\texttt*
-\textup latexhelp.txt /*\\textup*
-\thanks latexhelp.txt /*\\thanks*
-\thebibliography latexhelp.txt /*\\thebibliography*
-\thispagestyle latexhelp.txt /*\\thispagestyle*
-\tiny latexhelp.txt /*\\tiny*
-\title latexhelp.txt /*\\title*
-\totalheight latexhelp.txt /*\\totalheight*
-\ttfamily latexhelp.txt /*\\ttfamily*
-\twocolumn latexhelp.txt /*\\twocolumn*
-\typein latexhelp.txt /*\\typein*
-\typeout latexhelp.txt /*\\typeout*
-\underbrace latexhelp.txt /*\\underbrace*
-\underline latexhelp.txt /*\\underline*
-\upshape latexhelp.txt /*\\upshape*
-\usebox latexhelp.txt /*\\usebox*
-\usecounter latexhelp.txt /*\\usecounter*
-\usefont latexhelp.txt /*\\usefont*
-\usepackage latexhelp.txt /*\\usepackage*
-\value latexhelp.txt /*\\value*
-\vdots latexhelp.txt /*\\vdots*
-\vector latexhelp.txt /*\\vector*
-\verb latexhelp.txt /*\\verb*
-\vfill latexhelp.txt /*\\vfill*
-\vline latexhelp.txt /*\\vline*
-\vspace latexhelp.txt /*\\vspace*
-\width latexhelp.txt /*\\width*
-_. haskellmode.txt /*_.*
-_? haskellmode.txt /*_?*
-_?1 haskellmode.txt /*_?1*
-_?2 haskellmode.txt /*_?2*
-_T haskellmode.txt /*_T*
-_ct haskellmode.txt /*_ct*
-_i haskellmode.txt /*_i*
-_ie haskellmode.txt /*_ie*
-_im haskellmode.txt /*_im*
-_iq haskellmode.txt /*_iq*
-_iqm haskellmode.txt /*_iqm*
-_lang haskellmode.txt /*_lang*
-_opt haskellmode.txt /*_opt*
-_si haskellmode.txt /*_si*
-_t haskellmode.txt /*_t*
-adding-bib-options latex-suite.txt /*adding-bib-options*
-alph latexhelp.txt /*alph*
-altkey-mappings latex-suite.txt /*altkey-mappings*
-arabic latexhelp.txt /*arabic*
-array latexhelp.txt /*array*
-article-class latexhelp.txt /*article-class*
-auc-tex-mappings latex-suite.txt /*auc-tex-mappings*
-automatic-package-detection latex-suite.txt /*automatic-package-detection*
-bibtex latexhelp.txt /*bibtex*
-bibtex-bindings latex-suite.txt /*bibtex-bindings*
-book-class latexhelp.txt /*book-class*
-c-support csupport.txt /*c-support*
-center latexhelp.txt /*center*
-changing-commands latex-suite.txt /*changing-commands*
-changing-environments latex-suite.txt /*changing-environments*
-cite-search-caching latex-suite.txt /*cite-search-caching*
-compiler-dependency latex-suite.txt /*compiler-dependency*
-compiler-ghc haskellmode.txt /*compiler-ghc*
-compiler-output-customization latex-suite.txt /*compiler-output-customization*
-compiler-rules latex-suite.txt /*compiler-rules*
-compiling-multiple latex-suite.txt /*compiling-multiple*
-completion-window-preferences latex-suite.txt /*completion-window-preferences*
-csupport csupport.txt /*csupport*
-csupport-c++ csupport.txt /*csupport-c++*
-csupport-c++-method-impl csupport.txt /*csupport-c++-method-impl*
-csupport-c++-normal-mode csupport.txt /*csupport-c++-normal-mode*
-csupport-c++-visual-mode csupport.txt /*csupport-c++-visual-mode*
-csupport-code-to-comm csupport.txt /*csupport-code-to-comm*
-csupport-comm csupport.txt /*csupport-comm*
-csupport-comm-aligned csupport.txt /*csupport-comm-aligned*
-csupport-comm-c-cpp csupport.txt /*csupport-comm-c-cpp*
-csupport-comm-date csupport.txt /*csupport-comm-date*
-csupport-comm-frame csupport.txt /*csupport-comm-frame*
-csupport-comm-keywords csupport.txt /*csupport-comm-keywords*
-csupport-comm-realign csupport.txt /*csupport-comm-realign*
-csupport-comm-to-code csupport.txt /*csupport-comm-to-code*
-csupport-custom csupport.txt /*csupport-custom*
-csupport-custom-glob-vars csupport.txt /*csupport-custom-glob-vars*
-csupport-custom-root-menu csupport.txt /*csupport-custom-root-menu*
-csupport-dictionary csupport.txt /*csupport-dictionary*
-csupport-folding csupport.txt /*csupport-folding*
-csupport-help csupport.txt /*csupport-help*
-csupport-hotkeys csupport.txt /*csupport-hotkeys*
-csupport-idioms csupport.txt /*csupport-idioms*
-csupport-prep csupport.txt /*csupport-prep*
-csupport-prep-if0 csupport.txt /*csupport-prep-if0*
-csupport-prep-normal-mode csupport.txt /*csupport-prep-normal-mode*
-csupport-prep-visual-mode csupport.txt /*csupport-prep-visual-mode*
-csupport-proto csupport.txt /*csupport-proto*
-csupport-release-notes csupport.txt /*csupport-release-notes*
-csupport-run csupport.txt /*csupport-run*
-csupport-run-buffer csupport.txt /*csupport-run-buffer*
-csupport-run-cmdline-args csupport.txt /*csupport-run-cmdline-args*
-csupport-run-codecheck csupport.txt /*csupport-run-codecheck*
-csupport-run-hardcopy csupport.txt /*csupport-run-hardcopy*
-csupport-run-indent csupport.txt /*csupport-run-indent*
-csupport-run-make csupport.txt /*csupport-run-make*
-csupport-run-make-args csupport.txt /*csupport-run-make-args*
-csupport-run-output csupport.txt /*csupport-run-output*
-csupport-run-splint csupport.txt /*csupport-run-splint*
-csupport-run-templates csupport.txt /*csupport-run-templates*
-csupport-run-xterm csupport.txt /*csupport-run-xterm*
-csupport-snippets csupport.txt /*csupport-snippets*
-csupport-stat csupport.txt /*csupport-stat*
-csupport-stat-normal-mode csupport.txt /*csupport-stat-normal-mode*
-csupport-stat-visual-mode csupport.txt /*csupport-stat-visual-mode*
-csupport-system-wide csupport.txt /*csupport-system-wide*
-csupport-taglist csupport.txt /*csupport-taglist*
-csupport-templates csupport.txt /*csupport-templates*
-csupport-templates-date csupport.txt /*csupport-templates-date*
-csupport-templates-definition csupport.txt /*csupport-templates-definition*
-csupport-templates-expansion csupport.txt /*csupport-templates-expansion*
-csupport-templates-files csupport.txt /*csupport-templates-files*
-csupport-templates-macros csupport.txt /*csupport-templates-macros*
-csupport-templates-names csupport.txt /*csupport-templates-names*
-csupport-troubleshooting csupport.txt /*csupport-troubleshooting*
-csupport-usage-gvim csupport.txt /*csupport-usage-gvim*
-csupport-usage-vim csupport.txt /*csupport-usage-vim*
-csupport-windows csupport.txt /*csupport-windows*
-csupport.txt csupport.txt /*csupport.txt*
-custom-macros-menu latex-suite.txt /*custom-macros-menu*
-custom-packages latex-suite.txt /*custom-packages*
-customize-alt-key-maps latex-suite.txt /*customize-alt-key-maps*
-customize-imap-maps latex-suite.txt /*customize-imap-maps*
-customizing-compiling latex-suite.txt /*customizing-compiling*
-customizing-folding latex-suite.txt /*customizing-folding*
-customizing-latex-completion latex-suite.txt /*customizing-latex-completion*
-customizing-latex-suite latex-suite.txt /*customizing-latex-suite*
-customizing-macros latex-suite.txt /*customizing-macros*
-customizing-menus latex-suite.txt /*customizing-menus*
-customizing-packages latex-suite.txt /*customizing-packages*
-customizing-place-holders latex-suite.txt /*customizing-place-holders*
-customizing-smart-keys latex-suite.txt /*customizing-smart-keys*
-customizing-viewing latex-suite.txt /*customizing-viewing*
-customizing-what-to-fold latex-suite.txt /*customizing-what-to-fold*
-default-folding latex-suite.txt /*default-folding*
-description latexhelp.txt /*description*
-diacritic-mappings latex-suite.txt /*diacritic-mappings*
-displaymath latexhelp.txt /*displaymath*
-draft latexhelp.txt /*draft*
-editing-folding latex-suite.txt /*editing-folding*
-empty latexhelp.txt /*empty*
-enabling-searching latex-suite.txt /*enabling-searching*
-enclosing-commands latex-suite.txt /*enclosing-commands*
-enclosing-env-f5 latex-suite.txt /*enclosing-env-f5*
-enclosing-env-threeletter latex-suite.txt /*enclosing-env-threeletter*
-enclosing-environments latex-suite.txt /*enclosing-environments*
-enumerate latexhelp.txt /*enumerate*
-environment-mappings latex-suite.txt /*environment-mappings*
-eqnarray latexhelp.txt /*eqnarray*
-equation latexhelp.txt /*equation*
-figure latexhelp.txt /*figure*
-final latexhelp.txt /*final*
-fleqn latexhelp.txt /*fleqn*
-flushleft latexhelp.txt /*flushleft*
-flushright latexhelp.txt /*flushright*
-fold-setting-adding latex-suite.txt /*fold-setting-adding*
-fold-setting-advanced latex-suite.txt /*fold-setting-advanced*
-font-lowlevelcommands latexhelp.txt /*font-lowlevelcommands*
-font-maps latex-suite.txt /*font-maps*
-font-size latexhelp.txt /*font-size*
-font-styles latexhelp.txt /*font-styles*
-forward-searching latex-suite.txt /*forward-searching*
-g:ghc haskellmode.txt /*g:ghc*
-g:haddock_browser haskellmode.txt /*g:haddock_browser*
-g:haddock_browser_callformat haskellmode.txt /*g:haddock_browser_callformat*
-g:haddock_docdir haskellmode.txt /*g:haddock_docdir*
-g:haddock_indexfiledir haskellmode.txt /*g:haddock_indexfiledir*
-g:wget haskellmode.txt /*g:wget*
-ghc haskellmode.txt /*ghc*
-ghc-compiler haskellmode.txt /*ghc-compiler*
-greek-letter-mappings latex-suite.txt /*greek-letter-mappings*
-haddock haskellmode.txt /*haddock*
-haskellmode haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode*
-haskellmode-XO haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-XO*
-haskellmode-XU haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-XU*
-haskellmode-compiler haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-compiler*
-haskellmode-editing haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-editing*
-haskellmode-haddock haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-haddock*
-haskellmode-hpaste haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-hpaste*
-haskellmode-indexing haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-indexing*
-haskellmode-lookup haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-lookup*
-haskellmode-omni-completion haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-omni-completion*
-haskellmode-overview haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-overview*
-haskellmode-quickref haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-quickref*
-haskellmode-requirements haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-requirements*
-haskellmode-resources haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-resources*
-haskellmode-settings haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-settings*
-haskellmode-settings-fine haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-settings-fine*
-haskellmode-settings-main haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-settings-main*
-haskellmode-user-completion haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode-user-completion*
-haskellmode.txt haskellmode.txt /*haskellmode.txt*
-headings latexhelp.txt /*headings*
-hpaste haskellmode.txt /*hpaste*
-hyph- latexhelp.txt /*hyph-*
-im_1 imaps.txt /*im_1*
-imaps-usage imaps.txt /*imaps-usage*
-imaps.txt imaps.txt /*imaps.txt*
-imaps.txt-toc imaps.txt /*imaps.txt-toc*
-inserting-commands latex-suite.txt /*inserting-commands*
-inserting-env-f5 latex-suite.txt /*inserting-env-f5*
-inserting-env-shift-f1 latex-suite.txt /*inserting-env-shift-f1*
-inserting-env-threeletter latex-suite.txt /*inserting-env-threeletter*
-inserting-environments latex-suite.txt /*inserting-environments*
-inserting-packages latex-suite.txt /*inserting-packages*
-inverse-searching latex-suite.txt /*inverse-searching*
-itemize latexhelp.txt /*itemize*
-landscape latexhelp.txt /*landscape*
-latex latexhelp.txt /*latex*
-latex-boxes latexhelp.txt /*latex-boxes*
-latex-breaking latexhelp.txt /*latex-breaking*
-latex-classes latexhelp.txt /*latex-classes*
-latex-command-maps latex-suite.txt /*latex-command-maps*
-latex-commands latexhelp.txt /*latex-commands*
-latex-compiling latex-suite.txt /*latex-compiling*
-latex-completion latex-suite.txt /*latex-completion*
-latex-completion-cite latex-suite.txt /*latex-completion-cite*
-latex-counters latexhelp.txt /*latex-counters*
-latex-definitions latexhelp.txt /*latex-definitions*
-latex-environments latexhelp.txt /*latex-environments*
-latex-folding latex-suite.txt /*latex-folding*
-latex-footnotes latexhelp.txt /*latex-footnotes*
-latex-hor-space latexhelp.txt /*latex-hor-space*
-latex-inputting latexhelp.txt /*latex-inputting*
-latex-layout latexhelp.txt /*latex-layout*
-latex-lengths latexhelp.txt /*latex-lengths*
-latex-letters latexhelp.txt /*latex-letters*
-latex-macros latex-suite.txt /*latex-macros*
-latex-margin-notes latexhelp.txt /*latex-margin-notes*
-latex-master-file latex-suite.txt /*latex-master-file*
-latex-master-file-specification latex-suite.txt /*latex-master-file-specification*
-latex-math latexhelp.txt /*latex-math*
-latex-modes latexhelp.txt /*latex-modes*
-latex-package-scanning latex-suite.txt /*latex-package-scanning*
-latex-packages latex-suite.txt /*latex-packages*
-latex-page-styles latexhelp.txt /*latex-page-styles*
-latex-paragraphs latexhelp.txt /*latex-paragraphs*
-latex-parameters latexhelp.txt /*latex-parameters*
-latex-project latex-suite.txt /*latex-project*
-latex-project-example latex-suite.txt /*latex-project-example*
-latex-project-settings latex-suite.txt /*latex-project-settings*
-latex-references latexhelp.txt /*latex-references*
-latex-sectioning latexhelp.txt /*latex-sectioning*
-latex-spaces-boxes latexhelp.txt /*latex-spaces-boxes*
-latex-special latexhelp.txt /*latex-special*
-latex-start-end latexhelp.txt /*latex-start-end*
-latex-suite-commands latex-suite.txt /*latex-suite-commands*
-latex-suite-commands-maps latex-suite.txt /*latex-suite-commands-maps*
-latex-suite-credits latex-suite.txt /*latex-suite-credits*
-latex-suite-maintainer latex-suite.txt /*latex-suite-maintainer*
-latex-suite-maps latex-suite.txt /*latex-suite-maps*
-latex-suite-quickstart.txt latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*latex-suite-quickstart.txt*
-latex-suite-quickstart.txt-toc latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*latex-suite-quickstart.txt-toc*
-latex-suite-templates latex-suite.txt /*latex-suite-templates*
-latex-suite.txt latex-suite.txt /*latex-suite.txt*
-latex-suite.txt-toc latex-suite.txt /*latex-suite.txt-toc*
-latex-terminal latexhelp.txt /*latex-terminal*
-latex-toc latexhelp.txt /*latex-toc*
-latex-typefaces latexhelp.txt /*latex-typefaces*
-latex-ver-space latexhelp.txt /*latex-ver-space*
-latex-viewing latex-suite.txt /*latex-viewing*
-latex-viewing-rules latex-suite.txt /*latex-viewing-rules*
-latexhelp.txt latexhelp.txt /*latexhelp.txt*
-leqno latexhelp.txt /*leqno*
-letter-class latexhelp.txt /*letter-class*
-list latexhelp.txt /*list*
-lq_1 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_1*
-lq_10 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_10*
-lq_2 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_2*
-lq_3 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_3*
-lq_4 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_4*
-lq_5 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_5*
-lq_6 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_6*
-lq_7 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_7*
-lq_8 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_8*
-lq_8_1 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_8_1*
-lq_9 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_9*
-lq_9_1 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_9_1*
-lq_9_2 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_9_2*
-lq_a_bc latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bc*
-lq_a_bd latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bd*
-lq_a_be latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_be*
-lq_a_bf latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bf*
-lq_a_bg latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bg*
-lq_a_bh latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bh*
-lq_a_bi latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bi*
-lq_a_bj latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bj*
-lq_a_bk latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bk*
-lq_a_bl latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bl*
-lq_a_bm latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bm*
-lq_a_bn latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bn*
-lq_a_bo latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_a_bo*
-lq_u_1 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_u_1*
-lq_u_2 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_u_2*
-lq_u_3 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_u_3*
-lq_u_4 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_u_4*
-lq_u_5 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_u_5*
-lq_u_6 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_u_6*
-lq_u_7 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_u_7*
-lq_u_8 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_u_8*
-lq_u_9 latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lq_u_9*
-lr-mode latexhelp.txt /*lr-mode*
-ls-completion-custom latex-suite.txt /*ls-completion-custom*
-ls-completion-ref latex-suite.txt /*ls-completion-ref*
-ls-completion-usage latex-suite.txt /*ls-completion-usage*
-ls-filename-completion latex-suite.txt /*ls-filename-completion*
-ls-general-purpose-settings latex-suite.txt /*ls-general-purpose-settings*
-ls-imap-f7 latex-suite.txt /*ls-imap-f7*
-ls-imap-s-f7 latex-suite.txt /*ls-imap-s-f7*
-ls-imaps-syntax latex-suite.txt /*ls-imaps-syntax*
-ls-new-macros latex-suite.txt /*ls-new-macros*
-ls-set-grepprg latex-suite.txt /*ls-set-grepprg*
-ls-vmap-f7 latex-suite.txt /*ls-vmap-f7*
-ls_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_1*
-ls_10 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10*
-ls_10_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_1*
-ls_10_1_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_1_1*
-ls_10_1_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_1_2*
-ls_10_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2*
-ls_10_2_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_1*
-ls_10_2_10 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_10*
-ls_10_2_11 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_11*
-ls_10_2_12 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_12*
-ls_10_2_13 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_13*
-ls_10_2_14 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_14*
-ls_10_2_15 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_15*
-ls_10_2_16 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_16*
-ls_10_2_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_2*
-ls_10_2_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_3*
-ls_10_2_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_4*
-ls_10_2_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_5*
-ls_10_2_6 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_6*
-ls_10_2_7 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_7*
-ls_10_2_8 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_8*
-ls_10_2_9 latex-suite.txt /*ls_10_2_9*
-ls_11 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11*
-ls_11_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_1*
-ls_11_10 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_10*
-ls_11_10_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_10_1*
-ls_11_1_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_1_1*
-ls_11_1_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_1_2*
-ls_11_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_2*
-ls_11_2_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_2_1*
-ls_11_2_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_2_2*
-ls_11_2_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_2_3*
-ls_11_2_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_2_4*
-ls_11_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3*
-ls_11_3_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_1*
-ls_11_3_10 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_10*
-ls_11_3_11 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_11*
-ls_11_3_12 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_12*
-ls_11_3_13 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_13*
-ls_11_3_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_2*
-ls_11_3_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_3*
-ls_11_3_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_4*
-ls_11_3_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_5*
-ls_11_3_6 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_6*
-ls_11_3_7 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_7*
-ls_11_3_8 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_8*
-ls_11_3_9 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_3_9*
-ls_11_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_4*
-ls_11_4_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_4_1*
-ls_11_4_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_4_2*
-ls_11_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_5*
-ls_11_5_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_5_1*
-ls_11_5_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_5_2*
-ls_11_5_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_5_3*
-ls_11_5_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_5_4*
-ls_11_5_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_5_5*
-ls_11_6 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_6*
-ls_11_6_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_6_1*
-ls_11_6_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_6_2*
-ls_11_6_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_6_3*
-ls_11_6_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_6_4*
-ls_11_6_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_6_5*
-ls_11_6_6 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_6_6*
-ls_11_6_7 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_6_7*
-ls_11_6_8 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_6_8*
-ls_11_7 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_7*
-ls_11_7_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_7_1*
-ls_11_7_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_7_2*
-ls_11_8 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_8*
-ls_11_8_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_8_1*
-ls_11_8_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_8_2*
-ls_11_8_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_8_3*
-ls_11_8_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_8_4*
-ls_11_8_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_8_5*
-ls_11_8_6 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_8_6*
-ls_11_8_7 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_8_7*
-ls_11_9 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_9*
-ls_11_9_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_9_1*
-ls_11_9_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_11_9_2*
-ls_12 latex-suite.txt /*ls_12*
-ls_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_2*
-ls_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3*
-ls_3_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_1*
-ls_3_10 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_10*
-ls_3_10_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_10_1*
-ls_3_10_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_10_2*
-ls_3_10_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_10_3*
-ls_3_10_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_10_4*
-ls_3_11 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_11*
-ls_3_12 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_12*
-ls_3_12_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_12_1*
-ls_3_12_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_12_2*
-ls_3_1_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_1_1*
-ls_3_1_1_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_1_1_1*
-ls_3_1_1_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_1_1_2*
-ls_3_1_1_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_1_1_3*
-ls_3_1_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_1_2*
-ls_3_1_2_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_1_2_1*
-ls_3_1_2_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_1_2_2*
-ls_3_1_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_1_3*
-ls_3_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_2*
-ls_3_2_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_2_1*
-ls_3_2_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_2_2*
-ls_3_2_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_2_3*
-ls_3_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_3*
-ls_3_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_4*
-ls_3_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_5*
-ls_3_6 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_6*
-ls_3_7 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_7*
-ls_3_8 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_8*
-ls_3_8_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_8_1*
-ls_3_9 latex-suite.txt /*ls_3_9*
-ls_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_4*
-ls_4_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_4_1*
-ls_4_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_4_2*
-ls_4_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_4_3*
-ls_4_3_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_4_3_1*
-ls_4_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_4_4*
-ls_4_4_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_4_4_1*
-ls_4_4_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_4_4_2*
-ls_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_5*
-ls_5_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_5_1*
-ls_5_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_5_2*
-ls_5_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_5_3*
-ls_5_3_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_5_3_1*
-ls_5_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_5_4*
-ls_5_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_5_5*
-ls_6 latex-suite.txt /*ls_6*
-ls_6_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_6_1*
-ls_6_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_6_2*
-ls_6_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_6_3*
-ls_6_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_6_4*
-ls_6_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_6_5*
-ls_7 latex-suite.txt /*ls_7*
-ls_7_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_7_1*
-ls_7_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_7_2*
-ls_7_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_7_3*
-ls_8 latex-suite.txt /*ls_8*
-ls_8_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_8_1*
-ls_8_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_8_2*
-ls_8_2_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_8_2_1*
-ls_8_2_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_8_2_2*
-ls_8_2_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_8_2_3*
-ls_8_2_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_8_2_4*
-ls_8_2_5 latex-suite.txt /*ls_8_2_5*
-ls_8_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_8_3*
-ls_9 latex-suite.txt /*ls_9*
-ls_9_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_9_1*
-ls_9_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_9_2*
-ls_a_bA latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bA*
-ls_a_bB latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bB*
-ls_a_bC latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bC*
-ls_a_bD latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bD*
-ls_a_bE latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bE*
-ls_a_bF latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bF*
-ls_a_bG latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bG*
-ls_a_bH latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bH*
-ls_a_bI latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bI*
-ls_a_bJ latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bJ*
-ls_a_bK latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bK*
-ls_a_bL latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bL*
-ls_a_bM latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bM*
-ls_a_bN latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bN*
-ls_a_bO latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bO*
-ls_a_bP latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bP*
-ls_a_bQ latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bQ*
-ls_a_bR latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bR*
-ls_a_bS latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bS*
-ls_a_bT latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bT*
-ls_a_bU latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bU*
-ls_a_bV latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bV*
-ls_a_bW latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bW*
-ls_a_bX latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bX*
-ls_a_bY latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bY*
-ls_a_bZ latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bZ*
-ls_a_bc latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bc*
-ls_a_bd latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bd*
-ls_a_be latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_be*
-ls_a_bf latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bf*
-ls_a_bg latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bg*
-ls_a_bh latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bh*
-ls_a_bi latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bi*
-ls_a_bj latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bj*
-ls_a_bk latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bk*
-ls_a_bl latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bl*
-ls_a_bm latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bm*
-ls_a_bn latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bn*
-ls_a_bo latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bo*
-ls_a_bp latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bp*
-ls_a_bq latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bq*
-ls_a_br latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_br*
-ls_a_bs latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bs*
-ls_a_bt latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bt*
-ls_a_bu latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bu*
-ls_a_bv latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bv*
-ls_a_bw latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bw*
-ls_a_bx latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bx*
-ls_a_by latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_by*
-ls_a_bz latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_bz*
-ls_a_cA latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cA*
-ls_a_cB latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cB*
-ls_a_cC latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cC*
-ls_a_cD latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cD*
-ls_a_cE latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cE*
-ls_a_cF latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cF*
-ls_a_cG latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cG*
-ls_a_cH latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cH*
-ls_a_cI latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cI*
-ls_a_cJ latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cJ*
-ls_a_cK latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cK*
-ls_a_cL latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cL*
-ls_a_cM latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cM*
-ls_a_cN latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cN*
-ls_a_cO latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cO*
-ls_a_cP latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cP*
-ls_a_cQ latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cQ*
-ls_a_cR latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cR*
-ls_a_cS latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cS*
-ls_a_cT latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cT*
-ls_a_cU latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cU*
-ls_a_cV latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cV*
-ls_a_cW latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cW*
-ls_a_cX latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cX*
-ls_a_cY latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cY*
-ls_a_cZ latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cZ*
-ls_a_ca latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ca*
-ls_a_cb latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cb*
-ls_a_cc latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cc*
-ls_a_cd latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cd*
-ls_a_ce latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ce*
-ls_a_cf latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cf*
-ls_a_cg latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cg*
-ls_a_ch latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ch*
-ls_a_ci latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ci*
-ls_a_cj latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cj*
-ls_a_ck latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ck*
-ls_a_cl latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cl*
-ls_a_cm latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cm*
-ls_a_cn latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cn*
-ls_a_co latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_co*
-ls_a_cp latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cp*
-ls_a_cq latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cq*
-ls_a_cr latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cr*
-ls_a_cs latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cs*
-ls_a_ct latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ct*
-ls_a_cu latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cu*
-ls_a_cv latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cv*
-ls_a_cw latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cw*
-ls_a_cx latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cx*
-ls_a_cy latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cy*
-ls_a_cz latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_cz*
-ls_a_dA latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dA*
-ls_a_dB latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dB*
-ls_a_dC latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dC*
-ls_a_dD latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dD*
-ls_a_dE latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dE*
-ls_a_dF latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dF*
-ls_a_dG latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dG*
-ls_a_dH latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dH*
-ls_a_dI latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dI*
-ls_a_dJ latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dJ*
-ls_a_dK latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dK*
-ls_a_dL latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dL*
-ls_a_dM latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dM*
-ls_a_dN latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dN*
-ls_a_dO latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dO*
-ls_a_dP latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dP*
-ls_a_dQ latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dQ*
-ls_a_dR latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dR*
-ls_a_dS latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dS*
-ls_a_dT latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dT*
-ls_a_dU latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dU*
-ls_a_dV latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dV*
-ls_a_dW latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dW*
-ls_a_dX latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dX*
-ls_a_dY latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dY*
-ls_a_dZ latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dZ*
-ls_a_da latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_da*
-ls_a_db latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_db*
-ls_a_dc latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dc*
-ls_a_dd latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dd*
-ls_a_de latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_de*
-ls_a_df latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_df*
-ls_a_dg latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dg*
-ls_a_dh latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dh*
-ls_a_di latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_di*
-ls_a_dj latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dj*
-ls_a_dk latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dk*
-ls_a_dl latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dl*
-ls_a_dm latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dm*
-ls_a_dn latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dn*
-ls_a_do latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_do*
-ls_a_dp latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dp*
-ls_a_dq latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dq*
-ls_a_dr latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dr*
-ls_a_ds latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ds*
-ls_a_dt latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dt*
-ls_a_du latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_du*
-ls_a_dv latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dv*
-ls_a_dw latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dw*
-ls_a_dx latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dx*
-ls_a_dy latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dy*
-ls_a_dz latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_dz*
-ls_a_eA latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eA*
-ls_a_eB latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eB*
-ls_a_eC latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eC*
-ls_a_eD latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eD*
-ls_a_eE latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eE*
-ls_a_eF latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eF*
-ls_a_eG latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eG*
-ls_a_ea latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ea*
-ls_a_eb latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eb*
-ls_a_ec latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ec*
-ls_a_ed latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ed*
-ls_a_ee latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ee*
-ls_a_ef latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ef*
-ls_a_eg latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eg*
-ls_a_eh latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eh*
-ls_a_ei latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ei*
-ls_a_ej latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ej*
-ls_a_ek latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ek*
-ls_a_el latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_el*
-ls_a_em latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_em*
-ls_a_en latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_en*
-ls_a_eo latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eo*
-ls_a_ep latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ep*
-ls_a_eq latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eq*
-ls_a_er latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_er*
-ls_a_es latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_es*
-ls_a_et latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_et*
-ls_a_eu latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_eu*
-ls_a_ev latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ev*
-ls_a_ew latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ew*
-ls_a_ex latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ex*
-ls_a_ey latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ey*
-ls_a_ez latex-suite.txt /*ls_a_ez*
-ls_u_1 latex-suite.txt /*ls_u_1*
-ls_u_2 latex-suite.txt /*ls_u_2*
-ls_u_3 latex-suite.txt /*ls_u_3*
-ls_u_4 latex-suite.txt /*ls_u_4*
-lsq-compiling latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-compiling*
-lsq-conclusions latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-conclusions*
-lsq-debugging latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-debugging*
-lsq-folding latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-folding*
-lsq-insert-environment latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-insert-environment*
-lsq-inserting-reference latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-inserting-reference*
-lsq-inserting-template latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-inserting-template*
-lsq-keyboard-shortcuts latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-keyboard-shortcuts*
-lsq-lsq-inserting-package latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-lsq-inserting-package*
-lsq-quick-forward-searching latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-quick-forward-searching*
-lsq-quick-inverse-searching latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-quick-inverse-searching*
-lsq-using-tutorial latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-using-tutorial*
-lsq-viewing-dvi latex-suite-quickstart.txt /*lsq-viewing-dvi*
-macro-enabling latex-suite.txt /*macro-enabling*
-math, latexhelp.txt /*math,*
-math-misc latexhelp.txt /*math-misc*
-math-mode latexhelp.txt /*math-mode*
-math-spacing latexhelp.txt /*math-spacing*
-math-symbols latexhelp.txt /*math-symbols*
-math: latexhelp.txt /*math:*
-math; latexhelp.txt /*math;*
-matn! latexhelp.txt /*matn!*
-minipage latexhelp.txt /*minipage*
-notitlepage latexhelp.txt /*notitlepage*
-onecolumn latexhelp.txt /*onecolumn*
-oneside latexhelp.txt /*oneside*
-openany latexhelp.txt /*openany*
-openbib latexhelp.txt /*openbib*
-openright latexhelp.txt /*openright*
-otl2html vo_readme.txt.gz /*otl2html*
-overriding-macros latex-suite.txt /*overriding-macros*
-package-actions latex-suite.txt /*package-actions*
-paragraph-mode latexhelp.txt /*paragraph-mode*
-part-compiling latex-suite.txt /*part-compiling*
-pausing-imaps latex-suite.txt /*pausing-imaps*
-picture latexhelp.txt /*picture*
-picture-makebox latexhelp.txt /*picture-makebox*
-place-holder latex-suite.txt /*place-holder*
-place-holders latex-suite.txt /*place-holders*
-plain latexhelp.txt /*plain*
-pre-lengths latexhelp.txt /*pre-lengths*
-ps_color.txt ps_color.txt /*ps_color.txt*
-ps_colour ps_color.txt /*ps_colour*
-psc ps_color.txt /*psc*
-psc-about-background ps_color.txt /*psc-about-background*
-psc-change-background ps_color.txt /*psc-change-background*
-psc-contents ps_color.txt /*psc-contents*
-psc-cterm ps_color.txt /*psc-cterm*
-psc-cterm-color-table ps_color.txt /*psc-cterm-color-table*
-psc-cterm-incompatible ps_color.txt /*psc-cterm-incompatible*
-psc-cterm-nt ps_color.txt /*psc-cterm-nt*
-psc-cterm-others ps_color.txt /*psc-cterm-others*
-psc-cterm-xterm ps_color.txt /*psc-cterm-xterm*
-psc-faq ps_color.txt /*psc-faq*
-psc-faq-ffothers ps_color.txt /*psc-faq-ffothers*
-psc-features ps_color.txt /*psc-features*
-psc-options ps_color.txt /*psc-options*
-psc-overview ps_color.txt /*psc-overview*
-psc-release-notes ps_color.txt /*psc-release-notes*
-psc-tips ps_color.txt /*psc-tips*
-psc-todo ps_color.txt /*psc-todo*
-psc-usage ps_color.txt /*psc-usage*
-psc_cterm_style ps_color.txt /*psc_cterm_style*
-psc_fontface ps_color.txt /*psc_fontface*
-psc_inversed_todo ps_color.txt /*psc_inversed_todo*
-psc_statement_different_from_type ps_color.txt /*psc_statement_different_from_type*
-psc_style ps_color.txt /*psc_style*
-psc_use_default_for_cterm ps_color.txt /*psc_use_default_for_cterm*
-pscolor ps_color.txt /*pscolor*
-quotation latexhelp.txt /*quotation*
-quote-l latexhelp.txt /*quote-l*
-recommended-settings latex-suite.txt /*recommended-settings*
-remapping-latex-suite-keys latex-suite.txt /*remapping-latex-suite-keys*
-report-class latexhelp.txt /*report-class*
-roman latexhelp.txt /*roman*
-rqno latexhelp.txt /*rqno*
-section-mappings latex-suite.txt /*section-mappings*
-slides-class latexhelp.txt /*slides-class*
-smart-backspace latex-suite.txt /*smart-backspace*
-smart-keys latex-suite.txt /*smart-keys*
-sub-sup latexhelp.txt /*sub-sup*
-subscripts latexhelp.txt /*subscripts*
-superscripts latexhelp.txt /*superscripts*
-supporting-packages latex-suite.txt /*supporting-packages*
-tab' latexhelp.txt /*tab'*
-tab+ latexhelp.txt /*tab+*
-tab- latexhelp.txt /*tab-*
-tab< latexhelp.txt /*tab<*
-tab= latexhelp.txt /*tab=*
-tab> latexhelp.txt /*tab>*
-tab` latexhelp.txt /*tab`*
-taba latexhelp.txt /*taba*
-tabbing latexhelp.txt /*tabbing*
-tabular latexhelp.txt /*tabular*
-taglist-commands taglist.txt /*taglist-commands*
-taglist-debug taglist.txt /*taglist-debug*
-taglist-extend taglist.txt /*taglist-extend*
-taglist-faq taglist.txt /*taglist-faq*
-taglist-functions taglist.txt /*taglist-functions*
-taglist-install taglist.txt /*taglist-install*
-taglist-internet taglist.txt /*taglist-internet*
-taglist-intro taglist.txt /*taglist-intro*
-taglist-keys taglist.txt /*taglist-keys*
-taglist-license taglist.txt /*taglist-license*
-taglist-menu taglist.txt /*taglist-menu*
-taglist-options taglist.txt /*taglist-options*
-taglist-requirements taglist.txt /*taglist-requirements*
-taglist-session taglist.txt /*taglist-session*
-taglist-todo taglist.txt /*taglist-todo*
-taglist-using taglist.txt /*taglist-using*
-taglist.txt taglist.txt /*taglist.txt*
-theorem latexhelp.txt /*theorem*
-titlepage latexhelp.txt /*titlepage*
-twocolumn latexhelp.txt /*twocolumn*
-twoside latexhelp.txt /*twoside*
-verbatim latexhelp.txt /*verbatim*
-verse latexhelp.txt /*verse*
-vimoutliner vo_readme.txt.gz /*vimoutliner*
-vo vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo*
-vo-activities vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-activities*
-vo-advanced vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-advanced*
-vo-cautions vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-cautions*
-vo-checkbox vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-checkbox*
-vo-color vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-color*
-vo-command vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-command*
-vo-debian vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-debian*
-vo-executable-lines vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-executable-lines*
-vo-hoisting vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-hoisting*
-vo-install vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-install*
-vo-license vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-license*
-vo-maketags vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-maketags*
-vo-menu vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-menu*
-vo-objects vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-objects*
-vo-other-files vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-other-files*
-vo-other-info vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-other-info*
-vo-philosophy vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-philosophy*
-vo-plugins vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-plugins*
-vo-post-processors vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-post-processors*
-vo-running vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-running*
-vo-scripts vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-scripts*
-vo-testing vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-testing*
-vo-troubleshooting vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-troubleshooting*
-vo-version vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo-version*
-vo_readme.txt vo_readme.txt.gz /*vo_readme.txt*
-why-IMAP latex-suite.txt /*why-IMAP*